summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
authorDavid Blaikie <dblaikie@gmail.com>2011-11-09 06:07:30 +0000
committerDavid Blaikie <dblaikie@gmail.com>2011-11-09 06:07:30 +0000
commitba243b59a1074e0962f6abfa3bb9aa984eac1245 (patch)
treedd93c1c4b556f304c7f531289245f049bb7f524d
parenta8fbc053eb08c929174bf519a0e9733e4ef90bfa (diff)
downloadclang-ba243b59a1074e0962f6abfa3bb9aa984eac1245.tar.gz
clang-ba243b59a1074e0962f6abfa3bb9aa984eac1245.tar.bz2
clang-ba243b59a1074e0962f6abfa3bb9aa984eac1245.tar.xz
Fixing 80 col violations (& removing any trailing whitespace on files I was touching anyway)
git-svn-id: https://llvm.org/svn/llvm-project/cfe/trunk@144171 91177308-0d34-0410-b5e6-96231b3b80d8
-rw-r--r--include/clang/AST/ASTConsumer.h4
-rw-r--r--include/clang/AST/Decl.h158
-rw-r--r--include/clang/AST/DeclBase.h59
-rw-r--r--include/clang/AST/DeclCXX.h240
-rw-r--r--include/clang/AST/DeclObjC.h190
-rw-r--r--include/clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h164
-rw-r--r--include/clang/AST/Expr.h194
-rw-r--r--include/clang/AST/ExprCXX.h456
-rw-r--r--include/clang/AST/NestedNameSpecifier.h85
-rw-r--r--include/clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h49
-rw-r--r--include/clang/AST/Stmt.h68
-rw-r--r--include/clang/AST/StmtCXX.h40
-rw-r--r--include/clang/AST/Type.h339
-rw-r--r--include/clang/AST/TypeLoc.h53
-rw-r--r--include/clang/AST/VTableBuilder.h82
-rw-r--r--include/clang/Analysis/Analyses/Dominators.h9
-rw-r--r--include/clang/Analysis/Analyses/FormatString.h56
-rw-r--r--include/clang/Analysis/Analyses/PostOrderCFGView.h36
-rw-r--r--include/clang/Analysis/Analyses/ThreadSafety.h6
-rw-r--r--include/clang/Analysis/Analyses/UninitializedValues.h8
-rw-r--r--include/clang/Analysis/AnalysisContext.h78
-rw-r--r--include/clang/Analysis/CFG.h52
-rw-r--r--include/clang/Frontend/Utils.h3
-rw-r--r--include/clang/Index/ASTLocation.h14
-rw-r--r--include/clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h91
-rw-r--r--include/clang/Sema/CodeCompleteConsumer.h320
-rw-r--r--include/clang/Sema/LocInfoType.h12
-rw-r--r--include/clang/Sema/PrettyDeclStackTrace.h5
-rw-r--r--include/clang/Sema/Sema.h466
-rw-r--r--include/clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h21
-rw-r--r--include/clang/Serialization/ASTReader.h143
-rw-r--r--include/clang/Serialization/ASTWriter.h82
-rw-r--r--include/clang/Serialization/Module.h168
33 files changed, 1907 insertions, 1844 deletions
diff --git a/include/clang/AST/ASTConsumer.h b/include/clang/AST/ASTConsumer.h
index 300e4f26d3..c6cb71cc7c 100644
--- a/include/clang/AST/ASTConsumer.h
+++ b/include/clang/AST/ASTConsumer.h
@@ -99,7 +99,9 @@ public:
/// \brief If the consumer is interested in entities being deserialized from
/// AST files, it should return a pointer to a ASTDeserializationListener here
- virtual ASTDeserializationListener *GetASTDeserializationListener() { return 0; }
+ virtual ASTDeserializationListener *GetASTDeserializationListener() {
+ return 0;
+ }
/// PrintStats - If desired, print any statistics.
virtual void PrintStats() {}
diff --git a/include/clang/AST/Decl.h b/include/clang/AST/Decl.h
index a02a2ce336..058e304149 100644
--- a/include/clang/AST/Decl.h
+++ b/include/clang/AST/Decl.h
@@ -185,13 +185,13 @@ public:
/// \brief Whether this declaration was marked as being private to the
/// module in which it was defined.
bool isModulePrivate() const { return ModulePrivate; }
-
+
/// \brief Specify whether this declaration was marked as being private
/// to the module in which it was defined.
void setModulePrivate(bool MP = true) {
ModulePrivate = MP;
}
-
+
/// \brief Determine whether this declaration is a C++ class member.
bool isCXXClassMember() const {
const DeclContext *DC = getDeclContext();
@@ -281,7 +281,9 @@ public:
Linkage getLinkage() const;
/// \brief Determines the visibility of this entity.
- Visibility getVisibility() const { return getLinkageAndVisibility().visibility(); }
+ Visibility getVisibility() const {
+ return getLinkageAndVisibility().visibility();
+ }
/// \brief Determines the linkage and visibility of this entity.
LinkageInfo getLinkageAndVisibility() const;
@@ -291,7 +293,7 @@ public:
llvm::Optional<Visibility> getExplicitVisibility() const;
/// \brief Clear the linkage cache in response to a change
- /// to the declaration.
+ /// to the declaration.
void ClearLinkageCache();
/// \brief Looks through UsingDecls and ObjCCompatibleAliasDecls for
@@ -349,7 +351,7 @@ public:
static bool classof(const LabelDecl *D) { return true; }
static bool classofKind(Kind K) { return K == Label; }
};
-
+
/// NamespaceDecl - Represent a C++ namespace.
class NamespaceDecl : public NamedDecl, public DeclContext {
bool IsInline : 1;
@@ -422,7 +424,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Return the next extended namespace declaration or null if there
/// is none.
NamespaceDecl *getNextNamespace();
- const NamespaceDecl *getNextNamespace() const {
+ const NamespaceDecl *getNextNamespace() const {
return const_cast<NamespaceDecl *>(this)->getNextNamespace();
}
@@ -445,7 +447,7 @@ public:
}
/// \brief Set the original (first) namespace declaration.
- void setOriginalNamespace(NamespaceDecl *ND) {
+ void setOriginalNamespace(NamespaceDecl *ND) {
if (ND != this) {
OrigOrAnonNamespace.setPointer(ND);
OrigOrAnonNamespace.setInt(false);
@@ -463,8 +465,8 @@ public:
}
virtual NamespaceDecl *getCanonicalDecl() { return getOriginalNamespace(); }
- const NamespaceDecl *getCanonicalDecl() const {
- return getOriginalNamespace();
+ const NamespaceDecl *getCanonicalDecl() const {
+ return getOriginalNamespace();
}
virtual SourceRange getSourceRange() const {
@@ -486,7 +488,7 @@ public:
static NamespaceDecl *castFromDeclContext(const DeclContext *DC) {
return static_cast<NamespaceDecl *>(const_cast<DeclContext*>(DC));
}
-
+
friend class ASTDeclReader;
friend class ASTDeclWriter;
};
@@ -537,7 +539,7 @@ struct QualifierInfo {
void setTemplateParameterListsInfo(ASTContext &Context,
unsigned NumTPLists,
TemplateParameterList **TPLists);
-
+
private:
// Copy constructor and copy assignment are disabled.
QualifierInfo(const QualifierInfo&);
@@ -600,15 +602,15 @@ public:
return hasExtInfo() ? getExtInfo()->QualifierLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier()
: 0;
}
-
- /// \brief Retrieve the nested-name-specifier (with source-location
- /// information) that qualifies the name of this declaration, if it was
+
+ /// \brief Retrieve the nested-name-specifier (with source-location
+ /// information) that qualifies the name of this declaration, if it was
/// present in the source.
NestedNameSpecifierLoc getQualifierLoc() const {
return hasExtInfo() ? getExtInfo()->QualifierLoc
: NestedNameSpecifierLoc();
}
-
+
void setQualifierInfo(NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc);
unsigned getNumTemplateParameterLists() const {
@@ -705,9 +707,10 @@ private:
/// \brief Whether this variable is the exception variable in a C++ catch
/// or an Objective-C @catch statement.
unsigned ExceptionVar : 1;
-
+
/// \brief Whether this local variable could be allocated in the return
- /// slot of its function, enabling the named return value optimization (NRVO).
+ /// slot of its function, enabling the named return value optimization
+ /// (NRVO).
unsigned NRVOVariable : 1;
/// \brief Whether this variable is the for-range-declaration in a C++0x
@@ -725,10 +728,10 @@ private:
friend class ASTDeclReader;
friend class StmtIteratorBase;
-
+
protected:
enum { NumParameterIndexBits = 8 };
-
+
class ParmVarDeclBitfields {
friend class ParmVarDecl;
friend class ASTDeclReader;
@@ -823,12 +826,12 @@ public:
return getStorageClass() >= SC_Auto;
}
- /// isStaticLocal - Returns true if a variable with function scope is a
+ /// isStaticLocal - Returns true if a variable with function scope is a
/// static local variable.
bool isStaticLocal() const {
return getStorageClass() == SC_Static && !isFileVarDecl();
}
-
+
/// hasExternStorage - Returns true if a variable has extern or
/// __private_extern__ storage.
bool hasExternalStorage() const {
@@ -919,21 +922,21 @@ public:
return const_cast<VarDecl*>(this)->getDefinition();
}
- /// \brief Determine whether this is or was instantiated from an out-of-line
+ /// \brief Determine whether this is or was instantiated from an out-of-line
/// definition of a static data member.
virtual bool isOutOfLine() const;
/// \brief If this is a static data member, find its out-of-line definition.
VarDecl *getOutOfLineDefinition();
-
+
/// isFileVarDecl - Returns true for file scoped variable declaration.
bool isFileVarDecl() const {
if (getKind() != Decl::Var)
return false;
-
+
if (getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext())
return true;
-
+
if (isStaticDataMember())
return true;
@@ -996,7 +999,7 @@ public:
void setInit(Expr *I);
/// \brief Determine whether this variable is a reference that
- /// extends the lifetime of its temporary initializer.
+ /// extends the lifetime of its temporary initializer.
///
/// A reference extends the lifetime of its temporary initializer if
/// it's initializer is an rvalue that would normally go out of scope
@@ -1118,7 +1121,7 @@ public:
return VarDeclBits.ExceptionVar;
}
void setExceptionVariable(bool EV) { VarDeclBits.ExceptionVar = EV; }
-
+
/// \brief Determine whether this local variable can be used with the named
/// return value optimization (NRVO).
///
@@ -1143,7 +1146,7 @@ public:
/// Generally such variables are also 'const' for safety.
bool isARCPseudoStrong() const { return VarDeclBits.ARCPseudoStrong; }
void setARCPseudoStrong(bool ps) { VarDeclBits.ARCPseudoStrong = ps; }
-
+
/// Whether this variable is (C++0x) constexpr.
bool isConstexpr() const { return VarDeclBits.IsConstexpr; }
void setConstexpr(bool IC) { VarDeclBits.IsConstexpr = IC; }
@@ -1153,15 +1156,15 @@ public:
/// from which it was instantiated.
VarDecl *getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember() const;
- /// \brief If this variable is a static data member, determine what kind of
+ /// \brief If this variable is a static data member, determine what kind of
/// template specialization or instantiation this is.
TemplateSpecializationKind getTemplateSpecializationKind() const;
-
+
/// \brief If this variable is an instantiation of a static data member of a
/// class template specialization, retrieves the member specialization
/// information.
MemberSpecializationInfo *getMemberSpecializationInfo() const;
-
+
/// \brief For a static data member that was instantiated from a static
/// data member of a class template, set the template specialiation kind.
void setTemplateSpecializationKind(TemplateSpecializationKind TSK,
@@ -1219,7 +1222,7 @@ public:
Expr *DefArg);
virtual SourceRange getSourceRange() const;
-
+
void setObjCMethodScopeInfo(unsigned parameterIndex) {
ParmVarDeclBits.IsObjCMethodParam = true;
setParameterIndex(parameterIndex);
@@ -1229,7 +1232,8 @@ public:
assert(!ParmVarDeclBits.IsObjCMethodParam);
ParmVarDeclBits.ScopeDepthOrObjCQuals = scopeDepth;
- assert(ParmVarDeclBits.ScopeDepthOrObjCQuals == scopeDepth && "truncation!");
+ assert(ParmVarDeclBits.ScopeDepthOrObjCQuals == scopeDepth
+ && "truncation!");
setParameterIndex(parameterIndex);
}
@@ -1276,7 +1280,7 @@ public:
const Expr *getDefaultArg() const {
return const_cast<ParmVarDecl *>(this)->getDefaultArg();
}
-
+
void setDefaultArg(Expr *defarg) {
Init = reinterpret_cast<Stmt *>(defarg);
}
@@ -1286,10 +1290,10 @@ public:
const CXXTemporary *getDefaultArgTemporary(unsigned i) const {
return const_cast<ParmVarDecl *>(this)->getDefaultArgTemporary(i);
}
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the source range that covers the entire default
/// argument.
- SourceRange getDefaultArgRange() const;
+ SourceRange getDefaultArgRange() const;
void setUninstantiatedDefaultArg(Expr *arg) {
Init = reinterpret_cast<UninstantiatedDefaultArgument *>(arg);
}
@@ -1351,7 +1355,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Determine whether this parameter is actually a function
/// parameter pack.
bool isParameterPack() const;
-
+
/// setOwningFunction - Sets the function declaration that owns this
/// ParmVarDecl. Since ParmVarDecls are often created before the
/// FunctionDecls that own them, this routine is required to update
@@ -1362,7 +1366,7 @@ public:
static bool classof(const Decl *D) { return classofKind(D->getKind()); }
static bool classof(const ParmVarDecl *D) { return true; }
static bool classofKind(Kind K) { return K == ParmVar; }
-
+
private:
enum { ParameterIndexSentinel = (1 << NumParameterIndexBits) - 1 };
@@ -1371,7 +1375,7 @@ private:
setParameterIndexLarge(parameterIndex);
return;
}
-
+
ParmVarDeclBits.ParameterIndex = parameterIndex;
assert(ParmVarDeclBits.ParameterIndex == parameterIndex && "truncation!");
}
@@ -1379,7 +1383,7 @@ private:
unsigned d = ParmVarDeclBits.ParameterIndex;
return d == ParameterIndexSentinel ? getParameterIndexLarge() : d;
}
-
+
void setParameterIndexLarge(unsigned parameterIndex);
unsigned getParameterIndexLarge() const;
};
@@ -1456,7 +1460,7 @@ private:
/// FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo, which contains information about
/// the template being specialized and the template arguments involved in
/// that specialization.
- llvm::PointerUnion4<FunctionTemplateDecl *,
+ llvm::PointerUnion4<FunctionTemplateDecl *,
MemberSpecializationInfo *,
FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *,
DependentFunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *>
@@ -1486,7 +1490,7 @@ private:
/// \param TemplateArgsAsWritten location info of template arguments.
///
/// \param PointOfInstantiation point at which the function template
- /// specialization was first instantiated.
+ /// specialization was first instantiated.
void setFunctionTemplateSpecialization(ASTContext &C,
FunctionTemplateDecl *Template,
const TemplateArgumentList *TemplateArgs,
@@ -1656,7 +1660,7 @@ public:
void setTrivial(bool IT) { IsTrivial = IT; }
/// Whether this function is defaulted per C++0x. Only valid for
- /// special member functions.
+ /// special member functions.
bool isDefaulted() const { return IsDefaulted; }
void setDefaulted(bool D = true) { IsDefaulted = D; }
@@ -1783,12 +1787,12 @@ public:
QualType getResultType() const {
return getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getResultType();
}
-
+
/// \brief Determine the type of an expression that calls this function.
QualType getCallResultType() const {
return getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getCallResultType(getASTContext());
}
-
+
StorageClass getStorageClass() const { return StorageClass(SClass); }
void setStorageClass(StorageClass SC);
@@ -1799,10 +1803,10 @@ public:
/// \brief Determine whether the "inline" keyword was specified for this
/// function.
bool isInlineSpecified() const { return IsInlineSpecified; }
-
+
/// Set whether the "inline" keyword was specified for this function.
- void setInlineSpecified(bool I) {
- IsInlineSpecified = I;
+ void setInlineSpecified(bool I) {
+ IsInlineSpecified = I;
IsInline = I;
}
@@ -1819,7 +1823,7 @@ public:
bool isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible() const;
bool doesDeclarationForceExternallyVisibleDefinition() const;
-
+
/// isOverloadedOperator - Whether this function declaration
/// represents an C++ overloaded operator, e.g., "operator+".
bool isOverloadedOperator() const {
@@ -1852,7 +1856,7 @@ public:
/// X<int>::A is required, it will be instantiated from the
/// declaration returned by getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction().
FunctionDecl *getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction() const;
-
+
/// \brief What kind of templated function this is.
TemplatedKind getTemplatedKind() const;
@@ -1860,7 +1864,7 @@ public:
/// class template specialization, retrieves the member specialization
/// information.
MemberSpecializationInfo *getMemberSpecializationInfo() const;
-
+
/// \brief Specify that this record is an instantiation of the
/// member function FD.
void setInstantiationOfMemberFunction(FunctionDecl *FD,
@@ -1888,7 +1892,7 @@ public:
TemplateOrSpecialization = Template;
}
- /// \brief Determine whether this function is a function template
+ /// \brief Determine whether this function is a function template
/// specialization.
bool isFunctionTemplateSpecialization() const {
return getPrimaryTemplate() != 0;
@@ -1899,7 +1903,7 @@ public:
FunctionDecl *getClassScopeSpecializationPattern() const;
/// \brief If this function is actually a function template specialization,
- /// retrieve information about this function template specialization.
+ /// retrieve information about this function template specialization.
/// Otherwise, returns NULL.
FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *getTemplateSpecializationInfo() const {
return TemplateOrSpecialization.
@@ -1910,7 +1914,7 @@ public:
/// specialization or a member of a class template specialization that can
/// be implicitly instantiated.
bool isImplicitlyInstantiable() const;
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the function declaration from which this function could
/// be instantiated, if it is an instantiation (rather than a non-template
/// or a specialization, for example).
@@ -1958,7 +1962,7 @@ public:
/// \param TemplateArgsAsWritten location info of template arguments.
///
/// \param PointOfInstantiation point at which the function template
- /// specialization was first instantiated.
+ /// specialization was first instantiated.
void setFunctionTemplateSpecialization(FunctionTemplateDecl *Template,
const TemplateArgumentList *TemplateArgs,
void *InsertPos,
@@ -1994,15 +1998,15 @@ public:
/// \brief Retrieve the (first) point of instantiation of a function template
/// specialization or a member of a class template specialization.
///
- /// \returns the first point of instantiation, if this function was
- /// instantiated from a template; otherwise, returns an invalid source
+ /// \returns the first point of instantiation, if this function was
+ /// instantiated from a template; otherwise, returns an invalid source
/// location.
SourceLocation getPointOfInstantiation() const;
-
- /// \brief Determine whether this is or was instantiated from an out-of-line
+
+ /// \brief Determine whether this is or was instantiated from an out-of-line
/// definition of a member function.
virtual bool isOutOfLine() const;
-
+
// Implement isa/cast/dyncast/etc.
static bool classof(const Decl *D) { return classofKind(D->getKind()); }
static bool classof(const FunctionDecl *D) { return true; }
@@ -2108,7 +2112,8 @@ public:
Expr *getInClassInitializer() const {
return hasInClassInitializer() ? InitializerOrBitWidth.getPointer() : 0;
}
- /// setInClassInitializer - Set the C++0x in-class initializer for this member.
+ /// setInClassInitializer - Set the C++0x in-class initializer for this
+ /// member.
void setInClassInitializer(Expr *Init);
/// removeInClassInitializer - Remove the C++0x in-class initializer from this
/// member.
@@ -2164,7 +2169,7 @@ public:
void setInitVal(const llvm::APSInt &V) { Val = V; }
SourceRange getSourceRange() const;
-
+
// Implement isa/cast/dyncast/etc.
static bool classof(const Decl *D) { return classofKind(D->getKind()); }
static bool classof(const EnumConstantDecl *D) { return true; }
@@ -2189,7 +2194,7 @@ public:
static IndirectFieldDecl *Create(ASTContext &C, DeclContext *DC,
SourceLocation L, IdentifierInfo *Id,
QualType T, NamedDecl **CH, unsigned CHS);
-
+
typedef NamedDecl * const *chain_iterator;
chain_iterator chain_begin() const { return Chaining; }
chain_iterator chain_end() const { return Chaining+ChainingSize; }
@@ -2435,8 +2440,8 @@ protected:
/// @brief Completes the definition of this tag declaration.
///
/// This is a helper function for derived classes.
- void completeDefinition();
-
+ void completeDefinition();
+
public:
typedef redeclarable_base::redecl_iterator redecl_iterator;
redecl_iterator redecls_begin() const {
@@ -2532,7 +2537,8 @@ public:
bool isEnum() const { return getTagKind() == TTK_Enum; }
TypedefNameDecl *getTypedefNameForAnonDecl() const {
- return hasExtInfo() ? 0 : TypedefNameDeclOrQualifier.get<TypedefNameDecl*>();
+ return hasExtInfo() ? 0 :
+ TypedefNameDeclOrQualifier.get<TypedefNameDecl*>();
}
void setTypedefNameForAnonDecl(TypedefNameDecl *TDD);
@@ -2543,15 +2549,15 @@ public:
return hasExtInfo() ? getExtInfo()->QualifierLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier()
: 0;
}
-
- /// \brief Retrieve the nested-name-specifier (with source-location
- /// information) that qualifies the name of this declaration, if it was
+
+ /// \brief Retrieve the nested-name-specifier (with source-location
+ /// information) that qualifies the name of this declaration, if it was
/// present in the source.
NestedNameSpecifierLoc getQualifierLoc() const {
return hasExtInfo() ? getExtInfo()->QualifierLoc
: NestedNameSpecifierLoc();
}
-
+
void setQualifierInfo(NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc);
unsigned getNumTemplateParameterLists() const {
@@ -2723,7 +2729,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Returns the width in bits required to store all the
/// negative enumerators of this enum. These widths include
/// the rightmost leading 1; that is:
- ///
+ ///
/// MOST NEGATIVE ENUMERATOR PATTERN NUM NEGATIVE BITS
/// ------------------------ ------- -----------------
/// -1 1111111 1
@@ -3058,7 +3064,7 @@ public:
bool capturesCXXThis);
virtual SourceRange getSourceRange() const;
-
+
// Implement isa/cast/dyncast/etc.
static bool classof(const Decl *D) { return classofKind(D->getKind()); }
static bool classof(const BlockDecl *D) { return true; }
@@ -3086,20 +3092,20 @@ void Redeclarable<decl_type>::setPreviousDeclaration(decl_type *PrevDecl) {
// and Redeclarable to be defined.
decl_type *First;
-
+
if (PrevDecl) {
// Point to previous. Make sure that this is actually the most recent
// redeclaration, or we can build invalid chains. If the most recent
// redeclaration is invalid, it won't be PrevDecl, but we want it anyway.
- RedeclLink = PreviousDeclLink(llvm::cast<decl_type>(
- PrevDecl->getMostRecentDeclaration()));
+ RedeclLink = PreviousDeclLink(
+ llvm::cast<decl_type>(PrevDecl->getMostRecentDeclaration()));
First = PrevDecl->getFirstDeclaration();
assert(First->RedeclLink.NextIsLatest() && "Expected first");
} else {
// Make this first.
First = static_cast<decl_type*>(this);
}
-
+
// First one will point to this one as latest.
First->RedeclLink = LatestDeclLink(static_cast<decl_type*>(this));
if (NamedDecl *ND = dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(static_cast<decl_type*>(this)))
diff --git a/include/clang/AST/DeclBase.h b/include/clang/AST/DeclBase.h
index 5d95cc81c7..db0cf95842 100644
--- a/include/clang/AST/DeclBase.h
+++ b/include/clang/AST/DeclBase.h
@@ -98,7 +98,7 @@ public:
/// identifiers. C++ describes lookup completely differently:
/// certain lookups merely "ignore" certain kinds of declarations,
/// usually based on whether the declaration is of a type, etc.
- ///
+ ///
/// These are meant as bitmasks, so that searches in
/// C++ can look into the "tag" namespace during ordinary lookup.
///
@@ -243,7 +243,7 @@ private:
/// evaluated context or not, e.g. functions used in uninstantiated templates
/// are regarded as "referenced" but not "used".
unsigned Referenced : 1;
-
+
protected:
/// Access - Used by C++ decls for the access specifier.
// NOTE: VC++ treats enums as signed, avoid using the AccessSpecifier enum
@@ -252,7 +252,7 @@ protected:
/// \brief Whether this declaration was loaded from an AST file.
unsigned FromASTFile : 1;
-
+
/// ChangedAfterLoad - if this declaration has changed since being loaded
unsigned ChangedAfterLoad : 1;
@@ -267,12 +267,12 @@ protected:
///
/// This field is only valid for NamedDecls subclasses.
mutable unsigned HasCachedLinkage : 1;
-
+
/// \brief If \c HasCachedLinkage, the linkage of this declaration.
///
/// This field is only valid for NamedDecls subclasses.
mutable unsigned CachedLinkage : 2;
-
+
friend class ASTDeclWriter;
friend class ASTDeclReader;
@@ -288,7 +288,7 @@ protected:
Access(AS_none), FromASTFile(0), ChangedAfterLoad(false),
ModulePrivate(0),
IdentifierNamespace(getIdentifierNamespaceForKind(DK)),
- HasCachedLinkage(0)
+ HasCachedLinkage(0)
{
if (Decl::CollectingStats()) add(DK);
}
@@ -389,11 +389,11 @@ public:
attr_iterator attr_end() const {
return hasAttrs() ? getAttrs().end() : 0;
}
-
+
template <typename T>
void dropAttr() {
if (!HasAttrs) return;
-
+
AttrVec &Attrs = getAttrs();
for (unsigned i = 0, e = Attrs.size(); i != e; /* in loop */) {
if (isa<T>(Attrs[i])) {
@@ -406,7 +406,7 @@ public:
if (Attrs.empty())
HasAttrs = false;
}
-
+
template <typename T>
specific_attr_iterator<T> specific_attr_begin() const {
return specific_attr_iterator<T>(attr_begin());
@@ -504,7 +504,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Determine whether this declaration came from an AST file (such as
/// a precompiled header or module) rather than having been parsed.
bool isFromASTFile() const { return FromASTFile; }
-
+
/// \brief Query whether this declaration was changed in a significant way
/// since being loaded from an AST file.
///
@@ -673,7 +673,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Whether this declaration is a parameter pack.
bool isParameterPack() const;
-
+
/// \brief returns true if this declaration is a template
bool isTemplateDecl() const;
@@ -722,7 +722,7 @@ public:
unsigned mask
= (IdentifierNamespace & (IDNS_TagFriend | IDNS_OrdinaryFriend));
if (!mask) return FOK_None;
- return (IdentifierNamespace & (IDNS_Tag | IDNS_Ordinary) ?
+ return (IdentifierNamespace & (IDNS_Tag | IDNS_Ordinary) ?
FOK_Declared : FOK_Undeclared);
}
@@ -886,11 +886,11 @@ public:
}
DeclContext *getLookupParent();
-
+
const DeclContext *getLookupParent() const {
return const_cast<DeclContext*>(this)->getLookupParent();
}
-
+
ASTContext &getParentASTContext() const {
return cast<Decl>(this)->getASTContext();
}
@@ -1141,13 +1141,13 @@ public:
return tmp;
}
- friend bool
- operator==(const specific_decl_iterator& x, const specific_decl_iterator& y) {
+ friend bool operator==(const specific_decl_iterator& x,
+ const specific_decl_iterator& y) {
return x.Current == y.Current;
}
- friend bool
- operator!=(const specific_decl_iterator& x, const specific_decl_iterator& y) {
+ friend bool operator!=(const specific_decl_iterator& x,
+ const specific_decl_iterator& y) {
return x.Current != y.Current;
}
};
@@ -1215,13 +1215,13 @@ public:
return tmp;
}
- friend bool
- operator==(const filtered_decl_iterator& x, const filtered_decl_iterator& y) {
+ friend bool operator==(const filtered_decl_iterator& x,
+ const filtered_decl_iterator& y) {
return x.Current == y.Current;
}
- friend bool
- operator!=(const filtered_decl_iterator& x, const filtered_decl_iterator& y) {
+ friend bool operator!=(const filtered_decl_iterator& x,
+ const filtered_decl_iterator& y) {
return x.Current != y.Current;
}
};
@@ -1283,12 +1283,12 @@ public:
/// \brief A simplistic name lookup mechanism that performs name lookup
/// into this declaration context without consulting the external source.
///
- /// This function should almost never be used, because it subverts the
+ /// This function should almost never be used, because it subverts the
/// usual relationship between a DeclContext and the external source.
/// See the ASTImporter for the (few, but important) use cases.
- void localUncachedLookup(DeclarationName Name,
+ void localUncachedLookup(DeclarationName Name,
llvm::SmallVectorImpl<NamedDecl *> &Results);
-
+
/// @brief Makes a declaration visible within this context.
///
/// This routine makes the declaration D visible to name lookup
@@ -1360,7 +1360,7 @@ public:
bool isDeclInLexicalTraversal(const Decl *D) const {
return D && (D->NextDeclInContext || D == FirstDecl || D == LastDecl);
}
-
+
static bool classof(const Decl *D);
static bool classof(const DeclContext *D) { return true; }
#define DECL(NAME, BASE)
@@ -1372,8 +1372,8 @@ public:
private:
void LoadLexicalDeclsFromExternalStorage() const;
-
- /// @brief Makes a declaration visible within this context, but
+
+ /// @brief Makes a declaration visible within this context, but
/// suppresses searches for external declarations with the same
/// name.
///
@@ -1386,7 +1386,8 @@ private:
StoredDeclsMap *CreateStoredDeclsMap(ASTContext &C) const;
void buildLookup(DeclContext *DCtx);
- void makeDeclVisibleInContextWithFlags(NamedDecl *D, bool Internal, bool Recoverable);
+ void makeDeclVisibleInContextWithFlags(NamedDecl *D, bool Internal,
+ bool Recoverable);
void makeDeclVisibleInContextImpl(NamedDecl *D, bool Internal);
};
diff --git a/include/clang/AST/DeclCXX.h b/include/clang/AST/DeclCXX.h
index e2313785bf..ca416771a0 100644
--- a/include/clang/AST/DeclCXX.h
+++ b/include/clang/AST/DeclCXX.h
@@ -36,7 +36,7 @@ class CXXMemberLookupCriteria;
class CXXFinalOverriderMap;
class CXXIndirectPrimaryBaseSet;
class FriendDecl;
-
+
/// \brief Represents any kind of function declaration, whether it is a
/// concrete function or a function template.
class AnyFunctionDecl {
@@ -170,7 +170,7 @@ class CXXBaseSpecifier {
/// \brief The source location of the ellipsis, if this is a pack
/// expansion.
SourceLocation EllipsisLoc;
-
+
/// Virtual - Whether this is a virtual base class or not.
bool Virtual : 1;
@@ -200,7 +200,7 @@ public:
CXXBaseSpecifier(SourceRange R, bool V, bool BC, AccessSpecifier A,
TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc)
- : Range(R), EllipsisLoc(EllipsisLoc), Virtual(V), BaseOfClass(BC),
+ : Range(R), EllipsisLoc(EllipsisLoc), Virtual(V), BaseOfClass(BC),
Access(A), InheritConstructors(false), BaseTypeInfo(TInfo) { }
/// getSourceRange - Retrieves the source range that contains the
@@ -214,7 +214,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Determine whether this base class is a base of a class declared
/// with the 'class' keyword (vs. one declared with the 'struct' keyword).
bool isBaseOfClass() const { return BaseOfClass; }
-
+
/// \brief Determine whether this base specifier is a pack expansion.
bool isPackExpansion() const { return EllipsisLoc.isValid(); }
@@ -319,7 +319,8 @@ class CXXRecordDecl : public RecordDecl {
/// * has no non-static data members of type non-standard-layout class (or
/// array of such types) or reference,
/// * has no virtual functions (10.3) and no virtual base classes (10.1),
- /// * has the same access control (Clause 11) for all non-static data members
+ /// * has the same access control (Clause 11) for all non-static data
+ /// members
/// * has no non-standard-layout base classes,
/// * either has no non-static data members in the most derived class and at
/// most one base class with non-static data members, or has no base
@@ -346,7 +347,7 @@ class CXXRecordDecl : public RecordDecl {
/// \brief True if this class (or any subobject) has mutable fields.
bool HasMutableFields : 1;
-
+
/// HasTrivialDefaultConstructor - True when, if this class has a default
/// constructor, this default constructor is trivial.
///
@@ -458,13 +459,13 @@ class CXXRecordDecl : public RecordDecl {
/// \brief Whether we have already declared the move constructor.
bool DeclaredMoveConstructor : 1;
-
+
/// \brief Whether we have already declared the copy-assignment operator.
bool DeclaredCopyAssignment : 1;
/// \brief Whether we have already declared the move-assignment operator.
bool DeclaredMoveAssignment : 1;
-
+
/// \brief Whether we have already declared a destructor within the class.
bool DeclaredDestructor : 1;
@@ -478,7 +479,7 @@ class CXXRecordDecl : public RecordDecl {
/// NumBases - The number of base class specifiers in Bases.
unsigned NumBases;
-
+
/// NumVBases - The number of virtual base class specifiers in VBases.
unsigned NumVBases;
@@ -510,12 +511,12 @@ class CXXRecordDecl : public RecordDecl {
/// in reverse order.
FriendDecl *FirstFriend;
- /// \brief Retrieve the set of direct base classes.
+ /// \brief Retrieve the set of direct base classes.
CXXBaseSpecifier *getBases() const {
return Bases.get(Definition->getASTContext().getExternalSource());
}
- /// \brief Retrieve the set of virtual base classes.
+ /// \brief Retrieve the set of virtual base classes.
CXXBaseSpecifier *getVBases() const {
return VBases.get(Definition->getASTContext().getExternalSource());
}
@@ -530,7 +531,7 @@ class CXXRecordDecl : public RecordDecl {
assert(DefinitionData && "queried property of class with no definition");
return *DefinitionData;
}
-
+
/// \brief The template or declaration that this declaration
/// describes or was instantiated from, respectively.
///
@@ -538,25 +539,25 @@ class CXXRecordDecl : public RecordDecl {
/// declarations that describe a class template, this will be a
/// pointer to a ClassTemplateDecl. For member
/// classes of class template specializations, this will be the
- /// MemberSpecializationInfo referring to the member class that was
+ /// MemberSpecializationInfo referring to the member class that was
/// instantiated or specialized.
llvm::PointerUnion<ClassTemplateDecl*, MemberSpecializationInfo*>
TemplateOrInstantiation;
friend class DeclContext;
-
+
/// \brief Notify the class that member has been added.
///
- /// This routine helps maintain information about the class based on which
+ /// This routine helps maintain information about the class based on which
/// members have been added. It will be invoked by DeclContext::addDecl()
/// whenever a member is added to this record.
void addedMember(Decl *D);
void markedVirtualFunctionPure();
friend void FunctionDecl::setPure(bool);
-
+
friend class ASTNodeImporter;
-
+
protected:
CXXRecordDecl(Kind K, TagKind TK, DeclContext *DC,
SourceLocation StartLoc, SourceLocation IdLoc,
@@ -587,7 +588,7 @@ public:
virtual const CXXRecordDecl *getCanonicalDecl() const {
return cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordDecl::getCanonicalDecl());
}
-
+
const CXXRecordDecl *getPreviousDeclaration() const {
return cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordDecl::getPreviousDeclaration());
}
@@ -706,7 +707,7 @@ public:
///
/// This value is used for lazy creation of default constructors.
bool needsImplicitDefaultConstructor() const {
- return !data().UserDeclaredConstructor &&
+ return !data().UserDeclaredConstructor &&
!data().DeclaredDefaultConstructor;
}
@@ -724,11 +725,11 @@ public:
CXXConstructorDecl *getCopyConstructor(unsigned TypeQuals) const;
/// getMoveConstructor - Returns the move constructor for this class
- CXXConstructorDecl *getMoveConstructor() const;
+ CXXConstructorDecl *getMoveConstructor() const;
/// \brief Retrieve the copy-assignment operator for this class, if available.
///
- /// This routine attempts to find the copy-assignment operator for this
+ /// This routine attempts to find the copy-assignment operator for this
/// class, using a simplistic form of overload resolution.
///
/// \param ArgIsConst Whether the argument to the copy-assignment operator
@@ -741,7 +742,7 @@ public:
/// getMoveAssignmentOperator - Returns the move assignment operator for this
/// class
CXXMethodDecl *getMoveAssignmentOperator() const;
-
+
/// hasUserDeclaredConstructor - Whether this class has any
/// user-declared constructors. When true, a default constructor
/// will not be implicitly declared.
@@ -762,7 +763,7 @@ public:
return data().UserDeclaredCopyConstructor;
}
- /// \brief Determine whether this class has had its copy constructor
+ /// \brief Determine whether this class has had its copy constructor
/// declared, either via the user or via an implicit declaration.
///
/// This value is used for lazy creation of copy constructors.
@@ -824,7 +825,7 @@ public:
return data().UserDeclaredCopyAssignment;
}
- /// \brief Determine whether this class has had its copy assignment operator
+ /// \brief Determine whether this class has had its copy assignment operator
/// declared, either via the user or via an implicit declaration.
///
/// This value is used for lazy creation of copy assignment operators.
@@ -943,7 +944,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Whether this class, or any of its class subobjects, contains a
/// mutable field.
bool hasMutableFields() const { return data().HasMutableFields; }
-
+
// hasTrivialDefaultConstructor - Whether this class has a trivial default
// constructor
// (C++0x [class.ctor]p5)
@@ -1045,12 +1046,12 @@ public:
/// X<int>::A is required, it will be instantiated from the
/// declaration returned by getInstantiatedFromMemberClass().
CXXRecordDecl *getInstantiatedFromMemberClass() const;
-
+
/// \brief If this class is an instantiation of a member class of a
/// class template specialization, retrieves the member specialization
/// information.
MemberSpecializationInfo *getMemberSpecializationInfo() const;
-
+
/// \brief Specify that this record is an instantiation of the
/// member class RD.
void setInstantiationOfMemberClass(CXXRecordDecl *RD,
@@ -1079,7 +1080,7 @@ public:
/// instantiation of a class template or member class of a class template,
/// and how it was instantiated or specialized.
TemplateSpecializationKind getTemplateSpecializationKind() const;
-
+
/// \brief Set the kind of specialization or template instantiation this is.
void setTemplateSpecializationKind(TemplateSpecializationKind TSK);
@@ -1106,7 +1107,7 @@ public:
///
/// \returns true if this class is derived from Base, false otherwise.
bool isDerivedFrom(const CXXRecordDecl *Base) const;
-
+
/// \brief Determine whether this class is derived from the type \p Base.
///
/// This routine only determines whether this class is derived from \p Base,
@@ -1121,8 +1122,8 @@ public:
///
/// \returns true if this class is derived from Base, false otherwise.
///
- /// \todo add a separate paramaeter to configure IsDerivedFrom, rather than
- /// tangling input and output in \p Paths
+ /// \todo add a separate paramaeter to configure IsDerivedFrom, rather than
+ /// tangling input and output in \p Paths
bool isDerivedFrom(const CXXRecordDecl *Base, CXXBasePaths &Paths) const;
/// \brief Determine whether this class is virtually derived from
@@ -1157,20 +1158,20 @@ public:
///
/// The class itself does not count as a base class. This routine
/// returns false if the class has non-computable base classes.
- ///
+ ///
/// \param AllowShortCircuit if false, forces the callback to be called
/// for every base class, even if a dependent or non-matching base was
/// found.
bool forallBases(ForallBasesCallback *BaseMatches, void *UserData,
bool AllowShortCircuit = true) const;
-
- /// \brief Function type used by lookupInBases() to determine whether a
+
+ /// \brief Function type used by lookupInBases() to determine whether a
/// specific base class subobject matches the lookup criteria.
///
- /// \param Specifier the base-class specifier that describes the inheritance
+ /// \param Specifier the base-class specifier that describes the inheritance
/// from the base class we are trying to match.
///
- /// \param Path the current path, from the most-derived class down to the
+ /// \param Path the current path, from the most-derived class down to the
/// base named by the \p Specifier.
///
/// \param UserData a single pointer to user-specified data, provided to
@@ -1180,13 +1181,13 @@ public:
typedef bool BaseMatchesCallback(const CXXBaseSpecifier *Specifier,
CXXBasePath &Path,
void *UserData);
-
+
/// \brief Look for entities within the base classes of this C++ class,
/// transitively searching all base class subobjects.
///
- /// This routine uses the callback function \p BaseMatches to find base
+ /// This routine uses the callback function \p BaseMatches to find base
/// classes meeting some search criteria, walking all base class subobjects
- /// and populating the given \p Paths structure with the paths through the
+ /// and populating the given \p Paths structure with the paths through the
/// inheritance hierarchy that resulted in a match. On a successful search,
/// the \p Paths structure can be queried to retrieve the matching paths and
/// to determine if there were any ambiguities.
@@ -1203,7 +1204,7 @@ public:
/// subobject that matches the search criteria.
bool lookupInBases(BaseMatchesCallback *BaseMatches, void *UserData,
CXXBasePaths &Paths) const;
-
+
/// \brief Base-class lookup callback that determines whether the given
/// base class specifier refers to a specific class declaration.
///
@@ -1225,7 +1226,7 @@ public:
/// are searching for.
static bool FindVirtualBaseClass(const CXXBaseSpecifier *Specifier,
CXXBasePath &Path, void *BaseRecord);
-
+
/// \brief Base-class lookup callback that determines whether there exists
/// a tag with the given name.
///
@@ -1243,7 +1244,7 @@ public:
/// is an opaque \c DeclarationName pointer.
static bool FindOrdinaryMember(const CXXBaseSpecifier *Specifier,
CXXBasePath &Path, void *Name);
-
+
/// \brief Base-class lookup callback that determines whether there exists
/// a member with the given name that can be used in a nested-name-specifier.
///
@@ -1279,15 +1280,15 @@ public:
/// \brief Indicates that the definition of this class is now complete.
virtual void completeDefinition();
- /// \brief Indicates that the definition of this class is now complete,
+ /// \brief Indicates that the definition of this class is now complete,
/// and provides a final overrider map to help determine
- ///
+ ///
/// \param FinalOverriders The final overrider map for this class, which can
/// be provided as an optimization for abstract-class checking. If NULL,
/// final overriders will be computed if they are needed to complete the
/// definition.
void completeDefinition(CXXFinalOverriderMap *FinalOverriders);
-
+
/// \brief Determine whether this class may end up being abstract, even though
/// it is not yet known to be abstract.
///
@@ -1296,7 +1297,7 @@ public:
/// will need to compute final overriders to determine whether the class is
/// actually abstract.
bool mayBeAbstract() const;
-
+
static bool classof(const Decl *D) { return classofKind(D->getKind()); }
static bool classofKind(Kind K) {
return K >= firstCXXRecord && K <= lastCXXRecord;
@@ -1343,12 +1344,12 @@ public:
bool isInstance() const { return !isStatic(); }
bool isVirtual() const {
- CXXMethodDecl *CD =
+ CXXMethodDecl *CD =
cast<CXXMethodDecl>(const_cast<CXXMethodDecl*>(this)->getCanonicalDecl());
if (CD->isVirtualAsWritten())
return true;
-
+
return (CD->begin_overridden_methods() != CD->end_overridden_methods());
}
@@ -1356,14 +1357,14 @@ public:
/// (C++ [basic.stc.dynamic.deallocation]p2), which is an overloaded
/// delete or delete[] operator with a particular signature.
bool isUsualDeallocationFunction() const;
-
+
/// \brief Determine whether this is a copy-assignment operator, regardless
/// of whether it was declared implicitly or explicitly.
bool isCopyAssignmentOperator() const;
/// \brief Determine whether this is a move assignment operator.
bool isMoveAssignmentOperator() const;
-
+
const CXXMethodDecl *getCanonicalDecl() const {
return cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionDecl::getCanonicalDecl());
}
@@ -1376,7 +1377,7 @@ public:
bool isUserProvided() const {
return !(isDeleted() || getCanonicalDecl()->isDefaulted());
}
-
+
///
void addOverriddenMethod(const CXXMethodDecl *MD);
@@ -1421,7 +1422,7 @@ public:
RefQualifierKind getRefQualifier() const {
return getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()->getRefQualifier();
}
-
+
bool hasInlineBody() const;
// Implement isa/cast/dyncast/etc.
@@ -1448,23 +1449,23 @@ public:
/// @endcode
class CXXCtorInitializer {
/// \brief Either the base class name/delegating constructor type (stored as
- /// a TypeSourceInfo*), an normal field (FieldDecl), or an anonymous field
+ /// a TypeSourceInfo*), an normal field (FieldDecl), or an anonymous field
/// (IndirectFieldDecl*) being initialized.
llvm::PointerUnion3<TypeSourceInfo *, FieldDecl *, IndirectFieldDecl *>
Initializee;
-
+
/// \brief The source location for the field name or, for a base initializer
/// pack expansion, the location of the ellipsis. In the case of a delegating
/// constructor, it will still include the type's source location as the
/// Initializee points to the CXXConstructorDecl (to allow loop detection).
SourceLocation MemberOrEllipsisLocation;
-
+
/// \brief The argument used to initialize the base or member, which may
/// end up constructing an object (when multiple arguments are involved).
- /// If 0, this is a field initializer, and the in-class member initializer
+ /// If 0, this is a field initializer, and the in-class member initializer
/// will be used.
Stmt *Init;
-
+
/// LParenLoc - Location of the left paren of the ctor-initializer.
SourceLocation LParenLoc;
@@ -1474,7 +1475,7 @@ class CXXCtorInitializer {
/// \brief If the initializee is a type, whether that type makes this
/// a delegating initialization.
bool IsDelegating : 1;
-
+
/// IsVirtual - If the initializer is a base initializer, this keeps track
/// of whether the base is virtual or not.
bool IsVirtual : 1;
@@ -1493,7 +1494,7 @@ class CXXCtorInitializer {
CXXCtorInitializer(ASTContext &Context, FieldDecl *Member,
SourceLocation MemberLoc, SourceLocation L, Expr *Init,
SourceLocation R, VarDecl **Indices, unsigned NumIndices);
-
+
public:
/// CXXCtorInitializer - Creates a new base-class initializer.
explicit
@@ -1518,24 +1519,24 @@ public:
CXXCtorInitializer(ASTContext &Context, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
SourceLocation L, Expr *Init, SourceLocation R);
- /// \brief Creates a new member initializer that optionally contains
+ /// \brief Creates a new member initializer that optionally contains
/// array indices used to describe an elementwise initialization.
static CXXCtorInitializer *Create(ASTContext &Context, FieldDecl *Member,
SourceLocation MemberLoc, SourceLocation L,
Expr *Init, SourceLocation R,
VarDecl **Indices, unsigned NumIndices);
-
+
/// isBaseInitializer - Returns true when this initializer is
/// initializing a base class.
- bool isBaseInitializer() const {
- return Initializee.is<TypeSourceInfo*>() && !IsDelegating;
+ bool isBaseInitializer() const {
+ return Initializee.is<TypeSourceInfo*>() && !IsDelegating;
}
/// isMemberInitializer - Returns true when this initializer is
/// initializing a non-static data member.
bool isMemberInitializer() const { return Initializee.is<FieldDecl*>(); }
- bool isAnyMemberInitializer() const {
+ bool isAnyMemberInitializer() const {
return isMemberInitializer() || isIndirectMemberInitializer();
}
@@ -1553,21 +1554,21 @@ public:
/// isDelegatingInitializer - Returns true when this initializer is creating
/// a delegating constructor.
bool isDelegatingInitializer() const {
- return Initializee.is<TypeSourceInfo*>() && IsDelegating;
+ return Initializee.is<TypeSourceInfo*>() && IsDelegating;
}
/// \brief Determine whether this initializer is a pack expansion.
- bool isPackExpansion() const {
- return isBaseInitializer() && MemberOrEllipsisLocation.isValid();
+ bool isPackExpansion() const {
+ return isBaseInitializer() && MemberOrEllipsisLocation.isValid();
}
-
+
// \brief For a pack expansion, returns the location of the ellipsis.
SourceLocation getEllipsisLoc() const {
assert(isPackExpansion() && "Initializer is not a pack expansion");
return MemberOrEllipsisLocation;
}
-
- /// If this is a base class initializer, returns the type of the
+
+ /// If this is a base class initializer, returns the type of the
/// base class with location information. Otherwise, returns an NULL
/// type location.
TypeLoc getBaseClassLoc() const;
@@ -1579,7 +1580,7 @@ public:
/// Returns whether the base is virtual or not.
bool isBaseVirtual() const {
assert(isBaseInitializer() && "Must call this on base initializer!");
-
+
return IsVirtual;
}
@@ -1588,7 +1589,7 @@ public:
TypeSourceInfo *getTypeSourceInfo() const {
return Initializee.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo *>();
}
-
+
/// getMember - If this is a member initializer, returns the
/// declaration of the non-static data member being
/// initialized. Otherwise, returns NULL.
@@ -1614,13 +1615,13 @@ public:
return 0;
}
- SourceLocation getMemberLocation() const {
+ SourceLocation getMemberLocation() const {
return MemberOrEllipsisLocation;
}
-
+
/// \brief Determine the source location of the initializer.
SourceLocation getSourceLocation() const;
-
+
/// \brief Determine the source range covering the entire initializer.
SourceRange getSourceRange() const;
@@ -1657,7 +1658,7 @@ public:
return IsWritten ? 0 : SourceOrderOrNumArrayIndices;
}
- /// \brief Retrieve a particular array index variable used to
+ /// \brief Retrieve a particular array index variable used to
/// describe an array member initialization.
VarDecl *getArrayIndex(unsigned I) {
assert(I < getNumArrayIndices() && "Out of bounds member array index");
@@ -1671,7 +1672,7 @@ public:
assert(I < getNumArrayIndices() && "Out of bounds member array index");
reinterpret_cast<VarDecl **>(this + 1)[I] = Index;
}
-
+
/// \brief Get the initializer. This is 0 if this is an in-class initializer
/// for a non-static data member which has not yet been parsed.
Expr *getInit() const {
@@ -1713,7 +1714,7 @@ class CXXConstructorDecl : public CXXMethodDecl {
CXXConstructorDecl(CXXRecordDecl *RD, SourceLocation StartLoc,
const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
QualType T, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
- bool isExplicitSpecified, bool isInline,
+ bool isExplicitSpecified, bool isInline,
bool isImplicitlyDeclared, bool isConstexpr)
: CXXMethodDecl(CXXConstructor, RD, StartLoc, NameInfo, T, TInfo, false,
SC_None, isInline, isConstexpr, SourceLocation()),
@@ -1735,7 +1736,7 @@ public:
/// isExplicitSpecified - Whether this constructor declaration has the
/// 'explicit' keyword specified.
bool isExplicitSpecified() const { return IsExplicitSpecified; }
-
+
/// isExplicit - Whether this constructor was marked "explicit" or not.
bool isExplicit() const {
return cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(getFirstDeclaration())
@@ -1783,7 +1784,8 @@ public:
}
typedef std::reverse_iterator<init_iterator> init_reverse_iterator;
- typedef std::reverse_iterator<init_const_iterator> init_const_reverse_iterator;
+ typedef std::reverse_iterator<init_const_iterator>
+ init_const_reverse_iterator;
init_reverse_iterator init_rbegin() {
return init_reverse_iterator(init_end());
@@ -1899,12 +1901,12 @@ public:
CXXConstructorDecl *getCanonicalDecl() {
return cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(FunctionDecl::getCanonicalDecl());
}
-
+
// Implement isa/cast/dyncast/etc.
static bool classof(const Decl *D) { return classofKind(D->getKind()); }
static bool classof(const CXXConstructorDecl *D) { return true; }
static bool classofKind(Kind K) { return K == CXXConstructor; }
-
+
friend class ASTDeclReader;
friend class ASTDeclWriter;
};
@@ -1928,7 +1930,7 @@ class CXXDestructorDecl : public CXXMethodDecl {
bool ImplicitlyDefined : 1;
FunctionDecl *OperatorDelete;
-
+
CXXDestructorDecl(CXXRecordDecl *RD, SourceLocation StartLoc,
const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
QualType T, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
@@ -1954,7 +1956,8 @@ public:
/// already been defined.
bool isImplicitlyDefined() const {
assert(isThisDeclarationADefinition() &&
- "Can only get the implicit-definition flag once the destructor has been defined");
+ "Can only get the implicit-definition flag once the destructor has "
+ "been defined");
return ImplicitlyDefined;
}
@@ -1962,7 +1965,8 @@ public:
/// implicitly defined or not.
void setImplicitlyDefined(bool ID) {
assert(isThisDeclarationADefinition() &&
- "Can only set the implicit-definition flag once the destructor has been defined");
+ "Can only set the implicit-definition flag once the destructor has "
+ "been defined");
ImplicitlyDefined = ID;
}
@@ -1973,7 +1977,7 @@ public:
static bool classof(const Decl *D) { return classofKind(D->getKind()); }
static bool classof(const CXXDestructorDecl *D) { return true; }
static bool classofKind(Kind K) { return K == CXXDestructor; }
-
+
friend class ASTDeclReader;
friend class ASTDeclWriter;
};
@@ -1988,7 +1992,7 @@ public:
/// };
/// @endcode
class CXXConversionDecl : public CXXMethodDecl {
- /// IsExplicitSpecified - Whether this conversion function declaration is
+ /// IsExplicitSpecified - Whether this conversion function declaration is
/// marked "explicit", meaning that it can only be applied when the user
/// explicitly wrote a cast. This is a C++0x feature.
bool IsExplicitSpecified : 1;
@@ -2012,7 +2016,7 @@ public:
bool isConstexpr,
SourceLocation EndLocation);
- /// IsExplicitSpecified - Whether this conversion function declaration is
+ /// IsExplicitSpecified - Whether this conversion function declaration is
/// marked "explicit", meaning that it can only be applied when the user
/// explicitly wrote a cast. This is a C++0x feature.
bool isExplicitSpecified() const { return IsExplicitSpecified; }
@@ -2035,7 +2039,7 @@ public:
static bool classof(const Decl *D) { return classofKind(D->getKind()); }
static bool classof(const CXXConversionDecl *D) { return true; }
static bool classofKind(Kind K) { return K == CXXConversion; }
-
+
friend class ASTDeclReader;
friend class ASTDeclWriter;
};
@@ -2121,7 +2125,7 @@ public:
class UsingDirectiveDecl : public NamedDecl {
/// \brief The location of the "using" keyword.
SourceLocation UsingLoc;
-
+
/// SourceLocation - Location of 'namespace' token.
SourceLocation NamespaceLoc;
@@ -2156,11 +2160,11 @@ public:
/// \brief Retrieve the nested-name-specifier that qualifies the
/// name of the namespace, with source-location information.
NestedNameSpecifierLoc getQualifierLoc() const { return QualifierLoc; }
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the nested-name-specifier that qualifies the
/// name of the namespace.
- NestedNameSpecifier *getQualifier() const {
- return QualifierLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier();
+ NestedNameSpecifier *getQualifier() const {
+ return QualifierLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier();
}
NamedDecl *getNominatedNamespaceAsWritten() { return NominatedNamespace; }
@@ -2182,7 +2186,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Return the location of the "using" keyword.
SourceLocation getUsingLoc() const { return UsingLoc; }
-
+
// FIXME: Could omit 'Key' in name.
/// getNamespaceKeyLocation - Returns location of namespace keyword.
SourceLocation getNamespaceKeyLocation() const { return NamespaceLoc; }
@@ -2201,14 +2205,14 @@ public:
SourceRange getSourceRange() const {
return SourceRange(UsingLoc, getLocation());
}
-
+
static bool classof(const Decl *D) { return classofKind(D->getKind()); }
static bool classof(const UsingDirectiveDecl *D) { return true; }
static bool classofKind(Kind K) { return K == UsingDirective; }
// Friend for getUsingDirectiveName.
friend class DeclContext;
-
+
friend class ASTDeclReader;
};
@@ -2223,10 +2227,10 @@ class NamespaceAliasDecl : public NamedDecl {
/// IdentLoc - Location of namespace identifier. Accessed by TargetNameLoc.
SourceLocation IdentLoc;
-
+
/// \brief The nested-name-specifier that precedes the namespace.
NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc;
-
+
/// Namespace - The Decl that this alias points to. Can either be a
/// NamespaceDecl or a NamespaceAliasDecl.
NamedDecl *Namespace;
@@ -2235,23 +2239,23 @@ class NamespaceAliasDecl : public NamedDecl {
SourceLocation AliasLoc, IdentifierInfo *Alias,
NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc,
SourceLocation IdentLoc, NamedDecl *Namespace)
- : NamedDecl(NamespaceAlias, DC, AliasLoc, Alias),
+ : NamedDecl(NamespaceAlias, DC, AliasLoc, Alias),
NamespaceLoc(NamespaceLoc), IdentLoc(IdentLoc),
QualifierLoc(QualifierLoc), Namespace(Namespace) { }
friend class ASTDeclReader;
-
+
public:
/// \brief Retrieve the nested-name-specifier that qualifies the
/// name of the namespace, with source-location information.
NestedNameSpecifierLoc getQualifierLoc() const { return QualifierLoc; }
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the nested-name-specifier that qualifies the
/// name of the namespace.
- NestedNameSpecifier *getQualifier() const {
- return QualifierLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier();
+ NestedNameSpecifier *getQualifier() const {
+ return QualifierLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier();
}
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the namespace declaration aliased by this directive.
NamespaceDecl *getNamespace() {
if (NamespaceAliasDecl *AD = dyn_cast<NamespaceAliasDecl>(Namespace))
@@ -2279,7 +2283,7 @@ public:
NamedDecl *getAliasedNamespace() const { return Namespace; }
static NamespaceAliasDecl *Create(ASTContext &C, DeclContext *DC,
- SourceLocation NamespaceLoc,
+ SourceLocation NamespaceLoc,
SourceLocation AliasLoc,
IdentifierInfo *Alias,
NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc,
@@ -2289,7 +2293,7 @@ public:
virtual SourceRange getSourceRange() const {
return SourceRange(NamespaceLoc, IdentLoc);
}
-
+
static bool classof(const Decl *D) { return classofKind(D->getKind()); }
static bool classof(const NamespaceAliasDecl *D) { return true; }
static bool classofKind(Kind K) { return K == NamespaceAlias; }
@@ -2383,7 +2387,7 @@ class UsingDecl : public NamedDecl {
// \brief Has 'typename' keyword.
bool IsTypeName;
- UsingDecl(DeclContext *DC, SourceLocation UL,
+ UsingDecl(DeclContext *DC, SourceLocation UL,
NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc,
const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, bool IsTypeNameArg)
: NamedDecl(Using, DC, NameInfo.getLoc(), NameInfo.getName()),
@@ -2403,8 +2407,8 @@ public:
NestedNameSpecifierLoc getQualifierLoc() const { return QualifierLoc; }
/// \brief Retrieve the nested-name-specifier that qualifies the name.
- NestedNameSpecifier *getQualifier() const {
- return QualifierLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier();
+ NestedNameSpecifier *getQualifier() const {
+ return QualifierLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier();
}
DeclarationNameInfo getNameInfo() const {
@@ -2507,7 +2511,7 @@ class UnresolvedUsingValueDecl : public ValueDecl {
DeclarationNameLoc DNLoc;
UnresolvedUsingValueDecl(DeclContext *DC, QualType Ty,
- SourceLocation UsingLoc,
+ SourceLocation UsingLoc,
NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc,
const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo)
: ValueDecl(UnresolvedUsingValue, DC,
@@ -2528,17 +2532,17 @@ public:
NestedNameSpecifierLoc getQualifierLoc() const { return QualifierLoc; }
/// \brief Retrieve the nested-name-specifier that qualifies the name.
- NestedNameSpecifier *getQualifier() const {
- return QualifierLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier();
+ NestedNameSpecifier *getQualifier() const {
+ return QualifierLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier();
}
-
+
DeclarationNameInfo getNameInfo() const {
return DeclarationNameInfo(getDeclName(), getLocation(), DNLoc);
}
static UnresolvedUsingValueDecl *
Create(ASTContext &C, DeclContext *DC, SourceLocation UsingLoc,
- NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc,
+ NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc,
const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo);
SourceRange getSourceRange() const {
@@ -2575,14 +2579,14 @@ class UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl : public TypeDecl {
UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl(DeclContext *DC, SourceLocation UsingLoc,
SourceLocation TypenameLoc,
NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc,
- SourceLocation TargetNameLoc,
+ SourceLocation TargetNameLoc,
IdentifierInfo *TargetName)
: TypeDecl(UnresolvedUsingTypename, DC, TargetNameLoc, TargetName,
UsingLoc),
TypenameLocation(TypenameLoc), QualifierLoc(QualifierLoc) { }
friend class ASTDeclReader;
-
+
public:
/// \brief Returns the source location of the 'using' keyword.
SourceLocation getUsingLoc() const { return getLocStart(); }
@@ -2595,8 +2599,8 @@ public:
NestedNameSpecifierLoc getQualifierLoc() const { return QualifierLoc; }
/// \brief Retrieve the nested-name-specifier that qualifies the name.
- NestedNameSpecifier *getQualifier() const {
- return QualifierLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier();
+ NestedNameSpecifier *getQualifier() const {
+ return QualifierLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier();
}
static UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *
diff --git a/include/clang/AST/DeclObjC.h b/include/clang/AST/DeclObjC.h
index b717af0d01..a428e77312 100644
--- a/include/clang/AST/DeclObjC.h
+++ b/include/clang/AST/DeclObjC.h
@@ -84,7 +84,7 @@ public:
loc_iterator loc_begin() const { return Locations; }
loc_iterator loc_end() const { return Locations + size(); }
- void set(ObjCProtocolDecl* const* InList, unsigned Elts,
+ void set(ObjCProtocolDecl* const* InList, unsigned Elts,
const SourceLocation *Locs, ASTContext &Ctx);
};
@@ -124,7 +124,7 @@ private:
// Synthesized declaration method for a property setter/getter
unsigned IsSynthesized : 1;
-
+
// Method has a definition.
unsigned IsDefined : 1;
@@ -144,14 +144,14 @@ private:
/// \brief Indicates whether this method has a related result type.
unsigned RelatedResultType : 1;
-
+
/// \brief Whether the locations of the selector identifiers are in a
/// "standard" position, a enum SelectorLocationsKind.
unsigned SelLocsKind : 2;
// Result type of this method.
QualType MethodDeclType;
-
+
// Type source information for the result type.
TypeSourceInfo *ResultTInfo;
@@ -246,7 +246,7 @@ public:
SourceLocation beginLoc,
SourceLocation endLoc,
Selector SelInfo,
- QualType T,
+ QualType T,
TypeSourceInfo *ResultTInfo,
DeclContext *contextDecl,
bool isInstance = true,
@@ -270,14 +270,14 @@ public:
/// \brief Determine whether this method has a result type that is related
/// to the message receiver's type.
bool hasRelatedResultType() const { return RelatedResultType; }
-
+
/// \brief Note whether this method has a related result type.
void SetRelatedResultType(bool RRT = true) { RelatedResultType = RRT; }
/// \brief True if this is a method redeclaration in the same interface.
bool isRedeclaration() const { return IsRedeclaration; }
void setAsRedeclaration(const ObjCMethodDecl *PrevMethod);
-
+
// Location information, modeled after the Stmt API.
SourceLocation getLocStart() const { return getLocation(); }
SourceLocation getLocEnd() const { return EndLoc; }
@@ -319,12 +319,12 @@ public:
QualType getResultType() const { return MethodDeclType; }
void setResultType(QualType T) { MethodDeclType = T; }
- /// \brief Determine the type of an expression that sends a message to this
+ /// \brief Determine the type of an expression that sends a message to this
/// function.
QualType getSendResultType() const {
return getResultType().getNonLValueExprType(getASTContext());
}
-
+
TypeSourceInfo *getResultTypeSourceInfo() const { return ResultTInfo; }
void setResultTypeSourceInfo(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) { ResultTInfo = TInfo; }
@@ -338,8 +338,8 @@ public:
param_iterator param_end() { return getParams() + NumParams; }
// This method returns and of the parameters which are part of the selector
// name mangling requirements.
- param_const_iterator sel_param_end() const {
- return param_begin() + getSelector().getNumArgs();
+ param_const_iterator sel_param_end() const {
+ return param_begin() + getSelector().getNumArgs();
}
/// \brief Sets the method's parameters and selector source locations.
@@ -385,7 +385,7 @@ public:
bool isSynthesized() const { return IsSynthesized; }
void setSynthesized(bool isSynth) { IsSynthesized = isSynth; }
-
+
bool isDefined() const { return IsDefined; }
void setDefined(bool isDefined) { IsDefined = isDefined; }
@@ -551,7 +551,7 @@ class ObjCInterfaceDecl : public ObjCContainerDecl {
/// Protocols referenced in the @interface declaration
ObjCProtocolList ReferencedProtocols;
-
+
/// Protocols reference in both the @interface and class extensions.
ObjCList<ObjCProtocolDecl> AllReferencedProtocols;
@@ -561,7 +561,7 @@ class ObjCInterfaceDecl : public ObjCContainerDecl {
/// and class extensions come long after the initial interface declaration,
/// and we avoid dynamically-resized arrays in the AST wherever possible.
ObjCCategoryDecl *CategoryList;
-
+
/// IvarList - List of all ivars defined by this class; including class
/// extensions and implementation. This list is built lazily.
ObjCIvarDecl *IvarList;
@@ -573,11 +573,11 @@ class ObjCInterfaceDecl : public ObjCContainerDecl {
bool InitiallyForwardDecl : 1;
bool ForwardDecl:1; // declared with @class.
bool InternalInterface:1; // true - no @interface for @implementation
-
+
/// \brief Indicates that the contents of this Objective-C class will be
/// completed by the external AST source when required.
mutable bool ExternallyCompleted : 1;
-
+
SourceLocation SuperClassLoc; // location of the super class identifier.
SourceLocation EndLoc; // marks the '>', '}', or identifier.
@@ -598,16 +598,16 @@ public:
return SourceRange(getAtStartLoc(), getLocation());
return ObjCContainerDecl::getSourceRange();
}
-
+
/// \brief Indicate that this Objective-C class is complete, but that
/// the external AST source will be responsible for filling in its contents
/// when a complete class is required.
void setExternallyCompleted();
-
+
const ObjCProtocolList &getReferencedProtocols() const {
if (ExternallyCompleted)
LoadExternalDefinition();
-
+
return ReferencedProtocols;
}
@@ -625,7 +625,7 @@ public:
}
typedef ObjCProtocolList::iterator protocol_iterator;
-
+
protocol_iterator protocol_begin() const {
if (ExternallyCompleted)
LoadExternalDefinition();
@@ -641,22 +641,22 @@ public:
typedef ObjCProtocolList::loc_iterator protocol_loc_iterator;
- protocol_loc_iterator protocol_loc_begin() const {
+ protocol_loc_iterator protocol_loc_begin() const {
if (ExternallyCompleted)
LoadExternalDefinition();
- return ReferencedProtocols.loc_begin();
+ return ReferencedProtocols.loc_begin();
}
- protocol_loc_iterator protocol_loc_end() const {
+ protocol_loc_iterator protocol_loc_end() const {
if (ExternallyCompleted)
LoadExternalDefinition();
- return ReferencedProtocols.loc_end();
+ return ReferencedProtocols.loc_end();
}
-
+
typedef ObjCList<ObjCProtocolDecl>::iterator all_protocol_iterator;
-
+
all_protocol_iterator all_referenced_protocol_begin() const {
if (ExternallyCompleted)
LoadExternalDefinition();
@@ -668,7 +668,7 @@ public:
if (ExternallyCompleted)
LoadExternalDefinition();
- return AllReferencedProtocols.empty() ? protocol_end()
+ return AllReferencedProtocols.empty() ? protocol_end()
: AllReferencedProtocols.end();
}
@@ -680,9 +680,9 @@ public:
unsigned ivar_size() const {
return std::distance(ivar_begin(), ivar_end());
}
-
+
bool ivar_empty() const { return ivar_begin() == ivar_end(); }
-
+
ObjCIvarDecl *all_declared_ivar_begin();
const ObjCIvarDecl *all_declared_ivar_begin() const {
// Even though this modifies IvarList, it's conceptually const:
@@ -690,7 +690,7 @@ public:
return const_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl *>(this)->all_declared_ivar_begin();
}
void setIvarList(ObjCIvarDecl *ivar) { IvarList = ivar; }
-
+
/// setProtocolList - Set the list of protocols that this interface
/// implements.
void setProtocolList(ObjCProtocolDecl *const* List, unsigned Num,
@@ -700,7 +700,7 @@ public:
/// mergeClassExtensionProtocolList - Merge class extension's protocol list
/// into the protocol list for this class.
- void mergeClassExtensionProtocolList(ObjCProtocolDecl *const* List,
+ void mergeClassExtensionProtocolList(ObjCProtocolDecl *const* List,
unsigned Num,
ASTContext &C);
@@ -712,26 +712,26 @@ public:
bool isForwardDecl() const { return ForwardDecl; }
void setForwardDecl(bool val) { ForwardDecl = val; }
- ObjCInterfaceDecl *getSuperClass() const {
+ ObjCInterfaceDecl *getSuperClass() const {
if (ExternallyCompleted)
LoadExternalDefinition();
- return SuperClass;
+ return SuperClass;
}
-
+
void setSuperClass(ObjCInterfaceDecl * superCls) { SuperClass = superCls; }
- ObjCCategoryDecl* getCategoryList() const {
+ ObjCCategoryDecl* getCategoryList() const {
if (ExternallyCompleted)
LoadExternalDefinition();
- return CategoryList;
+ return CategoryList;
}
-
+
void setCategoryList(ObjCCategoryDecl *category) {
CategoryList = category;
}
-
+
ObjCCategoryDecl* getFirstClassExtension() const;
ObjCPropertyDecl
@@ -758,7 +758,7 @@ public:
return true;
Class = Class->getSuperClass();
}
- return false;
+ return false;
}
ObjCIvarDecl *lookupInstanceVariable(IdentifierInfo *IVarName,
@@ -778,7 +778,7 @@ public:
return lookupMethod(Sel, false/*isInstance*/);
}
ObjCInterfaceDecl *lookupInheritedClass(const IdentifierInfo *ICName);
-
+
// Lookup a method in the classes implementation hierarchy.
ObjCMethodDecl *lookupPrivateMethod(const Selector &Sel, bool Instance=true);
@@ -858,7 +858,7 @@ public:
/// interface the ivar is conceptually a part of in the case of synthesized
/// ivars.
const ObjCInterfaceDecl *getContainingInterface() const;
-
+
ObjCIvarDecl *getNextIvar() { return NextIvar; }
const ObjCIvarDecl *getNextIvar() const { return NextIvar; }
void setNextIvar(ObjCIvarDecl *ivar) { NextIvar = ivar; }
@@ -873,16 +873,16 @@ public:
void setSynthesize(bool synth) { Synthesized = synth; }
bool getSynthesize() const { return Synthesized; }
-
+
// Implement isa/cast/dyncast/etc.
static bool classof(const Decl *D) { return classofKind(D->getKind()); }
static bool classof(const ObjCIvarDecl *D) { return true; }
static bool classofKind(Kind K) { return K == ObjCIvar; }
private:
- /// NextIvar - Next Ivar in the list of ivars declared in class; class's
+ /// NextIvar - Next Ivar in the list of ivars declared in class; class's
/// extensions and class's implementation
ObjCIvarDecl *NextIvar;
-
+
// NOTE: VC++ treats enums as signed, avoid using the AccessControl enum
unsigned DeclAccess : 3;
unsigned Synthesized : 1;
@@ -967,11 +967,11 @@ public:
protocol_iterator protocol_begin() const {return ReferencedProtocols.begin();}
protocol_iterator protocol_end() const { return ReferencedProtocols.end(); }
typedef ObjCProtocolList::loc_iterator protocol_loc_iterator;
- protocol_loc_iterator protocol_loc_begin() const {
- return ReferencedProtocols.loc_begin();
+ protocol_loc_iterator protocol_loc_begin() const {
+ return ReferencedProtocols.loc_begin();
}
- protocol_loc_iterator protocol_loc_end() const {
- return ReferencedProtocols.loc_end();
+ protocol_loc_iterator protocol_loc_end() const {
+ return ReferencedProtocols.loc_end();
}
unsigned protocol_size() const { return ReferencedProtocols.size(); }
@@ -998,7 +998,7 @@ public:
/// Differs with \see isForwardDecl in that \see isForwardDecl will change to
/// false when we see the definition, but this will remain true.
bool isInitiallyForwardDecl() const { return InitiallyForwardDecl; }
-
+
bool isForwardDecl() const { return isForwardProtoDecl; }
void setForwardDecl(bool val) { isForwardProtoDecl = val; }
@@ -1033,18 +1033,20 @@ private:
ObjCClassRef *ForwardDecl;
ObjCClassDecl(DeclContext *DC, SourceLocation L,
- ObjCInterfaceDecl *const Elt, const SourceLocation Loc,
+ ObjCInterfaceDecl *const Elt, const SourceLocation Loc,
ASTContext &C);
public:
static ObjCClassDecl *Create(ASTContext &C, DeclContext *DC, SourceLocation L,
ObjCInterfaceDecl *const Elt = 0,
const SourceLocation Locs = SourceLocation());
-
- ObjCInterfaceDecl *getForwardInterfaceDecl() { return ForwardDecl->getInterface(); }
+
+ ObjCInterfaceDecl *getForwardInterfaceDecl() {
+ return ForwardDecl->getInterface();
+ }
ObjCClassRef *getForwardDecl() { return ForwardDecl; }
void setClass(ASTContext &C, ObjCInterfaceDecl*const Cls,
const SourceLocation Locs);
-
+
virtual SourceRange getSourceRange() const;
static bool classof(const Decl *D) { return classofKind(D->getKind()); }
@@ -1080,11 +1082,11 @@ public:
protocol_iterator protocol_begin() const {return ReferencedProtocols.begin();}
protocol_iterator protocol_end() const { return ReferencedProtocols.end(); }
typedef ObjCProtocolList::loc_iterator protocol_loc_iterator;
- protocol_loc_iterator protocol_loc_begin() const {
- return ReferencedProtocols.loc_begin();
+ protocol_loc_iterator protocol_loc_begin() const {
+ return ReferencedProtocols.loc_begin();
}
- protocol_loc_iterator protocol_loc_end() const {
- return ReferencedProtocols.loc_end();
+ protocol_loc_iterator protocol_loc_end() const {
+ return ReferencedProtocols.loc_end();
}
unsigned protocol_size() const { return ReferencedProtocols.size(); }
@@ -1133,7 +1135,7 @@ class ObjCCategoryDecl : public ObjCContainerDecl {
/// \brief The location of the category name in this declaration.
SourceLocation CategoryNameLoc;
- ObjCCategoryDecl(DeclContext *DC, SourceLocation AtLoc,
+ ObjCCategoryDecl(DeclContext *DC, SourceLocation AtLoc,
SourceLocation ClassNameLoc, SourceLocation CategoryNameLoc,
IdentifierInfo *Id, ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl)
: ObjCContainerDecl(ObjCCategory, DC, Id, ClassNameLoc, AtLoc),
@@ -1143,7 +1145,7 @@ class ObjCCategoryDecl : public ObjCContainerDecl {
public:
static ObjCCategoryDecl *Create(ASTContext &C, DeclContext *DC,
- SourceLocation AtLoc,
+ SourceLocation AtLoc,
SourceLocation ClassNameLoc,
SourceLocation CategoryNameLoc,
IdentifierInfo *Id,
@@ -1172,21 +1174,21 @@ public:
protocol_iterator protocol_end() const { return ReferencedProtocols.end(); }
unsigned protocol_size() const { return ReferencedProtocols.size(); }
typedef ObjCProtocolList::loc_iterator protocol_loc_iterator;
- protocol_loc_iterator protocol_loc_begin() const {
- return ReferencedProtocols.loc_begin();
+ protocol_loc_iterator protocol_loc_begin() const {
+ return ReferencedProtocols.loc_begin();
}
- protocol_loc_iterator protocol_loc_end() const {
- return ReferencedProtocols.loc_end();
+ protocol_loc_iterator protocol_loc_end() const {
+ return ReferencedProtocols.loc_end();
}
ObjCCategoryDecl *getNextClassCategory() const { return NextClassCategory; }
bool IsClassExtension() const { return getIdentifier() == 0; }
const ObjCCategoryDecl *getNextClassExtension() const;
-
+
bool hasSynthBitfield() const { return HasSynthBitfield; }
void setHasSynthBitfield (bool val) { HasSynthBitfield = val; }
-
+
typedef specific_decl_iterator<ObjCIvarDecl> ivar_iterator;
ivar_iterator ivar_begin() const {
return ivar_iterator(decls_begin());
@@ -1295,9 +1297,9 @@ public:
/// interface associated with this implementation.
/// FIXME: This is a bad API, we are overriding the NamedDecl::getIdentifier()
/// to mean something different. For example:
- /// ((NamedDecl *)SomeCategoryImplDecl)->getIdentifier()
- /// returns the class interface name, whereas
- /// ((ObjCCategoryImplDecl *)SomeCategoryImplDecl)->getIdentifier()
+ /// ((NamedDecl *)SomeCategoryImplDecl)->getIdentifier()
+ /// returns the class interface name, whereas
+ /// ((ObjCCategoryImplDecl *)SomeCategoryImplDecl)->getIdentifier()
/// returns the category name.
IdentifierInfo *getIdentifier() const {
return Id;
@@ -1363,10 +1365,10 @@ class ObjCImplementationDecl : public ObjCImplDecl {
/// true if class has a .cxx_[construct,destruct] method.
bool HasCXXStructors : 1;
-
+
/// true of class extension has at least one bitfield ivar.
bool HasSynthBitfield : 1;
-
+
ObjCImplementationDecl(DeclContext *DC,
ObjCInterfaceDecl *classInterface,
ObjCInterfaceDecl *superDecl,
@@ -1380,18 +1382,18 @@ public:
ObjCInterfaceDecl *superDecl,
SourceLocation nameLoc,
SourceLocation atStartLoc);
-
+
/// init_iterator - Iterates through the ivar initializer list.
typedef CXXCtorInitializer **init_iterator;
-
+
/// init_const_iterator - Iterates through the ivar initializer list.
typedef CXXCtorInitializer * const * init_const_iterator;
-
+
/// init_begin() - Retrieve an iterator to the first initializer.
init_iterator init_begin() { return IvarInitializers; }
/// begin() - Retrieve an iterator to the first initializer.
init_const_iterator init_begin() const { return IvarInitializers; }
-
+
/// init_end() - Retrieve an iterator past the last initializer.
init_iterator init_end() {
return IvarInitializers + NumIvarInitializers;
@@ -1404,21 +1406,21 @@ public:
unsigned getNumIvarInitializers() const {
return NumIvarInitializers;
}
-
+
void setNumIvarInitializers(unsigned numNumIvarInitializers) {
NumIvarInitializers = numNumIvarInitializers;
}
-
+
void setIvarInitializers(ASTContext &C,
CXXCtorInitializer ** initializers,
unsigned numInitializers);
bool hasCXXStructors() const { return HasCXXStructors; }
void setHasCXXStructors(bool val) { HasCXXStructors = val; }
-
+
bool hasSynthBitfield() const { return HasSynthBitfield; }
void setHasSynthBitfield (bool val) { HasSynthBitfield = val; }
-
+
/// getIdentifier - Get the identifier that names the class
/// interface associated with this implementation.
IdentifierInfo *getIdentifier() const {
@@ -1553,7 +1555,7 @@ private:
ObjCPropertyDecl(DeclContext *DC, SourceLocation L, IdentifierInfo *Id,
SourceLocation AtLocation, TypeSourceInfo *T)
: NamedDecl(ObjCProperty, DC, L, Id), AtLoc(AtLocation), DeclType(T),
- PropertyAttributes(OBJC_PR_noattr),
+ PropertyAttributes(OBJC_PR_noattr),
PropertyAttributesAsWritten(OBJC_PR_noattr),
PropertyImplementation(None),
GetterName(Selector()),
@@ -1567,7 +1569,7 @@ public:
PropertyControl propControl = None);
SourceLocation getAtLoc() const { return AtLoc; }
void setAtLoc(SourceLocation L) { AtLoc = L; }
-
+
TypeSourceInfo *getTypeSourceInfo() const { return DeclType; }
QualType getType() const { return DeclType->getType(); }
void setType(TypeSourceInfo *T) { DeclType = T; }
@@ -1588,11 +1590,11 @@ public:
OBJC_PR_unsafe_unretained | OBJC_PR_retain | OBJC_PR_strong |
OBJC_PR_weak);
}
-
+
void setPropertyAttributesAsWritten(PropertyAttributeKind PRVal) {
PropertyAttributesAsWritten = PRVal;
}
-
+
void makeitReadWriteAttribute(void) {
PropertyAttributes &= ~OBJC_PR_readonly;
PropertyAttributes |= OBJC_PR_readwrite;
@@ -1683,7 +1685,7 @@ public:
};
private:
SourceLocation AtLoc; // location of @synthesize or @dynamic
-
+
/// \brief For @synthesize, the location of the ivar, if it was written in
/// the source code.
///
@@ -1691,16 +1693,16 @@ private:
/// @synthesize int a = b
/// \endcode
SourceLocation IvarLoc;
-
+
/// Property declaration being implemented
ObjCPropertyDecl *PropertyDecl;
/// Null for @dynamic. Required for @synthesize.
ObjCIvarDecl *PropertyIvarDecl;
-
+
/// Null for @dynamic. Non-null if property must be copy-constructed in getter
Expr *GetterCXXConstructor;
-
+
/// Null for @dynamic. Non-null if property has assignment operator to call
/// in Setter synthesis.
Expr *SetterCXXAssignment;
@@ -1711,7 +1713,7 @@ private:
ObjCIvarDecl *ivarDecl,
SourceLocation ivarLoc)
: Decl(ObjCPropertyImpl, DC, L), AtLoc(atLoc),
- IvarLoc(ivarLoc), PropertyDecl(property), PropertyIvarDecl(ivarDecl),
+ IvarLoc(ivarLoc), PropertyDecl(property), PropertyIvarDecl(ivarDecl),
GetterCXXConstructor(0), SetterCXXAssignment(0) {
assert (PK == Dynamic || PropertyIvarDecl);
}
@@ -1725,7 +1727,7 @@ public:
SourceLocation ivarLoc);
virtual SourceRange getSourceRange() const;
-
+
SourceLocation getLocStart() const { return AtLoc; }
void setAtLoc(SourceLocation Loc) { AtLoc = Loc; }
@@ -1742,13 +1744,13 @@ public:
return PropertyIvarDecl;
}
SourceLocation getPropertyIvarDeclLoc() const { return IvarLoc; }
-
+
void setPropertyIvarDecl(ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar,
- SourceLocation IvarLoc) {
- PropertyIvarDecl = Ivar;
+ SourceLocation IvarLoc) {
+ PropertyIvarDecl = Ivar;
this->IvarLoc = IvarLoc;
}
-
+
Expr *getGetterCXXConstructor() const {
return GetterCXXConstructor;
}
@@ -1762,11 +1764,11 @@ public:
void setSetterCXXAssignment(Expr *setterCXXAssignment) {
SetterCXXAssignment = setterCXXAssignment;
}
-
+
static bool classof(const Decl *D) { return classofKind(D->getKind()); }
static bool classof(const ObjCPropertyImplDecl *D) { return true; }
static bool classofKind(Decl::Kind K) { return K == ObjCPropertyImpl; }
-
+
friend class ASTDeclReader;
};
diff --git a/include/clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h b/include/clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h
index 138e47d1a9..9149850e8f 100644
--- a/include/clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h
+++ b/include/clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h
@@ -99,7 +99,7 @@ public:
/// The first template parameter list in a declaration will have depth 0,
/// the second template parameter list will have depth 1, etc.
unsigned getDepth() const;
-
+
SourceLocation getTemplateLoc() const { return TemplateLoc; }
SourceLocation getLAngleLoc() const { return LAngleLoc; }
SourceLocation getRAngleLoc() const { return RAngleLoc; }
@@ -116,7 +116,8 @@ class FixedSizeTemplateParameterList : public TemplateParameterList {
NamedDecl *Params[N];
public:
- FixedSizeTemplateParameterList(SourceLocation TemplateLoc, SourceLocation LAngleLoc,
+ FixedSizeTemplateParameterList(SourceLocation TemplateLoc,
+ SourceLocation LAngleLoc,
NamedDecl **Params, SourceLocation RAngleLoc) :
TemplateParameterList(TemplateLoc, LAngleLoc, Params, N, RAngleLoc) {
}
@@ -142,7 +143,7 @@ class TemplateArgumentList {
: Arguments(Args, Owned), NumArguments(NumArgs) { }
public:
- /// \brief Type used to indicate that the template argument list itself is a
+ /// \brief Type used to indicate that the template argument list itself is a
/// stack object. It does not own its template arguments.
enum OnStackType { OnStack };
@@ -156,12 +157,12 @@ public:
///
/// The template argument list does not own the template arguments
/// provided.
- explicit TemplateArgumentList(OnStackType,
+ explicit TemplateArgumentList(OnStackType,
const TemplateArgument *Args, unsigned NumArgs)
: Arguments(Args, false), NumArguments(NumArgs) { }
-
- /// \brief Produces a shallow copy of the given template argument list.
- ///
+
+ /// \brief Produces a shallow copy of the given template argument list.
+ ///
/// This operation assumes that the input argument list outlives it.
/// This takes the list as a pointer to avoid looking like a copy
/// constructor, since this really really isn't safe to use that
@@ -244,7 +245,7 @@ public:
protected:
NamedDecl *TemplatedDecl;
TemplateParameterList* TemplateParams;
-
+
public:
/// \brief Initialize the underlying templated declaration and
/// template parameters.
@@ -298,9 +299,9 @@ public:
const ASTTemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgumentsAsWritten;
/// \brief The point at which this function template specialization was
- /// first instantiated.
+ /// first instantiated.
SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation;
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the template from which this function was specialized.
FunctionTemplateDecl *getTemplate() const { return Template.getPointer(); }
@@ -325,16 +326,16 @@ public:
///
/// The point of instantiation may be an invalid source location if this
/// function has yet to be instantiated.
- SourceLocation getPointOfInstantiation() const {
- return PointOfInstantiation;
+ SourceLocation getPointOfInstantiation() const {
+ return PointOfInstantiation;
}
-
+
/// \brief Set the (first) point of instantiation of this function template
/// specialization.
void setPointOfInstantiation(SourceLocation POI) {
PointOfInstantiation = POI;
}
-
+
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) {
Profile(ID, TemplateArguments->data(),
TemplateArguments->size(),
@@ -350,49 +351,49 @@ public:
}
};
-/// \brief Provides information a specialization of a member of a class
+/// \brief Provides information a specialization of a member of a class
/// template, which may be a member function, static data member, or
/// member class.
class MemberSpecializationInfo {
// The member declaration from which this member was instantiated, and the
// manner in which the instantiation occurred (in the lower two bits).
llvm::PointerIntPair<NamedDecl *, 2> MemberAndTSK;
-
+
// The point at which this member was first instantiated.
SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation;
-
+
public:
- explicit
+ explicit
MemberSpecializationInfo(NamedDecl *IF, TemplateSpecializationKind TSK,
SourceLocation POI = SourceLocation())
: MemberAndTSK(IF, TSK - 1), PointOfInstantiation(POI) {
- assert(TSK != TSK_Undeclared &&
+ assert(TSK != TSK_Undeclared &&
"Cannot encode undeclared template specializations for members");
}
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the member declaration from which this member was
/// instantiated.
NamedDecl *getInstantiatedFrom() const { return MemberAndTSK.getPointer(); }
-
+
/// \brief Determine what kind of template specialization this is.
TemplateSpecializationKind getTemplateSpecializationKind() const {
return (TemplateSpecializationKind)(MemberAndTSK.getInt() + 1);
}
-
+
/// \brief Set the template specialization kind.
void setTemplateSpecializationKind(TemplateSpecializationKind TSK) {
- assert(TSK != TSK_Undeclared &&
+ assert(TSK != TSK_Undeclared &&
"Cannot encode undeclared template specializations for members");
MemberAndTSK.setInt(TSK - 1);
}
-
- /// \brief Retrieve the first point of instantiation of this member.
+
+ /// \brief Retrieve the first point of instantiation of this member.
/// If the point of instantiation is an invalid location, then this member
/// has not yet been instantiated.
- SourceLocation getPointOfInstantiation() const {
- return PointOfInstantiation;
+ SourceLocation getPointOfInstantiation() const {
+ return PointOfInstantiation;
}
-
+
/// \brief Set the first point of instantiation.
void setPointOfInstantiation(SourceLocation POI) {
PointOfInstantiation = POI;
@@ -414,14 +415,14 @@ class DependentFunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo {
union {
// Force sizeof to be a multiple of sizeof(void*) so that the
// trailing data is aligned.
- void *Aligner;
+ void *Aligner;
struct {
/// The number of potential template candidates.
unsigned NumTemplates;
/// The number of template arguments.
- unsigned NumArgs;
+ unsigned NumArgs;
} d;
};
@@ -452,7 +453,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Returns the explicit template arguments that were given.
const TemplateArgumentLoc *getTemplateArgs() const {
return reinterpret_cast<const TemplateArgumentLoc*>(
- &getTemplates()[getNumTemplates()]);
+ &getTemplates()[getNumTemplates()]);
}
/// \brief Returns the number of explicit template arguments that were given.
@@ -474,7 +475,7 @@ public:
return AngleLocs.getEnd();
}
};
-
+
/// Declaration of a redeclarable template.
class RedeclarableTemplateDecl : public TemplateDecl {
@@ -631,7 +632,7 @@ public:
const_cast<RedeclarableTemplateDecl*>(this)->getMostRecentDeclaration();
}
- /// \brief Determines whether this template was a specialization of a
+ /// \brief Determines whether this template was a specialization of a
/// member template.
///
/// In the following example, the function template \c X<int>::f and the
@@ -652,14 +653,14 @@ public:
bool isMemberSpecialization() {
return getCommonPtr()->InstantiatedFromMember.getInt();
}
-
+
/// \brief Note that this member template is a specialization.
void setMemberSpecialization() {
assert(getCommonPtr()->InstantiatedFromMember.getPointer() &&
"Only member templates can be member template specializations");
getCommonPtr()->InstantiatedFromMember.setInt(true);
}
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the previous declaration of this template, or
/// NULL if no such declaration exists.
RedeclarableTemplateDecl *getInstantiatedFromMemberTemplate() {
@@ -774,11 +775,11 @@ protected:
/// function template.
struct Common : CommonBase {
Common() : InjectedArgs(0) { }
-
+
/// \brief The function template specializations for this function
/// template, including explicit specializations and instantiations.
llvm::FoldingSet<FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo> Specializations;
-
+
/// \brief The set of "injected" template arguments used within this
/// function template.
///
@@ -813,7 +814,7 @@ protected:
/// retrieved by an earlier call to findSpecialization().
void addSpecialization(FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo* Info,
void *InsertPos);
-
+
public:
/// Get the underlying function declaration of the template.
FunctionDecl *getTemplatedDecl() const {
@@ -866,13 +867,13 @@ public:
/// \brief Retrieve the "injected" template arguments that correspond to the
/// template parameters of this function template.
- ///
+ ///
/// Although the C++ standard has no notion of the "injected" template
/// arguments for a function template, the notion is convenient when
/// we need to perform substitutions inside the definition of a function
- /// template.
+ /// template.
std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> getInjectedTemplateArgs();
-
+
/// \brief Create a function template node.
static FunctionTemplateDecl *Create(ASTContext &C, DeclContext *DC,
SourceLocation L,
@@ -1003,14 +1004,14 @@ public:
DefaultArgument = 0;
InheritedDefault = false;
}
-
+
/// \brief Set whether this template type parameter was declared with
/// the 'typename' or 'class' keyword.
void setDeclaredWithTypename(bool withTypename) { Typename = withTypename; }
/// \brief Retrieve the depth of the template parameter.
unsigned getDepth() const;
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the index of the template parameter.
unsigned getIndex() const;
@@ -1038,18 +1039,18 @@ class NonTypeTemplateParmDecl
// FIXME: Collapse this into TemplateParamPosition; or, just move depth/index
// down here to save memory.
-
+
/// \brief Whether this non-type template parameter is a parameter pack.
bool ParameterPack;
-
- /// \brief Whether this non-type template parameter is an "expanded"
+
+ /// \brief Whether this non-type template parameter is an "expanded"
/// parameter pack, meaning that its type is a pack expansion and we
/// already know the set of types that expansion expands to.
bool ExpandedParameterPack;
-
+
/// \brief The number of types in an expanded parameter pack.
unsigned NumExpandedTypes;
-
+
NonTypeTemplateParmDecl(DeclContext *DC, SourceLocation StartLoc,
SourceLocation IdLoc, unsigned D, unsigned P,
IdentifierInfo *Id, QualType T,
@@ -1069,7 +1070,7 @@ class NonTypeTemplateParmDecl
TypeSourceInfo **ExpandedTInfos);
friend class ASTDeclReader;
-
+
public:
static NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *
Create(const ASTContext &C, DeclContext *DC, SourceLocation StartLoc,
@@ -1135,7 +1136,7 @@ public:
/// template<typename T, unsigned ...Dims> struct multi_array;
/// \endcode
bool isParameterPack() const { return ParameterPack; }
-
+
/// \brief Whether this parameter is a non-type template parameter pack
/// that has different types at different positions.
///
@@ -1150,25 +1151,26 @@ public:
/// struct Y { /* ... */ };
/// };
/// \endcode
- ///
+ ///
/// The parameter pack \c Values has a \c PackExpansionType as its type,
/// which expands \c Types. When \c Types is supplied with template arguments
- /// by instantiating \c X, the instantiation of \c Values becomes an
- /// expanded parameter pack. For example, instantiating
+ /// by instantiating \c X, the instantiation of \c Values becomes an
+ /// expanded parameter pack. For example, instantiating
/// \c X<int, unsigned int> results in \c Values being an expanded parameter
/// pack with expansion types \c int and \c unsigned int.
///
- /// The \c getExpansionType() and \c getExpansionTypeSourceInfo() functions
+ /// The \c getExpansionType() and \c getExpansionTypeSourceInfo() functions
/// return the expansion types.
bool isExpandedParameterPack() const { return ExpandedParameterPack; }
-
- /// \brief Retrieves the number of expansion types in an expanded parameter pack.
+
+ /// \brief Retrieves the number of expansion types in an expanded parameter
+ /// pack.
unsigned getNumExpansionTypes() const {
assert(ExpandedParameterPack && "Not an expansion parameter pack");
return NumExpandedTypes;
}
- /// \brief Retrieve a particular expansion type within an expanded parameter
+ /// \brief Retrieve a particular expansion type within an expanded parameter
/// pack.
QualType getExpansionType(unsigned I) const {
assert(I < NumExpandedTypes && "Out-of-range expansion type index");
@@ -1176,7 +1178,7 @@ public:
return QualType::getFromOpaquePtr(TypesAndInfos[2*I]);
}
- /// \brief Retrieve a particular expansion type source info within an
+ /// \brief Retrieve a particular expansion type source info within an
/// expanded parameter pack.
TypeSourceInfo *getExpansionTypeSourceInfo(unsigned I) const {
assert(I < NumExpandedTypes && "Out-of-range expansion type index");
@@ -1207,7 +1209,7 @@ class TemplateTemplateParmDecl
/// \brief Whether this parameter is a parameter pack.
bool ParameterPack;
-
+
TemplateTemplateParmDecl(DeclContext *DC, SourceLocation L,
unsigned D, unsigned P, bool ParameterPack,
IdentifierInfo *Id, TemplateParameterList *Params)
@@ -1552,7 +1554,7 @@ public:
static bool classof(const ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *) {
return true;
}
-
+
friend class ASTDeclReader;
friend class ASTDeclWriter;
};
@@ -1571,15 +1573,15 @@ class ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl
/// specialization was added to the set of partial specializations for
/// its owning class template.
unsigned SequenceNumber;
-
- /// \brief The class template partial specialization from which this
+
+ /// \brief The class template partial specialization from which this
/// class template partial specialization was instantiated.
///
/// The boolean value will be true to indicate that this class template
/// partial specialization was specialized at this level.
llvm::PointerIntPair<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *, 1, bool>
InstantiatedFromMember;
-
+
ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl(ASTContext &Context, TagKind TK,
DeclContext *DC,
SourceLocation StartLoc,
@@ -1592,7 +1594,7 @@ class ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl
unsigned NumArgInfos,
ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *PrevDecl,
unsigned SequenceNumber);
-
+
ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl()
: ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl(ClassTemplatePartialSpecialization),
TemplateParams(0), ArgsAsWritten(0),
@@ -1654,9 +1656,9 @@ public:
/// \endcode
///
/// In this example, the instantiation of \c Outer<float>::Inner<int*> will
- /// end up instantiating the partial specialization
- /// \c Outer<float>::Inner<U*>, which itself was instantiated from the class
- /// template partial specialization \c Outer<T>::Inner<U*>. Given
+ /// end up instantiating the partial specialization
+ /// \c Outer<float>::Inner<U*>, which itself was instantiated from the class
+ /// template partial specialization \c Outer<T>::Inner<U*>. Given
/// \c Outer<float>::Inner<U*>, this function would return
/// \c Outer<T>::Inner<U*>.
ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *getInstantiatedFromMember() {
@@ -1664,15 +1666,15 @@ public:
= cast<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(getFirstDeclaration());
return First->InstantiatedFromMember.getPointer();
}
-
+
void setInstantiatedFromMember(
ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *PartialSpec) {
ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *First
= cast<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(getFirstDeclaration());
First->InstantiatedFromMember.setPointer(PartialSpec);
}
-
- /// \brief Determines whether this class template partial specialization
+
+ /// \brief Determines whether this class template partial specialization
/// template was a specialization of a member partial specialization.
///
/// In the following example, the member template partial specialization
@@ -1693,7 +1695,7 @@ public:
= cast<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(getFirstDeclaration());
return First->InstantiatedFromMember.getInt();
}
-
+
/// \brief Note that this member template is a specialization.
void setMemberSpecialization() {
ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *First
@@ -1711,7 +1713,7 @@ public:
return cast<InjectedClassNameType>(getTypeForDecl())
->getInjectedSpecializationType();
}
-
+
// FIXME: Add Profile support!
static bool classof(const Decl *D) { return classofKind(D->getKind()); }
@@ -1731,7 +1733,7 @@ public:
class ClassTemplateDecl : public RedeclarableTemplateDecl,
public RedeclarableTemplate<ClassTemplateDecl> {
static void DeallocateCommon(void *Ptr);
-
+
protected:
typedef RedeclarableTemplate<ClassTemplateDecl> redeclarable_base;
@@ -1739,7 +1741,7 @@ protected:
/// class template.
struct Common : CommonBase {
Common() : LazySpecializations() { }
-
+
/// \brief The class template specializations for this class
/// template, including explicit specializations and instantiations.
llvm::FoldingSet<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl> Specializations;
@@ -1751,7 +1753,7 @@ protected:
/// \brief The injected-class-name type for this class template.
QualType InjectedClassNameType;
-
+
/// \brief If non-null, points to an array of specializations (including
/// partial specializations) known ownly by their external declaration IDs.
///
@@ -1762,7 +1764,7 @@ protected:
/// \brief Load any lazily-loaded specializations from the external source.
void LoadLazySpecializations();
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the set of specializations of this class template.
llvm::FoldingSet<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl> &getSpecializations();
@@ -1860,7 +1862,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Retrieve the partial specializations as an ordered list.
void getPartialSpecializations(
SmallVectorImpl<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *> &PS);
-
+
/// \brief Find a class template partial specialization with the given
/// type T.
///
@@ -1870,7 +1872,7 @@ public:
/// \returns the class template partial specialization that exactly matches
/// the type \p T, or NULL if no such partial specialization exists.
ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *findPartialSpecialization(QualType T);
-
+
/// \brief Find a class template partial specialization which was instantiated
/// from the given member partial specialization.
///
@@ -1957,7 +1959,7 @@ private:
FriendTemplateDecl(DeclContext *DC, SourceLocation Loc,
- unsigned NParams,
+ unsigned NParams,
TemplateParameterList **Params,
FriendUnion Friend,
SourceLocation FriendLoc)
@@ -1977,7 +1979,7 @@ private:
public:
static FriendTemplateDecl *Create(ASTContext &Context,
DeclContext *DC, SourceLocation Loc,
- unsigned NParams,
+ unsigned NParams,
TemplateParameterList **Params,
FriendUnion Friend,
SourceLocation FriendLoc);
@@ -2072,7 +2074,7 @@ public:
return redeclarable_base::getInstantiatedFromMemberTemplate();
}
-
+
/// \brief Create a function template node.
static TypeAliasTemplateDecl *Create(ASTContext &C, DeclContext *DC,
SourceLocation L,
diff --git a/include/clang/AST/Expr.h b/include/clang/AST/Expr.h
index af46e1799c..f0a4802db1 100644
--- a/include/clang/AST/Expr.h
+++ b/include/clang/AST/Expr.h
@@ -56,8 +56,8 @@ class Expr : public Stmt {
protected:
Expr(StmtClass SC, QualType T, ExprValueKind VK, ExprObjectKind OK,
- bool TD, bool VD, bool ID, bool ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack)
- : Stmt(SC)
+ bool TD, bool VD, bool ID, bool ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack)
+ : Stmt(SC)
{
ExprBits.TypeDependent = TD;
ExprBits.ValueDependent = VD;
@@ -97,8 +97,8 @@ public:
bool isValueDependent() const { return ExprBits.ValueDependent; }
/// \brief Set whether this expression is value-dependent or not.
- void setValueDependent(bool VD) {
- ExprBits.ValueDependent = VD;
+ void setValueDependent(bool VD) {
+ ExprBits.ValueDependent = VD;
if (VD)
ExprBits.InstantiationDependent = true;
}
@@ -117,8 +117,8 @@ public:
bool isTypeDependent() const { return ExprBits.TypeDependent; }
/// \brief Set whether this expression is type-dependent or not.
- void setTypeDependent(bool TD) {
- ExprBits.TypeDependent = TD;
+ void setTypeDependent(bool TD) {
+ ExprBits.TypeDependent = TD;
if (TD)
ExprBits.InstantiationDependent = true;
}
@@ -140,12 +140,12 @@ public:
/// }
/// \endcode
///
- bool isInstantiationDependent() const {
- return ExprBits.InstantiationDependent;
+ bool isInstantiationDependent() const {
+ return ExprBits.InstantiationDependent;
}
-
+
/// \brief Set whether this expression is instantiation-dependent or not.
- void setInstantiationDependent(bool ID) {
+ void setInstantiationDependent(bool ID) {
ExprBits.InstantiationDependent = ID;
}
@@ -163,8 +163,8 @@ public:
///
/// The expressions \c args and \c static_cast<Types&&>(args) both
/// contain parameter packs.
- bool containsUnexpandedParameterPack() const {
- return ExprBits.ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack;
+ bool containsUnexpandedParameterPack() const {
+ return ExprBits.ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack;
}
/// \brief Set the bit that describes whether this expression
@@ -302,12 +302,12 @@ public:
bool isPRValue() const { return Kind >= CL_Function; }
bool isRValue() const { return Kind >= CL_XValue; }
bool isModifiable() const { return getModifiable() == CM_Modifiable; }
-
+
/// \brief Create a simple, modifiably lvalue
static Classification makeSimpleLValue() {
return Classification(CL_LValue, CM_Modifiable);
}
-
+
};
/// \brief Classify - Classify this expression according to the C++0x
/// expression taxonomy.
@@ -403,13 +403,13 @@ public:
return BT->getKind() == K;
return false;
}
-
+
/// isKnownToHaveBooleanValue - Return true if this is an integer expression
/// that is known to return 0 or 1. This happens for _Bool/bool expressions
/// but also int expressions which are produced by things like comparisons in
/// C.
bool isKnownToHaveBooleanValue() const;
-
+
/// isIntegerConstantExpr - Return true if this expression is a valid integer
/// constant expression, and, if so, return its value in Result. If not a
/// valid i-c-e, return false and fill in Loc (if specified) with the location
@@ -521,16 +521,16 @@ public:
enum NullPointerConstantValueDependence {
/// \brief Specifies that the expression should never be value-dependent.
NPC_NeverValueDependent = 0,
-
+
/// \brief Specifies that a value-dependent expression of integral or
/// dependent type should be considered a null pointer constant.
NPC_ValueDependentIsNull,
-
+
/// \brief Specifies that a value-dependent expression should be considered
/// to never be a null pointer constant.
NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
};
-
+
/// isNullPointerConstant - C99 6.3.2.3p3 - Test if this reduces down to
/// a Null pointer constant. The return value can further distinguish the
/// kind of NULL pointer constant that was detected.
@@ -578,8 +578,8 @@ public:
/// or CastExprs, returning their operand.
Expr *IgnoreParenCasts();
- /// IgnoreParenImpCasts - Ignore parentheses and implicit casts. Strip off any
- /// ParenExpr or ImplicitCastExprs, returning their operand.
+ /// IgnoreParenImpCasts - Ignore parentheses and implicit casts. Strip off
+ /// any ParenExpr or ImplicitCastExprs, returning their operand.
Expr *IgnoreParenImpCasts();
/// IgnoreConversionOperator - Ignore conversion operator. If this Expr is a
@@ -593,11 +593,11 @@ public:
const Expr *IgnoreParenImpCasts() const {
return const_cast<Expr*>(this)->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
}
-
+
/// Ignore parentheses and lvalue casts. Strip off any ParenExpr and
/// CastExprs that represent lvalue casts, returning their operand.
Expr *IgnoreParenLValueCasts();
-
+
const Expr *IgnoreParenLValueCasts() const {
return const_cast<Expr*>(this)->IgnoreParenLValueCasts();
}
@@ -610,12 +610,12 @@ public:
/// \brief Determine whether this expression is a default function argument.
///
/// Default arguments are implicitly generated in the abstract syntax tree
- /// by semantic analysis for function calls, object constructions, etc. in
+ /// by semantic analysis for function calls, object constructions, etc. in
/// C++. Default arguments are represented by \c CXXDefaultArgExpr nodes;
/// this routine also looks through any implicit casts to determine whether
/// the expression is a default argument.
bool isDefaultArgument() const;
-
+
/// \brief Determine whether the result of this expression is a
/// temporary object of the given class type.
bool isTemporaryObject(ASTContext &Ctx, const CXXRecordDecl *TempTy) const;
@@ -660,14 +660,14 @@ class OpaqueValueExpr : public Expr {
friend class ASTStmtReader;
Expr *SourceExpr;
SourceLocation Loc;
-
+
public:
- OpaqueValueExpr(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, ExprValueKind VK,
+ OpaqueValueExpr(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, ExprValueKind VK,
ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary)
: Expr(OpaqueValueExprClass, T, VK, OK,
- T->isDependentType(), T->isDependentType(),
+ T->isDependentType(), T->isDependentType(),
T->isInstantiationDependentType(),
- false),
+ false),
SourceExpr(0), Loc(Loc) {
}
@@ -681,7 +681,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Retrieve the location of this expression.
SourceLocation getLocation() const { return Loc; }
-
+
SourceRange getSourceRange() const {
if (SourceExpr) return SourceExpr->getSourceRange();
return Loc;
@@ -989,7 +989,7 @@ private:
public:
PredefinedExpr(SourceLocation l, QualType type, IdentType IT)
: Expr(PredefinedExprClass, type, VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary,
- type->isDependentType(), type->isDependentType(),
+ type->isDependentType(), type->isDependentType(),
type->isInstantiationDependentType(),
/*ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack=*/false),
Loc(l), Type(IT) {}
@@ -1051,14 +1051,14 @@ protected:
};
class APIntStorage : public APNumericStorage {
-public:
- llvm::APInt getValue() const { return getIntValue(); }
+public:
+ llvm::APInt getValue() const { return getIntValue(); }
void setValue(ASTContext &C, const llvm::APInt &Val) { setIntValue(C, Val); }
};
class APFloatStorage : public APNumericStorage {
-public:
- llvm::APFloat getValue() const { return llvm::APFloat(getIntValue()); }
+public:
+ llvm::APFloat getValue() const { return llvm::APFloat(getIntValue()); }
void setValue(ASTContext &C, const llvm::APFloat &Val) {
setIntValue(C, Val.bitcastToAPInt());
}
@@ -1347,8 +1347,8 @@ public:
StringKind Kind, bool IsPascal);
StringKind getKind() const { return static_cast<StringKind>(Kind); }
-
-
+
+
bool isAscii() const { return Kind == Ascii; }
bool isWide() const { return Kind == Wide; }
bool isUTF8() const { return Kind == UTF8; }
@@ -1363,7 +1363,7 @@ public:
return true;
return false;
}
-
+
/// getNumConcatenated - Get the number of string literal tokens that were
/// concatenated in translation phase #6 to form this string literal.
unsigned getNumConcatenated() const { return NumConcatenated; }
@@ -1376,7 +1376,7 @@ public:
assert(TokNum < NumConcatenated && "Invalid tok number");
TokLocs[TokNum] = L;
}
-
+
/// getLocationOfByte - Return a source location that points to the specified
/// byte of this string literal.
///
@@ -1471,7 +1471,7 @@ public:
: Expr(UnaryOperatorClass, type, VK, OK,
input->isTypeDependent() || type->isDependentType(),
input->isValueDependent(),
- (input->isInstantiationDependent() ||
+ (input->isInstantiationDependent() ||
type->isInstantiationDependentType()),
input->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()),
Opc(opc), Loc(l), Val(input) {}
@@ -1561,14 +1561,14 @@ public:
/// @code
/// struct S {
/// float f;
-/// double d;
+/// double d;
/// };
/// struct T {
/// int i;
/// struct S s[10];
/// };
/// @endcode
-/// we can represent and evaluate the expression @c offsetof(struct T, s[2].d).
+/// we can represent and evaluate the expression @c offsetof(struct T, s[2].d).
class OffsetOfExpr : public Expr {
public:
@@ -1590,48 +1590,48 @@ public:
private:
enum { MaskBits = 2, Mask = 0x03 };
-
+
/// \brief The source range that covers this part of the designator.
SourceRange Range;
-
+
/// \brief The data describing the designator, which comes in three
/// different forms, depending on the lower two bits.
- /// - An unsigned index into the array of Expr*'s stored after this node
+ /// - An unsigned index into the array of Expr*'s stored after this node
/// in memory, for [constant-expression] designators.
/// - A FieldDecl*, for references to a known field.
/// - An IdentifierInfo*, for references to a field with a given name
/// when the class type is dependent.
- /// - A CXXBaseSpecifier*, for references that look at a field in a
+ /// - A CXXBaseSpecifier*, for references that look at a field in a
/// base class.
uintptr_t Data;
-
+
public:
/// \brief Create an offsetof node that refers to an array element.
- OffsetOfNode(SourceLocation LBracketLoc, unsigned Index,
+ OffsetOfNode(SourceLocation LBracketLoc, unsigned Index,
SourceLocation RBracketLoc)
: Range(LBracketLoc, RBracketLoc), Data((Index << 2) | Array) { }
-
+
/// \brief Create an offsetof node that refers to a field.
- OffsetOfNode(SourceLocation DotLoc, FieldDecl *Field,
+ OffsetOfNode(SourceLocation DotLoc, FieldDecl *Field,
SourceLocation NameLoc)
- : Range(DotLoc.isValid()? DotLoc : NameLoc, NameLoc),
+ : Range(DotLoc.isValid()? DotLoc : NameLoc, NameLoc),
Data(reinterpret_cast<uintptr_t>(Field) | OffsetOfNode::Field) { }
-
+
/// \brief Create an offsetof node that refers to an identifier.
OffsetOfNode(SourceLocation DotLoc, IdentifierInfo *Name,
SourceLocation NameLoc)
- : Range(DotLoc.isValid()? DotLoc : NameLoc, NameLoc),
+ : Range(DotLoc.isValid()? DotLoc : NameLoc, NameLoc),
Data(reinterpret_cast<uintptr_t>(Name) | Identifier) { }
/// \brief Create an offsetof node that refers into a C++ base class.
explicit OffsetOfNode(const CXXBaseSpecifier *Base)
: Range(), Data(reinterpret_cast<uintptr_t>(Base) | OffsetOfNode::Base) {}
-
+
/// \brief Determine what kind of offsetof node this is.
- Kind getKind() const {
+ Kind getKind() const {
return static_cast<Kind>(Data & Mask);
}
-
+
/// \brief For an array element node, returns the index into the array
/// of expressions.
unsigned getArrayExprIndex() const {
@@ -1644,28 +1644,28 @@ public:
assert(getKind() == Field);
return reinterpret_cast<FieldDecl *>(Data & ~(uintptr_t)Mask);
}
-
+
/// \brief For a field or identifier offsetof node, returns the name of
/// the field.
IdentifierInfo *getFieldName() const;
-
+
/// \brief For a base class node, returns the base specifier.
CXXBaseSpecifier *getBase() const {
assert(getKind() == Base);
- return reinterpret_cast<CXXBaseSpecifier *>(Data & ~(uintptr_t)Mask);
+ return reinterpret_cast<CXXBaseSpecifier *>(Data & ~(uintptr_t)Mask);
}
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the source range that covers this offsetof node.
///
/// For an array element node, the source range contains the locations of
/// the square brackets. For a field or identifier node, the source range
- /// contains the location of the period (if there is one) and the
+ /// contains the location of the period (if there is one) and the
/// identifier.
SourceRange getSourceRange() const { return Range; }
};
private:
-
+
SourceLocation OperatorLoc, RParenLoc;
// Base type;
TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo;
@@ -1673,26 +1673,26 @@ private:
unsigned NumComps;
// Number of sub-expressions (i.e. array subscript expressions).
unsigned NumExprs;
-
- OffsetOfExpr(ASTContext &C, QualType type,
+
+ OffsetOfExpr(ASTContext &C, QualType type,
SourceLocation OperatorLoc, TypeSourceInfo *tsi,
- OffsetOfNode* compsPtr, unsigned numComps,
+ OffsetOfNode* compsPtr, unsigned numComps,
Expr** exprsPtr, unsigned numExprs,
SourceLocation RParenLoc);
explicit OffsetOfExpr(unsigned numComps, unsigned numExprs)
: Expr(OffsetOfExprClass, EmptyShell()),
- TSInfo(0), NumComps(numComps), NumExprs(numExprs) {}
+ TSInfo(0), NumComps(numComps), NumExprs(numExprs) {}
public:
-
- static OffsetOfExpr *Create(ASTContext &C, QualType type,
- SourceLocation OperatorLoc, TypeSourceInfo *tsi,
- OffsetOfNode* compsPtr, unsigned numComps,
+
+ static OffsetOfExpr *Create(ASTContext &C, QualType type,
+ SourceLocation OperatorLoc, TypeSourceInfo *tsi,
+ OffsetOfNode* compsPtr, unsigned numComps,
Expr** exprsPtr, unsigned numExprs,
SourceLocation RParenLoc);
- static OffsetOfExpr *CreateEmpty(ASTContext &C,
+ static OffsetOfExpr *CreateEmpty(ASTContext &C,
unsigned NumComps, unsigned NumExprs);
/// getOperatorLoc - Return the location of the operator.
@@ -1702,14 +1702,14 @@ public:
/// \brief Return the location of the right parentheses.
SourceLocation getRParenLoc() const { return RParenLoc; }
void setRParenLoc(SourceLocation R) { RParenLoc = R; }
-
+
TypeSourceInfo *getTypeSourceInfo() const {
return TSInfo;
}
void setTypeSourceInfo(TypeSourceInfo *tsi) {
TSInfo = tsi;
}
-
+
const OffsetOfNode &getComponent(unsigned Idx) const {
assert(Idx < NumComps && "Subscript out of range");
return reinterpret_cast<const OffsetOfNode *> (this + 1)[Idx];
@@ -1719,7 +1719,7 @@ public:
assert(Idx < NumComps && "Subscript out of range");
reinterpret_cast<OffsetOfNode *> (this + 1)[Idx] = ON;
}
-
+
unsigned getNumComponents() const {
return NumComps;
}
@@ -1738,7 +1738,7 @@ public:
reinterpret_cast<Expr **>(
reinterpret_cast<OffsetOfNode *>(this+1) + NumComps)[Idx] = E;
}
-
+
unsigned getNumExpressions() const {
return NumExprs;
}
@@ -2007,7 +2007,7 @@ public:
const Expr *const *getArgs() const {
return const_cast<CallExpr*>(this)->getArgs();
}
-
+
/// getArg - Return the specified argument.
Expr *getArg(unsigned Arg) {
assert(Arg < NumArgs && "Arg access out of range!");
@@ -2139,7 +2139,7 @@ public:
const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, QualType ty,
ExprValueKind VK, ExprObjectKind OK)
: Expr(MemberExprClass, ty, VK, OK,
- base->isTypeDependent(),
+ base->isTypeDependent(),
base->isValueDependent(),
base->isInstantiationDependent(),
base->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()),
@@ -2206,13 +2206,13 @@ public:
return getMemberQualifier()->QualifierLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier();
}
- /// \brief If the member name was qualified, retrieves the
+ /// \brief If the member name was qualified, retrieves the
/// nested-name-specifier that precedes the member name, with source-location
/// information.
NestedNameSpecifierLoc getQualifierLoc() const {
if (!hasQualifier())
return NestedNameSpecifierLoc();
-
+
return getMemberQualifier()->QualifierLoc;
}
@@ -2255,7 +2255,7 @@ public:
if (!hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) return 0;
return &getExplicitTemplateArgs();
}
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the location of the left angle bracket following the
/// member name ('<'), if any.
SourceLocation getLAngleLoc() const {
@@ -2307,7 +2307,7 @@ public:
void setMemberLoc(SourceLocation L) { MemberLoc = L; }
SourceRange getSourceRange() const;
-
+
SourceLocation getExprLoc() const { return MemberLoc; }
/// \brief Determine whether the base of this explicit is implicit.
@@ -2356,7 +2356,7 @@ public:
CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation lparenloc, TypeSourceInfo *tinfo,
QualType T, ExprValueKind VK, Expr *init, bool fileScope)
: Expr(CompoundLiteralExprClass, T, VK, OK_Ordinary,
- tinfo->getType()->isDependentType(),
+ tinfo->getType()->isDependentType(),
init->isValueDependent(),
(init->isInstantiationDependent() ||
tinfo->getType()->isInstantiationDependentType()),
@@ -2432,7 +2432,7 @@ protected:
// Cast expressions are value-dependent if the type is
// dependent or if the subexpression is value-dependent.
ty->isDependentType() || (op && op->isValueDependent()),
- (ty->isInstantiationDependentType() ||
+ (ty->isInstantiationDependentType() ||
(op && op->isInstantiationDependent())),
(ty->containsUnexpandedParameterPack() ||
op->containsUnexpandedParameterPack())),
@@ -2929,7 +2929,7 @@ public:
// the expression if the condition evaluates to false. This is
// the same as getRHS.
Expr *getFalseExpr() const { return cast<Expr>(SubExprs[RHS]); }
-
+
Expr *getLHS() const { return cast<Expr>(SubExprs[LHS]); }
Expr *getRHS() const { return cast<Expr>(SubExprs[RHS]); }
@@ -3015,7 +3015,7 @@ public:
Expr *getFalseExpr() const {
return cast<Expr>(SubExprs[RHS]);
}
-
+
SourceRange getSourceRange() const {
return SourceRange(getCommon()->getLocStart(), getFalseExpr()->getLocEnd());
}
@@ -3175,7 +3175,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Retrieve the array of expressions.
Expr **getSubExprs() { return reinterpret_cast<Expr **>(SubExprs); }
-
+
/// getExpr - Return the Expr at the specified index.
Expr *getExpr(unsigned Index) {
assert((Index < NumExprs) && "Arg access out of range!");
@@ -3423,7 +3423,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Retrieve the set of initializers.
Expr **getInits() { return reinterpret_cast<Expr **>(InitExprs.data()); }
-
+
const Expr *getInit(unsigned Init) const {
assert(Init < getNumInits() && "Initializer access out of range!");
return cast_or_null<Expr>(InitExprs[Init]);
@@ -3798,7 +3798,7 @@ public:
Designator *getDesignator(unsigned Idx) { return &designators_begin()[Idx]; }
- void setDesignators(ASTContext &C, const Designator *Desigs,
+ void setDesignators(ASTContext &C, const Designator *Desigs,
unsigned NumDesigs);
Expr *getArrayIndex(const Designator& D);
@@ -4133,7 +4133,7 @@ protected:
public:
BlockExpr(BlockDecl *BD, QualType ty)
: Expr(BlockExprClass, ty, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
- ty->isDependentType(), false,
+ ty->isDependentType(), false,
// FIXME: Check for instantiate-dependence in the statement?
ty->isInstantiationDependentType(),
false),
@@ -4197,7 +4197,7 @@ public:
bool isConstQualAdded() const { return ConstQualAdded; }
void setConstQualAdded(bool C) { ConstQualAdded = C; }
-
+
static bool classof(const Stmt *T) {
return T->getStmtClass() == BlockDeclRefExprClass;
}
@@ -4218,12 +4218,12 @@ private:
friend class ASTReader;
friend class ASTStmtReader;
explicit AsTypeExpr(EmptyShell Empty) : Expr(AsTypeExprClass, Empty) {}
-
+
public:
AsTypeExpr(Expr* SrcExpr, QualType DstType,
ExprValueKind VK, ExprObjectKind OK,
SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, SourceLocation RParenLoc)
- : Expr(AsTypeExprClass, DstType, VK, OK,
+ : Expr(AsTypeExprClass, DstType, VK, OK,
DstType->isDependentType(),
DstType->isDependentType() || SrcExpr->isValueDependent(),
(DstType->isInstantiationDependentType() ||
@@ -4231,7 +4231,7 @@ public:
(DstType->containsUnexpandedParameterPack() ||
SrcExpr->containsUnexpandedParameterPack())),
SrcExpr(SrcExpr), BuiltinLoc(BuiltinLoc), RParenLoc(RParenLoc) {}
-
+
/// getSrcExpr - Return the Expr to be converted.
Expr *getSrcExpr() const { return cast<Expr>(SrcExpr); }
@@ -4240,16 +4240,16 @@ public:
/// getRParenLoc - Return the location of final right parenthesis.
SourceLocation getRParenLoc() const { return RParenLoc; }
-
+
SourceRange getSourceRange() const {
return SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
}
-
+
static bool classof(const Stmt *T) {
- return T->getStmtClass() == AsTypeExprClass;
+ return T->getStmtClass() == AsTypeExprClass;
}
static bool classof(const AsTypeExpr *) { return true; }
-
+
// Iterators
child_range children() { return child_range(&SrcExpr, &SrcExpr+1); }
};
diff --git a/include/clang/AST/ExprCXX.h b/include/clang/AST/ExprCXX.h
index 3cc09cdf5e..3998ae8a4b 100644
--- a/include/clang/AST/ExprCXX.h
+++ b/include/clang/AST/ExprCXX.h
@@ -101,7 +101,7 @@ public:
/// argument for the member call. For example, in "x.f(5)", this
/// operation would return "x".
Expr *getImplicitObjectArgument() const;
-
+
/// Retrieves the declaration of the called method.
CXXMethodDecl *getMethodDecl() const;
@@ -158,7 +158,7 @@ class CXXNamedCastExpr : public ExplicitCastExpr {
private:
SourceLocation Loc; // the location of the casting op
SourceLocation RParenLoc; // the location of the right parenthesis
-
+
protected:
CXXNamedCastExpr(StmtClass SC, QualType ty, ExprValueKind VK,
CastKind kind, Expr *op, unsigned PathSize,
@@ -171,7 +171,7 @@ protected:
: ExplicitCastExpr(SC, Shell, PathSize) { }
friend class ASTStmtReader;
-
+
public:
const char *getCastName() const;
@@ -181,7 +181,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Retrieve the location of the closing parenthesis.
SourceLocation getRParenLoc() const { return RParenLoc; }
-
+
SourceRange getSourceRange() const {
return SourceRange(Loc, RParenLoc);
}
@@ -199,7 +199,8 @@ public:
static bool classof(const CXXNamedCastExpr *) { return true; }
};
-/// CXXStaticCastExpr - A C++ @c static_cast expression (C++ [expr.static.cast]).
+/// CXXStaticCastExpr - A C++ @c static_cast expression
+/// (C++ [expr.static.cast]).
///
/// This expression node represents a C++ static cast, e.g.,
/// @c static_cast<int>(1.0).
@@ -217,7 +218,7 @@ public:
static CXXStaticCastExpr *Create(ASTContext &Context, QualType T,
ExprValueKind VK, CastKind K, Expr *Op,
const CXXCastPath *Path,
- TypeSourceInfo *Written, SourceLocation L,
+ TypeSourceInfo *Written, SourceLocation L,
SourceLocation RParenLoc);
static CXXStaticCastExpr *CreateEmpty(ASTContext &Context,
unsigned PathSize);
@@ -248,9 +249,9 @@ public:
static CXXDynamicCastExpr *Create(ASTContext &Context, QualType T,
ExprValueKind VK, CastKind Kind, Expr *Op,
const CXXCastPath *Path,
- TypeSourceInfo *Written, SourceLocation L,
+ TypeSourceInfo *Written, SourceLocation L,
SourceLocation RParenLoc);
-
+
static CXXDynamicCastExpr *CreateEmpty(ASTContext &Context,
unsigned pathSize);
@@ -271,7 +272,7 @@ public:
class CXXReinterpretCastExpr : public CXXNamedCastExpr {
CXXReinterpretCastExpr(QualType ty, ExprValueKind vk, CastKind kind,
Expr *op, unsigned pathSize,
- TypeSourceInfo *writtenTy, SourceLocation l,
+ TypeSourceInfo *writtenTy, SourceLocation l,
SourceLocation RParenLoc)
: CXXNamedCastExpr(CXXReinterpretCastExprClass, ty, vk, kind, op,
pathSize, writtenTy, l, RParenLoc) {}
@@ -283,7 +284,7 @@ public:
static CXXReinterpretCastExpr *Create(ASTContext &Context, QualType T,
ExprValueKind VK, CastKind Kind,
Expr *Op, const CXXCastPath *Path,
- TypeSourceInfo *WrittenTy, SourceLocation L,
+ TypeSourceInfo *WrittenTy, SourceLocation L,
SourceLocation RParenLoc);
static CXXReinterpretCastExpr *CreateEmpty(ASTContext &Context,
unsigned pathSize);
@@ -301,9 +302,9 @@ public:
/// @c const_cast<char*>(PtrToConstChar).
class CXXConstCastExpr : public CXXNamedCastExpr {
CXXConstCastExpr(QualType ty, ExprValueKind VK, Expr *op,
- TypeSourceInfo *writtenTy, SourceLocation l,
+ TypeSourceInfo *writtenTy, SourceLocation l,
SourceLocation RParenLoc)
- : CXXNamedCastExpr(CXXConstCastExprClass, ty, VK, CK_NoOp, op,
+ : CXXNamedCastExpr(CXXConstCastExprClass, ty, VK, CK_NoOp, op,
0, writtenTy, l, RParenLoc) {}
explicit CXXConstCastExpr(EmptyShell Empty)
@@ -312,7 +313,7 @@ class CXXConstCastExpr : public CXXNamedCastExpr {
public:
static CXXConstCastExpr *Create(ASTContext &Context, QualType T,
ExprValueKind VK, Expr *Op,
- TypeSourceInfo *WrittenTy, SourceLocation L,
+ TypeSourceInfo *WrittenTy, SourceLocation L,
SourceLocation RParenLoc);
static CXXConstCastExpr *CreateEmpty(ASTContext &Context);
@@ -398,7 +399,7 @@ public:
Operand->getType()->isInstantiationDependentType(),
Operand->getType()->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()),
Operand(Operand), Range(R) { }
-
+
CXXTypeidExpr(QualType Ty, Expr *Operand, SourceRange R)
: Expr(CXXTypeidExprClass, Ty, VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary,
// typeid is never type-dependent (C++ [temp.dep.expr]p4)
@@ -416,9 +417,9 @@ public:
else
Operand = (TypeSourceInfo*)0;
}
-
+
bool isTypeOperand() const { return Operand.is<TypeSourceInfo *>(); }
-
+
/// \brief Retrieves the type operand of this typeid() expression after
/// various required adjustments (removing reference types, cv-qualifiers).
QualType getTypeOperand() const;
@@ -433,20 +434,20 @@ public:
assert(isTypeOperand() && "Cannot call getTypeOperand for typeid(expr)");
Operand = TSI;
}
-
+
Expr *getExprOperand() const {
assert(!isTypeOperand() && "Cannot call getExprOperand for typeid(type)");
return static_cast<Expr*>(Operand.get<Stmt *>());
}
-
+
void setExprOperand(Expr *E) {
assert(!isTypeOperand() && "Cannot call getExprOperand for typeid(type)");
Operand = E;
}
-
+
SourceRange getSourceRange() const { return Range; }
void setSourceRange(SourceRange R) { Range = R; }
-
+
static bool classof(const Stmt *T) {
return T->getStmtClass() == CXXTypeidExprClass;
}
@@ -476,7 +477,7 @@ public:
Operand->getType()->isInstantiationDependentType(),
Operand->getType()->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()),
Operand(Operand), Range(R) { }
-
+
CXXUuidofExpr(QualType Ty, Expr *Operand, SourceRange R)
: Expr(CXXUuidofExprClass, Ty, VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary,
false, Operand->isTypeDependent(),
@@ -491,9 +492,9 @@ public:
else
Operand = (TypeSourceInfo*)0;
}
-
+
bool isTypeOperand() const { return Operand.is<TypeSourceInfo *>(); }
-
+
/// \brief Retrieves the type operand of this __uuidof() expression after
/// various required adjustments (removing reference types, cv-qualifiers).
QualType getTypeOperand() const;
@@ -508,12 +509,12 @@ public:
assert(isTypeOperand() && "Cannot call getTypeOperand for __uuidof(expr)");
Operand = TSI;
}
-
+
Expr *getExprOperand() const {
assert(!isTypeOperand() && "Cannot call getExprOperand for __uuidof(type)");
return static_cast<Expr*>(Operand.get<Stmt *>());
}
-
+
void setExprOperand(Expr *E) {
assert(!isTypeOperand() && "Cannot call getExprOperand for __uuidof(type)");
Operand = E;
@@ -521,7 +522,7 @@ public:
SourceRange getSourceRange() const { return Range; }
void setSourceRange(SourceRange R) { Range = R; }
-
+
static bool classof(const Stmt *T) {
return T->getStmtClass() == CXXUuidofExprClass;
}
@@ -549,7 +550,7 @@ public:
class CXXThisExpr : public Expr {
SourceLocation Loc;
bool Implicit : 1;
-
+
public:
CXXThisExpr(SourceLocation L, QualType Type, bool isImplicit)
: Expr(CXXThisExprClass, Type, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
@@ -569,7 +570,7 @@ public:
bool isImplicit() const { return Implicit; }
void setImplicit(bool I) { Implicit = I; }
-
+
static bool classof(const Stmt *T) {
return T->getStmtClass() == CXXThisExprClass;
}
@@ -588,9 +589,9 @@ class CXXThrowExpr : public Expr {
SourceLocation ThrowLoc;
/// \brief Whether the thrown variable (if any) is in scope.
unsigned IsThrownVariableInScope : 1;
-
+
friend class ASTStmtReader;
-
+
public:
// Ty is the void type which is used as the result type of the
// exepression. The l is the location of the throw keyword. expr
@@ -614,7 +615,7 @@ public:
/// This information is required to determine whether the NRVO can apply to
/// this variable.
bool isThrownVariableInScope() const { return IsThrownVariableInScope; }
-
+
SourceRange getSourceRange() const {
if (getSubExpr() == 0)
return SourceRange(ThrowLoc, ThrowLoc);
@@ -639,16 +640,16 @@ public:
class CXXDefaultArgExpr : public Expr {
/// \brief The parameter whose default is being used.
///
- /// When the bit is set, the subexpression is stored after the
+ /// When the bit is set, the subexpression is stored after the
/// CXXDefaultArgExpr itself. When the bit is clear, the parameter's
/// actual default expression is the subexpression.
llvm::PointerIntPair<ParmVarDecl *, 1, bool> Param;
/// \brief The location where the default argument expression was used.
SourceLocation Loc;
-
+
CXXDefaultArgExpr(StmtClass SC, SourceLocation Loc, ParmVarDecl *param)
- : Expr(SC,
+ : Expr(SC,
param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()
? param->getType().getNonReferenceType()
: param->getDefaultArg()->getType(),
@@ -656,19 +657,19 @@ class CXXDefaultArgExpr : public Expr {
param->getDefaultArg()->getObjectKind(), false, false, false, false),
Param(param, false), Loc(Loc) { }
- CXXDefaultArgExpr(StmtClass SC, SourceLocation Loc, ParmVarDecl *param,
+ CXXDefaultArgExpr(StmtClass SC, SourceLocation Loc, ParmVarDecl *param,
Expr *SubExpr)
: Expr(SC, SubExpr->getType(),
SubExpr->getValueKind(), SubExpr->getObjectKind(),
- false, false, false, false),
+ false, false, false, false),
Param(param, true), Loc(Loc) {
*reinterpret_cast<Expr **>(this + 1) = SubExpr;
}
-
+
public:
CXXDefaultArgExpr(EmptyShell Empty) : Expr(CXXDefaultArgExprClass, Empty) {}
-
+
// Param is the parameter whose default argument is used by this
// expression.
static CXXDefaultArgExpr *Create(ASTContext &C, SourceLocation Loc,
@@ -678,31 +679,31 @@ public:
// Param is the parameter whose default argument is used by this
// expression, and SubExpr is the expression that will actually be used.
- static CXXDefaultArgExpr *Create(ASTContext &C,
+ static CXXDefaultArgExpr *Create(ASTContext &C,
SourceLocation Loc,
- ParmVarDecl *Param,
+ ParmVarDecl *Param,
Expr *SubExpr);
-
+
// Retrieve the parameter that the argument was created from.
const ParmVarDecl *getParam() const { return Param.getPointer(); }
ParmVarDecl *getParam() { return Param.getPointer(); }
-
+
// Retrieve the actual argument to the function call.
- const Expr *getExpr() const {
+ const Expr *getExpr() const {
if (Param.getInt())
return *reinterpret_cast<Expr const * const*> (this + 1);
- return getParam()->getDefaultArg();
+ return getParam()->getDefaultArg();
}
- Expr *getExpr() {
+ Expr *getExpr() {
if (Param.getInt())
return *reinterpret_cast<Expr **> (this + 1);
- return getParam()->getDefaultArg();
+ return getParam()->getDefaultArg();
}
- /// \brief Retrieve the location where this default argument was actually
+ /// \brief Retrieve the location where this default argument was actually
/// used.
SourceLocation getUsedLocation() const { return Loc; }
-
+
SourceRange getSourceRange() const {
// Default argument expressions have no representation in the
// source, so they have an empty source range.
@@ -757,7 +758,7 @@ class CXXBindTemporaryExpr : public Expr {
CXXBindTemporaryExpr(CXXTemporary *temp, Expr* SubExpr)
: Expr(CXXBindTemporaryExprClass, SubExpr->getType(),
- VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, SubExpr->isTypeDependent(),
+ VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, SubExpr->isTypeDependent(),
SubExpr->isValueDependent(),
SubExpr->isInstantiationDependent(),
SubExpr->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()),
@@ -766,7 +767,7 @@ class CXXBindTemporaryExpr : public Expr {
public:
CXXBindTemporaryExpr(EmptyShell Empty)
: Expr(CXXBindTemporaryExprClass, Empty), Temp(0), SubExpr(0) {}
-
+
static CXXBindTemporaryExpr *Create(ASTContext &C, CXXTemporary *Temp,
Expr* SubExpr);
@@ -778,7 +779,7 @@ public:
Expr *getSubExpr() { return cast<Expr>(SubExpr); }
void setSubExpr(Expr *E) { SubExpr = E; }
- SourceRange getSourceRange() const {
+ SourceRange getSourceRange() const {
return SubExpr->getSourceRange();
}
@@ -801,7 +802,7 @@ public:
CK_VirtualBase,
CK_Delegating
};
-
+
private:
CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor;
@@ -849,10 +850,10 @@ public:
CXXConstructorDecl* getConstructor() const { return Constructor; }
void setConstructor(CXXConstructorDecl *C) { Constructor = C; }
-
+
SourceLocation getLocation() const { return Loc; }
void setLocation(SourceLocation Loc) { this->Loc = Loc; }
-
+
/// \brief Whether this construction is elidable.
bool isElidable() const { return Elidable; }
void setElidable(bool E) { Elidable = E; }
@@ -868,16 +869,16 @@ public:
void setRequiresZeroInitialization(bool ZeroInit) {
ZeroInitialization = ZeroInit;
}
-
+
/// \brief Determines whether this constructor is actually constructing
/// a base class (rather than a complete object).
ConstructionKind getConstructionKind() const {
return (ConstructionKind)ConstructKind;
}
- void setConstructionKind(ConstructionKind CK) {
+ void setConstructionKind(ConstructionKind CK) {
ConstructKind = CK;
}
-
+
typedef ExprIterator arg_iterator;
typedef ConstExprIterator const_arg_iterator;
@@ -933,7 +934,7 @@ class CXXFunctionalCastExpr : public ExplicitCastExpr {
TypeSourceInfo *writtenTy,
SourceLocation tyBeginLoc, CastKind kind,
Expr *castExpr, unsigned pathSize,
- SourceLocation rParenLoc)
+ SourceLocation rParenLoc)
: ExplicitCastExpr(CXXFunctionalCastExprClass, ty, VK, kind,
castExpr, pathSize, writtenTy),
TyBeginLoc(tyBeginLoc), RParenLoc(rParenLoc) {}
@@ -971,7 +972,7 @@ public:
///
/// This expression type represents a C++ "functional" cast
/// (C++[expr.type.conv]) with N != 1 arguments that invokes a
-/// constructor to build a temporary object. With N == 1 arguments the
+/// constructor to build a temporary object. With N == 1 arguments the
/// functional cast expression will be represented by CXXFunctionalCastExpr.
/// Example:
/// @code
@@ -997,7 +998,7 @@ public:
TypeSourceInfo *getTypeSourceInfo() const { return Type; }
SourceRange getSourceRange() const;
-
+
static bool classof(const Stmt *T) {
return T->getStmtClass() == CXXTemporaryObjectExprClass;
}
@@ -1015,9 +1016,9 @@ class CXXScalarValueInitExpr : public Expr {
TypeSourceInfo *TypeInfo;
friend class ASTStmtReader;
-
+
public:
- /// \brief Create an explicitly-written scalar-value initialization
+ /// \brief Create an explicitly-written scalar-value initialization
/// expression.
CXXScalarValueInitExpr(QualType Type,
TypeSourceInfo *TypeInfo,
@@ -1032,7 +1033,7 @@ public:
TypeSourceInfo *getTypeSourceInfo() const {
return TypeInfo;
}
-
+
SourceLocation getRParenLoc() const { return RParenLoc; }
SourceRange getSourceRange() const;
@@ -1082,11 +1083,11 @@ class CXXNewExpr : public Expr {
/// \brief The allocated type-source information, as written in the source.
TypeSourceInfo *AllocatedTypeInfo;
-
- /// \brief If the allocated type was expressed as a parenthesized type-id,
+
+ /// \brief If the allocated type was expressed as a parenthesized type-id,
/// the source range covering the parenthesized type-id.
SourceRange TypeIdParens;
-
+
SourceLocation StartLoc;
SourceLocation EndLoc;
SourceLocation ConstructorLParen;
@@ -1110,7 +1111,7 @@ public:
void AllocateArgsArray(ASTContext &C, bool isArray, unsigned numPlaceArgs,
unsigned numConsArgs);
-
+
QualType getAllocatedType() const {
assert(getType()->isPointerType());
return getType()->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
@@ -1130,7 +1131,7 @@ public:
/// identical except that the definition of a non-throwing
/// exception specification is just "is it throw()?".
bool shouldNullCheckAllocation(ASTContext &Ctx) const;
-
+
FunctionDecl *getOperatorNew() const { return OperatorNew; }
void setOperatorNew(FunctionDecl *D) { OperatorNew = D; }
FunctionDecl *getOperatorDelete() const { return OperatorDelete; }
@@ -1147,10 +1148,10 @@ public:
}
unsigned getNumPlacementArgs() const { return NumPlacementArgs; }
- Expr **getPlacementArgs() {
- return reinterpret_cast<Expr **>(SubExprs + Array);
+ Expr **getPlacementArgs() {
+ return reinterpret_cast<Expr **>(SubExprs + Array);
}
-
+
Expr *getPlacementArg(unsigned i) {
assert(i < NumPlacementArgs && "Index out of range");
return cast<Expr>(SubExprs[Array + i]);
@@ -1174,11 +1175,11 @@ public:
}
unsigned getNumConstructorArgs() const { return NumConstructorArgs; }
-
+
Expr **getConstructorArgs() {
return reinterpret_cast<Expr **>(SubExprs + Array + NumPlacementArgs);
}
-
+
Expr *getConstructorArg(unsigned i) {
assert(i < NumConstructorArgs && "Index out of range");
return cast<Expr>(SubExprs[Array + NumPlacementArgs + i]);
@@ -1221,7 +1222,7 @@ public:
const_arg_iterator constructor_arg_end() const {
return SubExprs + Array + getNumPlacementArgs() + getNumConstructorArgs();
}
-
+
typedef Stmt **raw_arg_iterator;
raw_arg_iterator raw_arg_begin() { return SubExprs; }
raw_arg_iterator raw_arg_end() {
@@ -1308,7 +1309,7 @@ public:
/// destroyed is a dependent type which may or may not be a pointer,
/// return an invalid type.
QualType getDestroyedType() const;
-
+
SourceRange getSourceRange() const {
return SourceRange(Loc, Argument->getLocEnd());
}
@@ -1324,39 +1325,39 @@ public:
friend class ASTStmtReader;
};
-/// \brief Structure used to store the type being destroyed by a
+/// \brief Structure used to store the type being destroyed by a
/// pseudo-destructor expression.
class PseudoDestructorTypeStorage {
- /// \brief Either the type source information or the name of the type, if
+ /// \brief Either the type source information or the name of the type, if
/// it couldn't be resolved due to type-dependence.
llvm::PointerUnion<TypeSourceInfo *, IdentifierInfo *> Type;
-
+
/// \brief The starting source location of the pseudo-destructor type.
SourceLocation Location;
-
+
public:
PseudoDestructorTypeStorage() { }
-
+
PseudoDestructorTypeStorage(IdentifierInfo *II, SourceLocation Loc)
: Type(II), Location(Loc) { }
-
+
PseudoDestructorTypeStorage(TypeSourceInfo *Info);
-
- TypeSourceInfo *getTypeSourceInfo() const {
- return Type.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo *>();
+
+ TypeSourceInfo *getTypeSourceInfo() const {
+ return Type.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo *>();
}
-
+
IdentifierInfo *getIdentifier() const {
return Type.dyn_cast<IdentifierInfo *>();
}
-
+
SourceLocation getLocation() const { return Location; }
};
-
+
/// \brief Represents a C++ pseudo-destructor (C++ [expr.pseudo]).
///
/// A pseudo-destructor is an expression that looks like a member access to a
-/// destructor of a scalar type, except that scalar types don't have
+/// destructor of a scalar type, except that scalar types don't have
/// destructors. For example:
///
/// \code
@@ -1367,7 +1368,7 @@ public:
/// \endcode
///
/// Pseudo-destructors typically occur when instantiating templates such as:
-///
+///
/// \code
/// template<typename T>
/// void destroy(T* ptr) {
@@ -1387,27 +1388,27 @@ class CXXPseudoDestructorExpr : public Expr {
/// \brief The location of the '.' or '->' operator.
SourceLocation OperatorLoc;
-
+
/// \brief The nested-name-specifier that follows the operator, if present.
NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc;
/// \brief The type that precedes the '::' in a qualified pseudo-destructor
/// expression.
TypeSourceInfo *ScopeType;
-
- /// \brief The location of the '::' in a qualified pseudo-destructor
+
+ /// \brief The location of the '::' in a qualified pseudo-destructor
/// expression.
SourceLocation ColonColonLoc;
-
+
/// \brief The location of the '~'.
SourceLocation TildeLoc;
-
- /// \brief The type being destroyed, or its name if we were unable to
+
+ /// \brief The type being destroyed, or its name if we were unable to
/// resolve the name.
PseudoDestructorTypeStorage DestroyedType;
friend class ASTStmtReader;
-
+
public:
CXXPseudoDestructorExpr(ASTContext &Context,
Expr *Base, bool isArrow, SourceLocation OperatorLoc,
@@ -1431,12 +1432,12 @@ public:
/// \brief Retrieves the nested-name-specifier that qualifies the type name,
/// with source-location information.
NestedNameSpecifierLoc getQualifierLoc() const { return QualifierLoc; }
-
+
/// \brief If the member name was qualified, retrieves the
/// nested-name-specifier that precedes the member name. Otherwise, returns
/// NULL.
- NestedNameSpecifier *getQualifier() const {
- return QualifierLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier();
+ NestedNameSpecifier *getQualifier() const {
+ return QualifierLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier();
}
/// \brief Determine whether this pseudo-destructor expression was written
@@ -1446,48 +1447,48 @@ public:
/// \brief Retrieve the location of the '.' or '->' operator.
SourceLocation getOperatorLoc() const { return OperatorLoc; }
- /// \brief Retrieve the scope type in a qualified pseudo-destructor
+ /// \brief Retrieve the scope type in a qualified pseudo-destructor
/// expression.
///
/// Pseudo-destructor expressions can have extra qualification within them
/// that is not part of the nested-name-specifier, e.g., \c p->T::~T().
/// Here, if the object type of the expression is (or may be) a scalar type,
- /// \p T may also be a scalar type and, therefore, cannot be part of a
+ /// \p T may also be a scalar type and, therefore, cannot be part of a
/// nested-name-specifier. It is stored as the "scope type" of the pseudo-
/// destructor expression.
TypeSourceInfo *getScopeTypeInfo() const { return ScopeType; }
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the location of the '::' in a qualified pseudo-destructor
/// expression.
SourceLocation getColonColonLoc() const { return ColonColonLoc; }
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the location of the '~'.
SourceLocation getTildeLoc() const { return TildeLoc; }
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the source location information for the type
/// being destroyed.
///
- /// This type-source information is available for non-dependent
+ /// This type-source information is available for non-dependent
/// pseudo-destructor expressions and some dependent pseudo-destructor
/// expressions. Returns NULL if we only have the identifier for a
/// dependent pseudo-destructor expression.
- TypeSourceInfo *getDestroyedTypeInfo() const {
- return DestroyedType.getTypeSourceInfo();
+ TypeSourceInfo *getDestroyedTypeInfo() const {
+ return DestroyedType.getTypeSourceInfo();
}
-
+
/// \brief In a dependent pseudo-destructor expression for which we do not
/// have full type information on the destroyed type, provides the name
/// of the destroyed type.
IdentifierInfo *getDestroyedTypeIdentifier() const {
return DestroyedType.getIdentifier();
}
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the type being destroyed.
QualType getDestroyedType() const;
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the starting location of the type being destroyed.
- SourceLocation getDestroyedTypeLoc() const {
- return DestroyedType.getLocation();
+ SourceLocation getDestroyedTypeLoc() const {
+ return DestroyedType.getLocation();
}
/// \brief Set the name of destroyed type for a dependent pseudo-destructor
@@ -1533,7 +1534,7 @@ class UnaryTypeTraitExpr : public Expr {
TypeSourceInfo *QueriedType;
public:
- UnaryTypeTraitExpr(SourceLocation loc, UnaryTypeTrait utt,
+ UnaryTypeTraitExpr(SourceLocation loc, UnaryTypeTrait utt,
TypeSourceInfo *queried, bool value,
SourceLocation rparen, QualType ty)
: Expr(UnaryTypeTraitExprClass, ty, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
@@ -1553,7 +1554,7 @@ public:
QualType getQueriedType() const { return QueriedType->getType(); }
TypeSourceInfo *getQueriedTypeSourceInfo() const { return QueriedType; }
-
+
bool getValue() const { return Value; }
static bool classof(const Stmt *T) {
@@ -1591,10 +1592,10 @@ class BinaryTypeTraitExpr : public Expr {
TypeSourceInfo *RhsType;
public:
- BinaryTypeTraitExpr(SourceLocation loc, BinaryTypeTrait btt,
- TypeSourceInfo *lhsType, TypeSourceInfo *rhsType,
+ BinaryTypeTraitExpr(SourceLocation loc, BinaryTypeTrait btt,
+ TypeSourceInfo *lhsType, TypeSourceInfo *rhsType,
bool value, SourceLocation rparen, QualType ty)
- : Expr(BinaryTypeTraitExprClass, ty, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, false,
+ : Expr(BinaryTypeTraitExprClass, ty, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, false,
lhsType->getType()->isDependentType() ||
rhsType->getType()->isDependentType(),
(lhsType->getType()->isInstantiationDependentType() ||
@@ -1622,7 +1623,7 @@ public:
TypeSourceInfo *getLhsTypeSourceInfo() const { return LhsType; }
TypeSourceInfo *getRhsTypeSourceInfo() const { return RhsType; }
-
+
bool getValue() const { assert(!isTypeDependent()); return Value; }
static bool classof(const Stmt *T) {
@@ -1679,7 +1680,9 @@ public:
virtual ~ArrayTypeTraitExpr() { }
- virtual SourceRange getSourceRange() const { return SourceRange(Loc, RParen); }
+ virtual SourceRange getSourceRange() const {
+ return SourceRange(Loc, RParen);
+ }
ArrayTypeTrait getTrait() const { return static_cast<ArrayTypeTrait>(ATT); }
@@ -1720,7 +1723,7 @@ class ExpressionTraitExpr : public Expr {
Expr* QueriedExpression;
public:
- ExpressionTraitExpr(SourceLocation loc, ExpressionTrait et,
+ ExpressionTraitExpr(SourceLocation loc, ExpressionTrait et,
Expr *queried, bool value,
SourceLocation rparen, QualType resultType)
: Expr(ExpressionTraitExprClass, resultType, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
@@ -1729,7 +1732,8 @@ public:
queried->isTypeDependent(),
queried->isInstantiationDependent(),
queried->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()),
- ET(et), Value(value), Loc(loc), RParen(rparen), QueriedExpression(queried) { }
+ ET(et), Value(value), Loc(loc), RParen(rparen),
+ QueriedExpression(queried) { }
explicit ExpressionTraitExpr(EmptyShell Empty)
: Expr(ExpressionTraitExprClass, Empty), ET(0), Value(false),
@@ -1832,10 +1836,10 @@ public:
typedef UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator decls_iterator;
decls_iterator decls_begin() const { return UnresolvedSetIterator(Results); }
- decls_iterator decls_end() const {
+ decls_iterator decls_end() const {
return UnresolvedSetIterator(Results + NumResults);
}
-
+
/// Gets the number of declarations in the unresolved set.
unsigned getNumDecls() const { return NumResults; }
@@ -1849,11 +1853,11 @@ public:
SourceLocation getNameLoc() const { return NameInfo.getLoc(); }
/// Fetches the nested-name qualifier, if one was given.
- NestedNameSpecifier *getQualifier() const {
- return QualifierLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier();
+ NestedNameSpecifier *getQualifier() const {
+ return QualifierLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier();
}
- /// Fetches the nested-name qualifier with source-location information, if
+ /// Fetches the nested-name qualifier with source-location information, if
/// one was given.
NestedNameSpecifierLoc getQualifierLoc() const { return QualifierLoc; }
@@ -1916,15 +1920,15 @@ class UnresolvedLookupExpr : public OverloadExpr {
/// against the qualified-lookup bits.
CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass;
- UnresolvedLookupExpr(ASTContext &C,
+ UnresolvedLookupExpr(ASTContext &C,
CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass,
NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc,
const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
- bool RequiresADL, bool Overloaded,
+ bool RequiresADL, bool Overloaded,
const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
UnresolvedSetIterator Begin, UnresolvedSetIterator End,
bool StdIsAssociatedNamespace)
- : OverloadExpr(UnresolvedLookupExprClass, C, QualifierLoc, NameInfo,
+ : OverloadExpr(UnresolvedLookupExprClass, C, QualifierLoc, NameInfo,
TemplateArgs, Begin, End, false, false, false),
RequiresADL(RequiresADL),
StdIsAssociatedNamespace(StdIsAssociatedNamespace),
@@ -1938,19 +1942,19 @@ class UnresolvedLookupExpr : public OverloadExpr {
{}
friend class ASTStmtReader;
-
+
public:
static UnresolvedLookupExpr *Create(ASTContext &C,
CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass,
NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc,
const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
bool ADL, bool Overloaded,
- UnresolvedSetIterator Begin,
+ UnresolvedSetIterator Begin,
UnresolvedSetIterator End,
bool StdIsAssociatedNamespace = false) {
assert((ADL || !StdIsAssociatedNamespace) &&
"std considered associated namespace when not performing ADL");
- return new(C) UnresolvedLookupExpr(C, NamingClass, QualifierLoc, NameInfo,
+ return new(C) UnresolvedLookupExpr(C, NamingClass, QualifierLoc, NameInfo,
ADL, Overloaded, 0, Begin, End,
StdIsAssociatedNamespace);
}
@@ -1961,7 +1965,7 @@ public:
const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
bool ADL,
const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
- UnresolvedSetIterator Begin,
+ UnresolvedSetIterator Begin,
UnresolvedSetIterator End);
static UnresolvedLookupExpr *CreateEmpty(ASTContext &C,
@@ -2012,7 +2016,7 @@ public:
void copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgumentListInfo &List) const {
getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(List);
}
-
+
SourceLocation getLAngleLoc() const {
return getExplicitTemplateArgs().LAngleLoc;
}
@@ -2031,9 +2035,9 @@ public:
SourceRange getSourceRange() const {
SourceRange Range(getNameInfo().getSourceRange());
- if (getQualifierLoc())
+ if (getQualifierLoc())
Range.setBegin(getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc());
- if (hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
+ if (hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
Range.setEnd(getRAngleLoc());
return Range;
}
@@ -2064,7 +2068,7 @@ class DependentScopeDeclRefExpr : public Expr {
/// \brief The nested-name-specifier that qualifies this unresolved
/// declaration name.
NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc;
-
+
/// The name of the entity we will be referencing.
DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
@@ -2098,12 +2102,12 @@ public:
/// \brief Retrieve the nested-name-specifier that qualifies the
/// name, with source location information.
NestedNameSpecifierLoc getQualifierLoc() const { return QualifierLoc; }
-
-
+
+
/// \brief Retrieve the nested-name-specifier that qualifies this
/// declaration.
- NestedNameSpecifier *getQualifier() const {
- return QualifierLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier();
+ NestedNameSpecifier *getQualifier() const {
+ return QualifierLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier();
}
/// Determines whether this lookup had explicit template arguments.
@@ -2137,7 +2141,7 @@ public:
void copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgumentListInfo &List) const {
getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(List);
}
-
+
SourceLocation getLAngleLoc() const {
return getExplicitTemplateArgs().LAngleLoc;
}
@@ -2185,19 +2189,19 @@ class ExprWithCleanups : public Expr {
ExprWithCleanups(ASTContext &C, Expr *SubExpr,
CXXTemporary **Temps, unsigned NumTemps);
-
+
public:
ExprWithCleanups(EmptyShell Empty)
: Expr(ExprWithCleanupsClass, Empty),
SubExpr(0), Temps(0), NumTemps(0) {}
-
+
static ExprWithCleanups *Create(ASTContext &C, Expr *SubExpr,
- CXXTemporary **Temps,
+ CXXTemporary **Temps,
unsigned NumTemps);
unsigned getNumTemporaries() const { return NumTemps; }
void setNumTemporaries(ASTContext &C, unsigned N);
-
+
CXXTemporary *getTemporary(unsigned i) {
assert(i < NumTemps && "Index out of range");
return Temps[i];
@@ -2214,7 +2218,7 @@ public:
const Expr *getSubExpr() const { return cast<Expr>(SubExpr); }
void setSubExpr(Expr *E) { SubExpr = E; }
- SourceRange getSourceRange() const {
+ SourceRange getSourceRange() const {
return SubExpr->getSourceRange();
}
@@ -2252,7 +2256,7 @@ public:
class CXXUnresolvedConstructExpr : public Expr {
/// \brief The type being constructed.
TypeSourceInfo *Type;
-
+
/// \brief The location of the left parentheses ('(').
SourceLocation LParenLoc;
@@ -2272,7 +2276,7 @@ class CXXUnresolvedConstructExpr : public Expr {
: Expr(CXXUnresolvedConstructExprClass, Empty), Type(), NumArgs(NumArgs) { }
friend class ASTStmtReader;
-
+
public:
static CXXUnresolvedConstructExpr *Create(ASTContext &C,
TypeSourceInfo *Type,
@@ -2288,10 +2292,10 @@ public:
/// in the source code.
QualType getTypeAsWritten() const { return Type->getType(); }
- /// \brief Retrieve the type source information for the type being
+ /// \brief Retrieve the type source information for the type being
/// constructed.
TypeSourceInfo *getTypeSourceInfo() const { return Type; }
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the location of the left parentheses ('(') that
/// precedes the argument list.
SourceLocation getLParenLoc() const { return LParenLoc; }
@@ -2333,7 +2337,7 @@ public:
}
SourceRange getSourceRange() const;
-
+
static bool classof(const Stmt *T) {
return T->getStmtClass() == CXXUnresolvedConstructExprClass;
}
@@ -2417,7 +2421,7 @@ public:
const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs);
static CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *
- CreateEmpty(ASTContext &C, bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs,
+ CreateEmpty(ASTContext &C, bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs,
unsigned NumTemplateArgs);
/// \brief True if this is an implicit access, i.e. one in which the
@@ -2443,15 +2447,15 @@ public:
/// \brief Retrieve the nested-name-specifier that qualifies the member
/// name.
- NestedNameSpecifier *getQualifier() const {
- return QualifierLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier();
+ NestedNameSpecifier *getQualifier() const {
+ return QualifierLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier();
}
/// \brief Retrieve the nested-name-specifier that qualifies the member
/// name, with source location information.
NestedNameSpecifierLoc getQualifierLoc() const { return QualifierLoc; }
-
-
+
+
/// \brief Retrieve the first part of the nested-name-specifier that was
/// found in the scope of the member access expression when the member access
/// was initially parsed.
@@ -2615,13 +2619,13 @@ class UnresolvedMemberExpr : public OverloadExpr {
const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo,
const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
UnresolvedSetIterator Begin, UnresolvedSetIterator End);
-
+
UnresolvedMemberExpr(EmptyShell Empty)
: OverloadExpr(UnresolvedMemberExprClass, Empty), IsArrow(false),
HasUnresolvedUsing(false), Base(0) { }
friend class ASTStmtReader;
-
+
public:
static UnresolvedMemberExpr *
Create(ASTContext &C, bool HasUnresolvedUsing,
@@ -2796,7 +2800,7 @@ public:
child_range children() { return child_range(&Operand, &Operand + 1); }
};
-/// \brief Represents a C++0x pack expansion that produces a sequence of
+/// \brief Represents a C++0x pack expansion that produces a sequence of
/// expressions.
///
/// A pack expansion expression contains a pattern (which itself is an
@@ -2810,29 +2814,29 @@ public:
/// \endcode
///
/// Here, the argument to the function object \c f is a pack expansion whose
-/// pattern is \c static_cast<Types&&>(args). When the \c forward function
+/// pattern is \c static_cast<Types&&>(args). When the \c forward function
/// template is instantiated, the pack expansion will instantiate to zero or
/// or more function arguments to the function object \c f.
class PackExpansionExpr : public Expr {
SourceLocation EllipsisLoc;
-
+
/// \brief The number of expansions that will be produced by this pack
/// expansion expression, if known.
///
/// When zero, the number of expansions is not known. Otherwise, this value
/// is the number of expansions + 1.
unsigned NumExpansions;
-
+
Stmt *Pattern;
-
+
friend class ASTStmtReader;
friend class ASTStmtWriter;
-
+
public:
PackExpansionExpr(QualType T, Expr *Pattern, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc,
llvm::Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions)
- : Expr(PackExpansionExprClass, T, Pattern->getValueKind(),
- Pattern->getObjectKind(), /*TypeDependent=*/true,
+ : Expr(PackExpansionExprClass, T, Pattern->getValueKind(),
+ Pattern->getObjectKind(), /*TypeDependent=*/true,
/*ValueDependent=*/true, /*InstantiationDependent=*/true,
/*ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack=*/false),
EllipsisLoc(EllipsisLoc),
@@ -2840,7 +2844,7 @@ public:
Pattern(Pattern) { }
PackExpansionExpr(EmptyShell Empty) : Expr(PackExpansionExprClass, Empty) { }
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the pattern of the pack expansion.
Expr *getPattern() { return reinterpret_cast<Expr *>(Pattern); }
@@ -2850,16 +2854,16 @@ public:
/// \brief Retrieve the location of the ellipsis that describes this pack
/// expansion.
SourceLocation getEllipsisLoc() const { return EllipsisLoc; }
-
- /// \brief Determine the number of expansions that will be produced when
+
+ /// \brief Determine the number of expansions that will be produced when
/// this pack expansion is instantiated, if already known.
llvm::Optional<unsigned> getNumExpansions() const {
if (NumExpansions)
return NumExpansions - 1;
-
+
return llvm::Optional<unsigned>();
}
-
+
SourceRange getSourceRange() const {
return SourceRange(Pattern->getLocStart(), EllipsisLoc);
}
@@ -2868,13 +2872,13 @@ public:
return T->getStmtClass() == PackExpansionExprClass;
}
static bool classof(const PackExpansionExpr *) { return true; }
-
+
// Iterators
child_range children() {
return child_range(&Pattern, &Pattern + 1);
}
};
-
+
inline ASTTemplateArgumentListInfo &OverloadExpr::getExplicitTemplateArgs() {
if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(this))
return cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(this)->getExplicitTemplateArgs();
@@ -2882,7 +2886,7 @@ inline ASTTemplateArgumentListInfo &OverloadExpr::getExplicitTemplateArgs() {
return cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(this)->getExplicitTemplateArgs();
}
-/// \brief Represents an expression that computes the length of a parameter
+/// \brief Represents an expression that computes the length of a parameter
/// pack.
///
/// \code
@@ -2894,30 +2898,30 @@ inline ASTTemplateArgumentListInfo &OverloadExpr::getExplicitTemplateArgs() {
class SizeOfPackExpr : public Expr {
/// \brief The location of the 'sizeof' keyword.
SourceLocation OperatorLoc;
-
+
/// \brief The location of the name of the parameter pack.
SourceLocation PackLoc;
-
+
/// \brief The location of the closing parenthesis.
SourceLocation RParenLoc;
-
+
/// \brief The length of the parameter pack, if known.
///
/// When this expression is value-dependent, the length of the parameter pack
/// is unknown. When this expression is not value-dependent, the length is
/// known.
unsigned Length;
-
+
/// \brief The parameter pack itself.
NamedDecl *Pack;
-
+
friend class ASTStmtReader;
friend class ASTStmtWriter;
-
+
public:
/// \brief Creates a value-dependent expression that computes the length of
/// the given parameter pack.
- SizeOfPackExpr(QualType SizeType, SourceLocation OperatorLoc, NamedDecl *Pack,
+ SizeOfPackExpr(QualType SizeType, SourceLocation OperatorLoc, NamedDecl *Pack,
SourceLocation PackLoc, SourceLocation RParenLoc)
: Expr(SizeOfPackExprClass, SizeType, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
/*TypeDependent=*/false, /*ValueDependent=*/true,
@@ -2928,7 +2932,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Creates an expression that computes the length of
/// the given parameter pack, which is already known.
- SizeOfPackExpr(QualType SizeType, SourceLocation OperatorLoc, NamedDecl *Pack,
+ SizeOfPackExpr(QualType SizeType, SourceLocation OperatorLoc, NamedDecl *Pack,
SourceLocation PackLoc, SourceLocation RParenLoc,
unsigned Length)
: Expr(SizeOfPackExprClass, SizeType, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
@@ -2940,38 +2944,38 @@ public:
/// \brief Create an empty expression.
SizeOfPackExpr(EmptyShell Empty) : Expr(SizeOfPackExprClass, Empty) { }
-
+
/// \brief Determine the location of the 'sizeof' keyword.
SourceLocation getOperatorLoc() const { return OperatorLoc; }
/// \brief Determine the location of the parameter pack.
SourceLocation getPackLoc() const { return PackLoc; }
-
+
/// \brief Determine the location of the right parenthesis.
SourceLocation getRParenLoc() const { return RParenLoc; }
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the parameter pack.
NamedDecl *getPack() const { return Pack; }
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the length of the parameter pack.
///
- /// This routine may only be invoked when the expression is not
+ /// This routine may only be invoked when the expression is not
/// value-dependent.
unsigned getPackLength() const {
- assert(!isValueDependent() &&
+ assert(!isValueDependent() &&
"Cannot get the length of a value-dependent pack size expression");
return Length;
}
-
+
SourceRange getSourceRange() const {
return SourceRange(OperatorLoc, RParenLoc);
}
-
+
static bool classof(const Stmt *T) {
return T->getStmtClass() == SizeOfPackExprClass;
}
static bool classof(const SizeOfPackExpr *) { return true; }
-
+
// Iterators
child_range children() { return child_range(); }
};
@@ -2990,11 +2994,11 @@ class SubstNonTypeTemplateParmExpr : public Expr {
friend class ASTReader;
friend class ASTStmtReader;
- explicit SubstNonTypeTemplateParmExpr(EmptyShell Empty)
+ explicit SubstNonTypeTemplateParmExpr(EmptyShell Empty)
: Expr(SubstNonTypeTemplateParmExprClass, Empty) { }
public:
- SubstNonTypeTemplateParmExpr(QualType type,
+ SubstNonTypeTemplateParmExpr(QualType type,
ExprValueKind valueKind,
SourceLocation loc,
NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *param,
@@ -3009,16 +3013,16 @@ public:
SourceRange getSourceRange() const { return NameLoc; }
Expr *getReplacement() const { return cast<Expr>(Replacement); }
-
+
NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *getParameter() const { return Param; }
static bool classof(const Stmt *s) {
return s->getStmtClass() == SubstNonTypeTemplateParmExprClass;
}
- static bool classof(const SubstNonTypeTemplateParmExpr *) {
- return true;
+ static bool classof(const SubstNonTypeTemplateParmExpr *) {
+ return true;
}
-
+
// Iterators
child_range children() { return child_range(&Replacement, &Replacement+1); }
};
@@ -3028,7 +3032,7 @@ public:
///
/// When a pack expansion in the source code contains multiple parameter packs
/// and those parameter packs correspond to different levels of template
-/// parameter lists, this node node is used to represent a non-type template
+/// parameter lists, this node node is used to represent a non-type template
/// parameter pack from an outer level, which has already had its argument pack
/// substituted but that still lives within a pack expansion that itself
/// could not be instantiated. When actually performing a substitution into
@@ -3038,47 +3042,47 @@ public:
class SubstNonTypeTemplateParmPackExpr : public Expr {
/// \brief The non-type template parameter pack itself.
NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *Param;
-
+
/// \brief A pointer to the set of template arguments that this
/// parameter pack is instantiated with.
const TemplateArgument *Arguments;
-
+
/// \brief The number of template arguments in \c Arguments.
unsigned NumArguments;
-
+
/// \brief The location of the non-type template parameter pack reference.
SourceLocation NameLoc;
-
+
friend class ASTReader;
friend class ASTStmtReader;
- explicit SubstNonTypeTemplateParmPackExpr(EmptyShell Empty)
+ explicit SubstNonTypeTemplateParmPackExpr(EmptyShell Empty)
: Expr(SubstNonTypeTemplateParmPackExprClass, Empty) { }
-
+
public:
- SubstNonTypeTemplateParmPackExpr(QualType T,
+ SubstNonTypeTemplateParmPackExpr(QualType T,
NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *Param,
SourceLocation NameLoc,
const TemplateArgument &ArgPack);
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the non-type template parameter pack being substituted.
NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *getParameterPack() const { return Param; }
/// \brief Retrieve the location of the parameter pack name.
SourceLocation getParameterPackLocation() const { return NameLoc; }
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the template argument pack containing the substituted
/// template arguments.
TemplateArgument getArgumentPack() const;
SourceRange getSourceRange() const { return NameLoc; }
-
+
static bool classof(const Stmt *T) {
return T->getStmtClass() == SubstNonTypeTemplateParmPackExprClass;
}
- static bool classof(const SubstNonTypeTemplateParmPackExpr *) {
- return true;
+ static bool classof(const SubstNonTypeTemplateParmPackExpr *) {
+ return true;
}
-
+
// Iterators
child_range children() { return child_range(); }
};
@@ -3103,12 +3107,12 @@ class MaterializeTemporaryExpr : public Expr {
/// \brief The temporary-generating expression whose value will be
/// materialized.
Stmt *Temporary;
-
+
friend class ASTStmtReader;
friend class ASTStmtWriter;
-
+
public:
- MaterializeTemporaryExpr(QualType T, Expr *Temporary,
+ MaterializeTemporaryExpr(QualType T, Expr *Temporary,
bool BoundToLvalueReference)
: Expr(MaterializeTemporaryExprClass, T,
BoundToLvalueReference? VK_LValue : VK_XValue, OK_Ordinary,
@@ -3116,33 +3120,33 @@ public:
Temporary->isInstantiationDependent(),
Temporary->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()),
Temporary(Temporary) { }
-
- MaterializeTemporaryExpr(EmptyShell Empty)
+
+ MaterializeTemporaryExpr(EmptyShell Empty)
: Expr(MaterializeTemporaryExprClass, Empty) { }
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the temporary-generating subexpression whose value will
/// be materialized into a glvalue.
Expr *GetTemporaryExpr() const { return reinterpret_cast<Expr *>(Temporary); }
-
+
/// \brief Determine whether this materialized temporary is bound to an
/// lvalue reference; otherwise, it's bound to an rvalue reference.
- bool isBoundToLvalueReference() const {
+ bool isBoundToLvalueReference() const {
return getValueKind() == VK_LValue;
}
-
+
SourceRange getSourceRange() const { return Temporary->getSourceRange(); }
-
+
static bool classof(const Stmt *T) {
return T->getStmtClass() == MaterializeTemporaryExprClass;
}
- static bool classof(const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *) {
- return true;
+ static bool classof(const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *) {
+ return true;
}
-
+
// Iterators
child_range children() { return child_range(&Temporary, &Temporary + 1); }
};
-
+
} // end namespace clang
#endif
diff --git a/include/clang/AST/NestedNameSpecifier.h b/include/clang/AST/NestedNameSpecifier.h
index c81c06e332..e831113863 100644
--- a/include/clang/AST/NestedNameSpecifier.h
+++ b/include/clang/AST/NestedNameSpecifier.h
@@ -95,7 +95,8 @@ private:
Specifier(Other.Specifier) {
}
- NestedNameSpecifier &operator=(const NestedNameSpecifier &); // do not implement
+ NestedNameSpecifier &operator=(const NestedNameSpecifier &); // do not
+ // implement
/// \brief Either find or insert the given nested name specifier
/// mockup in the given context.
@@ -221,12 +222,12 @@ class NestedNameSpecifierLoc {
public:
/// \brief Construct an empty nested-name-specifier.
NestedNameSpecifierLoc() : Qualifier(0), Data(0) { }
-
+
/// \brief Construct a nested-name-specifier with source location information
- /// from
+ /// from
NestedNameSpecifierLoc(NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier, void *Data)
: Qualifier(Qualifier), Data(Data) { }
-
+
/// \brief Evalutes true when this nested-name-specifier location is
/// non-empty.
operator bool() const { return Qualifier; }
@@ -239,7 +240,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Retrieve the opaque pointer that refers to source-location data.
void *getOpaqueData() const { return Data; }
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the source range covering the entirety of this
/// nested-name-specifier.
///
@@ -258,25 +259,25 @@ public:
/// \brief Retrieve the location of the beginning of this
/// nested-name-specifier.
- SourceLocation getBeginLoc() const {
+ SourceLocation getBeginLoc() const {
return getSourceRange().getBegin();
}
/// \brief Retrieve the location of the end of this
/// nested-name-specifier.
- SourceLocation getEndLoc() const {
+ SourceLocation getEndLoc() const {
return getSourceRange().getEnd();
}
/// \brief Retrieve the location of the beginning of this
/// component of the nested-name-specifier.
- SourceLocation getLocalBeginLoc() const {
+ SourceLocation getLocalBeginLoc() const {
return getLocalSourceRange().getBegin();
}
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the location of the end of this component of the
/// nested-name-specifier.
- SourceLocation getLocalEndLoc() const {
+ SourceLocation getLocalEndLoc() const {
return getLocalSourceRange().getEnd();
}
@@ -300,13 +301,13 @@ public:
/// \brief Determines the data length for the entire
/// nested-name-specifier.
unsigned getDataLength() const { return getDataLength(Qualifier); }
-
- friend bool operator==(NestedNameSpecifierLoc X,
+
+ friend bool operator==(NestedNameSpecifierLoc X,
NestedNameSpecifierLoc Y) {
return X.Qualifier == Y.Qualifier && X.Data == Y.Data;
}
- friend bool operator!=(NestedNameSpecifierLoc X,
+ friend bool operator!=(NestedNameSpecifierLoc X,
NestedNameSpecifierLoc Y) {
return !(X == Y);
}
@@ -316,39 +317,39 @@ public:
/// with source-location information for all of the components of the
/// nested-name-specifier.
class NestedNameSpecifierLocBuilder {
- /// \brief The current representation of the nested-name-specifier we're
+ /// \brief The current representation of the nested-name-specifier we're
/// building.
NestedNameSpecifier *Representation;
-
+
/// \brief Buffer used to store source-location information for the
/// nested-name-specifier.
///
- /// Note that we explicitly manage the buffer (rather than using a
+ /// Note that we explicitly manage the buffer (rather than using a
/// SmallVector) because \c Declarator expects it to be possible to memcpy()
/// a \c CXXScopeSpec, and CXXScopeSpec uses a NestedNameSpecifierLocBuilder.
char *Buffer;
-
+
/// \brief The size of the buffer used to store source-location information
/// for the nested-name-specifier.
unsigned BufferSize;
-
- /// \brief The capacity of the buffer used to store source-location
+
+ /// \brief The capacity of the buffer used to store source-location
/// information for the nested-name-specifier.
unsigned BufferCapacity;
public:
NestedNameSpecifierLocBuilder();
-
+
NestedNameSpecifierLocBuilder(const NestedNameSpecifierLocBuilder &Other);
-
+
NestedNameSpecifierLocBuilder &
operator=(const NestedNameSpecifierLocBuilder &Other);
-
+
~NestedNameSpecifierLocBuilder();
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the representation of the nested-name-specifier.
NestedNameSpecifier *getRepresentation() const { return Representation; }
-
+
/// \brief Extend the current nested-name-specifier by another
/// nested-name-specifier component of the form 'type::'.
///
@@ -362,8 +363,8 @@ public:
/// \param ColonColonLoc The location of the trailing '::'.
void Extend(ASTContext &Context, SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, TypeLoc TL,
SourceLocation ColonColonLoc);
-
- /// \brief Extend the current nested-name-specifier by another
+
+ /// \brief Extend the current nested-name-specifier by another
/// nested-name-specifier component of the form 'identifier::'.
///
/// \param Context The AST context in which this nested-name-specifier
@@ -376,8 +377,8 @@ public:
/// \param ColonColonLoc The location of the trailing '::'.
void Extend(ASTContext &Context, IdentifierInfo *Identifier,
SourceLocation IdentifierLoc, SourceLocation ColonColonLoc);
-
- /// \brief Extend the current nested-name-specifier by another
+
+ /// \brief Extend the current nested-name-specifier by another
/// nested-name-specifier component of the form 'namespace::'.
///
/// \param Context The AST context in which this nested-name-specifier
@@ -390,8 +391,8 @@ public:
/// \param ColonColonLoc The location of the trailing '::'.
void Extend(ASTContext &Context, NamespaceDecl *Namespace,
SourceLocation NamespaceLoc, SourceLocation ColonColonLoc);
-
- /// \brief Extend the current nested-name-specifier by another
+
+ /// \brief Extend the current nested-name-specifier by another
/// nested-name-specifier component of the form 'namespace-alias::'.
///
/// \param Context The AST context in which this nested-name-specifier
@@ -399,35 +400,35 @@ public:
///
/// \param Alias The namespace alias.
///
- /// \param AliasLoc The location of the namespace alias
+ /// \param AliasLoc The location of the namespace alias
/// name.
///
/// \param ColonColonLoc The location of the trailing '::'.
void Extend(ASTContext &Context, NamespaceAliasDecl *Alias,
SourceLocation AliasLoc, SourceLocation ColonColonLoc);
-
+
/// \brief Turn this (empty) nested-name-specifier into the global
/// nested-name-specifier '::'.
void MakeGlobal(ASTContext &Context, SourceLocation ColonColonLoc);
-
+
/// \brief Make a new nested-name-specifier from incomplete source-location
/// information.
///
/// This routine should be used very, very rarely, in cases where we
/// need to synthesize a nested-name-specifier. Most code should instead use
/// \c Adopt() with a proper \c NestedNameSpecifierLoc.
- void MakeTrivial(ASTContext &Context, NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
+ void MakeTrivial(ASTContext &Context, NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
SourceRange R);
-
- /// \brief Adopt an existing nested-name-specifier (with source-range
+
+ /// \brief Adopt an existing nested-name-specifier (with source-range
/// information).
void Adopt(NestedNameSpecifierLoc Other);
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the source range covered by this nested-name-specifier.
SourceRange getSourceRange() const {
return NestedNameSpecifierLoc(Representation, Buffer).getSourceRange();
}
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve a nested-name-specifier with location information,
/// copied into the given AST context.
///
@@ -449,7 +450,7 @@ public:
Representation = 0;
BufferSize = 0;
}
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the underlying buffer.
///
/// \returns A pair containing a pointer to the buffer of source-location
@@ -459,9 +460,9 @@ public:
return std::make_pair(Buffer, BufferSize);
}
};
-
-/// Insertion operator for diagnostics. This allows sending NestedNameSpecifiers
-/// into a diagnostic with <<.
+
+/// Insertion operator for diagnostics. This allows sending
+/// NestedNameSpecifiers into a diagnostic with <<.
inline const DiagnosticBuilder &operator<<(const DiagnosticBuilder &DB,
NestedNameSpecifier *NNS) {
DB.AddTaggedVal(reinterpret_cast<intptr_t>(NNS),
diff --git a/include/clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h b/include/clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h
index 409f83019f..f553ec1f95 100644
--- a/include/clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h
+++ b/include/clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h
@@ -147,7 +147,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Return whether this visitor should recurse into the types of
/// TypeLocs.
bool shouldWalkTypesOfTypeLocs() const { return true; }
-
+
/// \brief Recursively visit a statement or expression, by
/// dispatching to Traverse*() based on the argument's dynamic type.
///
@@ -181,7 +181,7 @@ public:
/// \returns false if the visitation was terminated early, true otherwise.
bool TraverseNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS);
- /// \brief Recursively visit a C++ nested-name-specifier with location
+ /// \brief Recursively visit a C++ nested-name-specifier with location
/// information.
///
/// \returns false if the visitation was terminated early, true otherwise.
@@ -191,7 +191,7 @@ public:
///
/// \returns false if the visitation was terminated early, true otherwise.
bool TraverseDeclarationNameInfo(DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo);
-
+
/// \brief Recursively visit a template name and dispatch to the
/// appropriate method.
///
@@ -530,23 +530,23 @@ bool RecursiveASTVisitor<Derived>::TraverseNestedNameSpecifierLoc(
NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNS) {
if (!NNS)
return true;
-
+
if (NestedNameSpecifierLoc Prefix = NNS.getPrefix())
TRY_TO(TraverseNestedNameSpecifierLoc(Prefix));
-
+
switch (NNS.getNestedNameSpecifier()->getKind()) {
case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier:
case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace:
case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias:
case NestedNameSpecifier::Global:
return true;
-
+
case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec:
case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate:
TRY_TO(TraverseTypeLoc(NNS.getTypeLoc()));
break;
}
-
+
return true;
}
@@ -559,9 +559,9 @@ bool RecursiveASTVisitor<Derived>::TraverseDeclarationNameInfo(
case DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName:
if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = NameInfo.getNamedTypeInfo())
TRY_TO(TraverseTypeLoc(TSInfo->getTypeLoc()));
-
+
break;
-
+
case DeclarationName::Identifier:
case DeclarationName::ObjCZeroArgSelector:
case DeclarationName::ObjCOneArgSelector:
@@ -571,7 +571,7 @@ bool RecursiveASTVisitor<Derived>::TraverseDeclarationNameInfo(
case DeclarationName::CXXUsingDirective:
break;
}
-
+
return true;
}
@@ -630,7 +630,7 @@ bool RecursiveASTVisitor<Derived>::TraverseTemplateArgumentLoc(
// FIXME: how can TSI ever be NULL?
if (TypeSourceInfo *TSI = ArgLoc.getTypeSourceInfo())
return getDerived().TraverseTypeLoc(TSI->getTypeLoc());
- else
+ else
return getDerived().TraverseType(Arg.getAsType());
}
@@ -669,7 +669,7 @@ bool RecursiveASTVisitor<Derived>::TraverseConstructorInitializer(
CXXCtorInitializer *Init) {
if (TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = Init->getTypeSourceInfo())
TRY_TO(TraverseTypeLoc(TInfo->getTypeLoc()));
-
+
if (Init->isWritten())
TRY_TO(TraverseStmt(Init->getInit()));
return true;
@@ -854,8 +854,8 @@ DEF_TRAVERSE_TYPE(AtomicType, {
// ----------------- TypeLoc traversal -----------------
// This macro makes available a variable TL, the passed-in TypeLoc.
-// If requested, it calls WalkUpFrom* for the Type in the given TypeLoc,
-// in addition to WalkUpFrom* for the TypeLoc itself, such that existing
+// If requested, it calls WalkUpFrom* for the Type in the given TypeLoc,
+// in addition to WalkUpFrom* for the TypeLoc itself, such that existing
// clients that override the WalkUpFrom*Type() and/or Visit*Type() methods
// continue to work.
#define DEF_TRAVERSE_TYPELOC(TYPE, CODE) \
@@ -1054,7 +1054,7 @@ DEF_TRAVERSE_TYPELOC(DependentTemplateSpecializationType, {
if (TL.getQualifierLoc()) {
TRY_TO(TraverseNestedNameSpecifierLoc(TL.getQualifierLoc()));
}
-
+
for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
TRY_TO(TraverseTemplateArgumentLoc(TL.getArgLoc(I)));
}
@@ -1196,8 +1196,8 @@ DEF_TRAVERSE_DECL(NamespaceAliasDecl, {
DEF_TRAVERSE_DECL(LabelDecl, {
// There is no code in a LabelDecl.
})
-
-
+
+
DEF_TRAVERSE_DECL(NamespaceDecl, {
// Code in an unnamed namespace shows up automatically in
// decls_begin()/decls_end(). Thus we don't need to recurse on
@@ -1345,7 +1345,8 @@ template<typename Derived>
bool RecursiveASTVisitor<Derived>::TraverseFunctionInstantiations(
FunctionTemplateDecl* D) {
FunctionTemplateDecl::spec_iterator end = D->spec_end();
- for (FunctionTemplateDecl::spec_iterator it = D->spec_begin(); it != end; ++it) {
+ for (FunctionTemplateDecl::spec_iterator it = D->spec_begin(); it != end;
+ ++it) {
FunctionDecl* FD = *it;
switch (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
@@ -1770,7 +1771,7 @@ DEF_TRAVERSE_STMT(ObjCAtTryStmt, { })
DEF_TRAVERSE_STMT(ObjCForCollectionStmt, { })
DEF_TRAVERSE_STMT(ObjCAutoreleasePoolStmt, { })
DEF_TRAVERSE_STMT(CXXForRangeStmt, { })
-DEF_TRAVERSE_STMT(MSDependentExistsStmt, {
+DEF_TRAVERSE_STMT(MSDependentExistsStmt, {
TRY_TO(TraverseNestedNameSpecifierLoc(S->getQualifierLoc()));
TRY_TO(TraverseDeclarationNameInfo(S->getNameInfo()));
})
@@ -1986,7 +1987,7 @@ DEF_TRAVERSE_STMT(CXXDefaultArgExpr, { })
DEF_TRAVERSE_STMT(CXXDeleteExpr, { })
DEF_TRAVERSE_STMT(ExprWithCleanups, { })
DEF_TRAVERSE_STMT(CXXNullPtrLiteralExpr, { })
-DEF_TRAVERSE_STMT(CXXPseudoDestructorExpr, {
+DEF_TRAVERSE_STMT(CXXPseudoDestructorExpr, {
TRY_TO(TraverseNestedNameSpecifierLoc(S->getQualifierLoc()));
if (TypeSourceInfo *ScopeInfo = S->getScopeTypeInfo())
TRY_TO(TraverseTypeLoc(ScopeInfo->getTypeLoc()));
@@ -2018,15 +2019,15 @@ DEF_TRAVERSE_STMT(StmtExpr, { })
DEF_TRAVERSE_STMT(UnresolvedLookupExpr, {
TRY_TO(TraverseNestedNameSpecifierLoc(S->getQualifierLoc()));
if (S->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
- TRY_TO(TraverseTemplateArgumentLocsHelper(S->getTemplateArgs(),
+ TRY_TO(TraverseTemplateArgumentLocsHelper(S->getTemplateArgs(),
S->getNumTemplateArgs()));
}
})
-
+
DEF_TRAVERSE_STMT(UnresolvedMemberExpr, {
TRY_TO(TraverseNestedNameSpecifierLoc(S->getQualifierLoc()));
if (S->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
- TRY_TO(TraverseTemplateArgumentLocsHelper(S->getTemplateArgs(),
+ TRY_TO(TraverseTemplateArgumentLocsHelper(S->getTemplateArgs(),
S->getNumTemplateArgs()));
}
})
@@ -2061,7 +2062,7 @@ DEF_TRAVERSE_STMT(FloatingLiteral, { })
DEF_TRAVERSE_STMT(ImaginaryLiteral, { })
DEF_TRAVERSE_STMT(StringLiteral, { })
DEF_TRAVERSE_STMT(ObjCStringLiteral, { })
-
+
// Traverse OpenCL: AsType, Convert.
DEF_TRAVERSE_STMT(AsTypeExpr, { })
diff --git a/include/clang/AST/Stmt.h b/include/clang/AST/Stmt.h
index 83836b717b..3dc8a41714 100644
--- a/include/clang/AST/Stmt.h
+++ b/include/clang/AST/Stmt.h
@@ -39,11 +39,11 @@ namespace clang {
class StringLiteral;
class SwitchStmt;
- //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
+ //===--------------------------------------------------------------------===//
// ExprIterator - Iterators for iterating over Stmt* arrays that contain
// only Expr*. This is needed because AST nodes use Stmt* arrays to store
// references to children (to be compatible with StmtIterator).
- //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
+ //===--------------------------------------------------------------------===//
class Stmt;
class Expr;
@@ -261,7 +261,7 @@ public:
if (Stmt::CollectingStats()) Stmt::addStmtClass(SC);
}
- StmtClass getStmtClass() const {
+ StmtClass getStmtClass() const {
return static_cast<StmtClass>(StmtBits.sClass);
}
const char *getStmtClassName() const;
@@ -497,7 +497,7 @@ public:
body_iterator body_begin() { return Body; }
body_iterator body_end() { return Body + size(); }
Stmt *body_back() { return !body_empty() ? Body[size()-1] : 0; }
-
+
void setLastStmt(Stmt *S) {
assert(!body_empty() && "setLastStmt");
Body[size()-1] = S;
@@ -545,7 +545,7 @@ public:
child_range children() {
return child_range(&Body[0], &Body[0]+CompoundStmtBits.NumStmts);
}
-
+
const_child_range children() const {
return child_range(&Body[0], &Body[0]+CompoundStmtBits.NumStmts);
}
@@ -679,7 +679,7 @@ public:
child_range children() { return child_range(&SubStmt, &SubStmt+1); }
};
-
+
/// LabelStmt - Represents a label, which has a substatement. For example:
/// foo: return;
///
@@ -724,11 +724,11 @@ class IfStmt : public Stmt {
SourceLocation IfLoc;
SourceLocation ElseLoc;
-
+
public:
- IfStmt(ASTContext &C, SourceLocation IL, VarDecl *var, Expr *cond,
+ IfStmt(ASTContext &C, SourceLocation IL, VarDecl *var, Expr *cond,
Stmt *then, SourceLocation EL = SourceLocation(), Stmt *elsev = 0);
-
+
/// \brief Build an empty if/then/else statement
explicit IfStmt(EmptyShell Empty) : Stmt(IfStmtClass, Empty) { }
@@ -742,13 +742,13 @@ public:
/// \endcode
VarDecl *getConditionVariable() const;
void setConditionVariable(ASTContext &C, VarDecl *V);
-
+
/// If this IfStmt has a condition variable, return the faux DeclStmt
/// associated with the creation of that condition variable.
const DeclStmt *getConditionVariableDeclStmt() const {
return reinterpret_cast<DeclStmt*>(SubExprs[VAR]);
}
-
+
const Expr *getCond() const { return reinterpret_cast<Expr*>(SubExprs[COND]);}
void setCond(Expr *E) { SubExprs[COND] = reinterpret_cast<Stmt *>(E); }
const Stmt *getThen() const { return SubExprs[THEN]; }
@@ -815,7 +815,7 @@ public:
/// \endcode
VarDecl *getConditionVariable() const;
void setConditionVariable(ASTContext &C, VarDecl *V);
-
+
/// If this SwitchStmt has a condition variable, return the faux DeclStmt
/// associated with the creation of that condition variable.
const DeclStmt *getConditionVariableDeclStmt() const {
@@ -846,7 +846,8 @@ public:
SwitchLoc = SL;
}
void addSwitchCase(SwitchCase *SC) {
- assert(!SC->getNextSwitchCase() && "case/default already added to a switch");
+ assert(!SC->getNextSwitchCase()
+ && "case/default already added to a switch");
SC->setNextSwitchCase(FirstCase);
FirstCase = SC;
}
@@ -885,7 +886,7 @@ class WhileStmt : public Stmt {
Stmt* SubExprs[END_EXPR];
SourceLocation WhileLoc;
public:
- WhileStmt(ASTContext &C, VarDecl *Var, Expr *cond, Stmt *body,
+ WhileStmt(ASTContext &C, VarDecl *Var, Expr *cond, Stmt *body,
SourceLocation WL);
/// \brief Build an empty while statement.
@@ -993,14 +994,14 @@ class ForStmt : public Stmt {
SourceLocation LParenLoc, RParenLoc;
public:
- ForStmt(ASTContext &C, Stmt *Init, Expr *Cond, VarDecl *condVar, Expr *Inc,
+ ForStmt(ASTContext &C, Stmt *Init, Expr *Cond, VarDecl *condVar, Expr *Inc,
Stmt *Body, SourceLocation FL, SourceLocation LP, SourceLocation RP);
/// \brief Build an empty for statement.
explicit ForStmt(EmptyShell Empty) : Stmt(ForStmtClass, Empty) { }
Stmt *getInit() { return SubExprs[INIT]; }
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the variable declared in this "for" statement, if any.
///
/// In the following example, "y" is the condition variable.
@@ -1011,7 +1012,7 @@ public:
/// \endcode
VarDecl *getConditionVariable() const;
void setConditionVariable(ASTContext &C, VarDecl *V);
-
+
/// If this ForStmt has a condition variable, return the faux DeclStmt
/// associated with the creation of that condition variable.
const DeclStmt *getConditionVariableDeclStmt() const {
@@ -1196,7 +1197,7 @@ class ReturnStmt : public Stmt {
Stmt *RetExpr;
SourceLocation RetLoc;
const VarDecl *NRVOCandidate;
-
+
public:
ReturnStmt(SourceLocation RL)
: Stmt(ReturnStmtClass), RetExpr(0), RetLoc(RL), NRVOCandidate(0) { }
@@ -1222,7 +1223,7 @@ public:
/// also marked as an NRVO object.
const VarDecl *getNRVOCandidate() const { return NRVOCandidate; }
void setNRVOCandidate(const VarDecl *Var) { NRVOCandidate = Var; }
-
+
SourceRange getSourceRange() const;
static bool classof(const Stmt *T) {
@@ -1256,16 +1257,16 @@ class AsmStmt : public Stmt {
StringLiteral **Constraints;
Stmt **Exprs;
StringLiteral **Clobbers;
-
+
public:
- AsmStmt(ASTContext &C, SourceLocation asmloc, bool issimple, bool isvolatile,
+ AsmStmt(ASTContext &C, SourceLocation asmloc, bool issimple, bool isvolatile,
bool msasm, unsigned numoutputs, unsigned numinputs,
IdentifierInfo **names, StringLiteral **constraints,
Expr **exprs, StringLiteral *asmstr, unsigned numclobbers,
StringLiteral **clobbers, SourceLocation rparenloc);
/// \brief Build an empty inline-assembly statement.
- explicit AsmStmt(EmptyShell Empty) : Stmt(AsmStmtClass, Empty),
+ explicit AsmStmt(EmptyShell Empty) : Stmt(AsmStmtClass, Empty),
Names(0), Constraints(0), Exprs(0), Clobbers(0) { }
SourceLocation getAsmLoc() const { return AsmLoc; }
@@ -1347,7 +1348,7 @@ public:
StringRef getOutputName(unsigned i) const {
if (IdentifierInfo *II = getOutputIdentifier(i))
return II->getName();
-
+
return StringRef();
}
@@ -1408,7 +1409,7 @@ public:
Expr *getInputExpr(unsigned i);
void setInputExpr(unsigned i, Expr *E);
-
+
const Expr *getInputExpr(unsigned i) const {
return const_cast<AsmStmt*>(this)->getInputExpr(i);
}
@@ -1418,7 +1419,7 @@ public:
StringLiteral **Constraints,
Stmt **Exprs,
unsigned NumOutputs,
- unsigned NumInputs,
+ unsigned NumInputs,
StringLiteral **Clobbers,
unsigned NumClobbers);
@@ -1511,8 +1512,13 @@ public:
SourceLocation getExceptLoc() const { return Loc; }
SourceLocation getEndLoc() const { return getBlock()->getLocEnd(); }
- Expr *getFilterExpr() const { return reinterpret_cast<Expr*>(Children[FILTER_EXPR]); }
- CompoundStmt *getBlock() const { return llvm::cast<CompoundStmt>(Children[BLOCK]); }
+ Expr *getFilterExpr() const {
+ return reinterpret_cast<Expr*>(Children[FILTER_EXPR]);
+ }
+
+ CompoundStmt *getBlock() const {
+ return llvm::cast<CompoundStmt>(Children[BLOCK]);
+ }
child_range children() {
return child_range(Children,Children+2);
@@ -1594,7 +1600,11 @@ public:
SourceLocation getEndLoc() const { return Children[HANDLER]->getLocEnd(); }
bool getIsCXXTry() const { return IsCXXTry; }
- CompoundStmt* getTryBlock() const { return llvm::cast<CompoundStmt>(Children[TRY]); }
+
+ CompoundStmt* getTryBlock() const {
+ return llvm::cast<CompoundStmt>(Children[TRY]);
+ }
+
Stmt *getHandler() const { return Children[HANDLER]; }
/// Returns 0 if not defined
@@ -1611,7 +1621,7 @@ public:
static bool classof(SEHTryStmt *) { return true; }
};
-
+
} // end namespace clang
#endif
diff --git a/include/clang/AST/StmtCXX.h b/include/clang/AST/StmtCXX.h
index 056a0a393c..8c72314080 100644
--- a/include/clang/AST/StmtCXX.h
+++ b/include/clang/AST/StmtCXX.h
@@ -148,7 +148,9 @@ public:
DeclStmt *getRangeStmt() { return cast<DeclStmt>(SubExprs[RANGE]); }
- DeclStmt *getBeginEndStmt() { return cast_or_null<DeclStmt>(SubExprs[BEGINEND]); }
+ DeclStmt *getBeginEndStmt() {
+ return cast_or_null<DeclStmt>(SubExprs[BEGINEND]);
+ }
Expr *getCond() { return cast_or_null<Expr>(SubExprs[COND]); }
Expr *getInc() { return cast_or_null<Expr>(SubExprs[INC]); }
DeclStmt *getLoopVarStmt() { return cast<DeclStmt>(SubExprs[LOOPVAR]); }
@@ -209,10 +211,10 @@ public:
/// example:
///
/// \code
-/// template<typename T>
+/// template<typename T>
/// void call_foo(T &t) {
/// __if_exists (T::foo) {
-/// t.foo(); // okay: only called when T::foo exists.
+/// t.foo(); // okay: only called when T::foo exists.
/// }
/// }
/// \endcode
@@ -234,56 +236,56 @@ class MSDependentExistsStmt : public Stmt {
NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc;
DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
Stmt *SubStmt;
-
+
friend class ASTReader;
friend class ASTStmtReader;
-
+
public:
- MSDependentExistsStmt(SourceLocation KeywordLoc, bool IsIfExists,
+ MSDependentExistsStmt(SourceLocation KeywordLoc, bool IsIfExists,
NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc,
DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo,
CompoundStmt *SubStmt)
: Stmt(MSDependentExistsStmtClass),
- KeywordLoc(KeywordLoc), IsIfExists(IsIfExists),
+ KeywordLoc(KeywordLoc), IsIfExists(IsIfExists),
QualifierLoc(QualifierLoc), NameInfo(NameInfo),
SubStmt(reinterpret_cast<Stmt *>(SubStmt)) { }
-
- /// \brief Retrieve the location of the __if_exists or __if_not_exists
+
+ /// \brief Retrieve the location of the __if_exists or __if_not_exists
/// keyword.
SourceLocation getKeywordLoc() const { return KeywordLoc; }
-
+
/// \brief Determine whether this is an __if_exists statement.
bool isIfExists() const { return IsIfExists; }
/// \brief Determine whether this is an __if_exists statement.
bool isIfNotExists() const { return !IsIfExists; }
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the nested-name-specifier that qualifies this name, if
/// any.
NestedNameSpecifierLoc getQualifierLoc() const { return QualifierLoc; }
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the name of the entity we're testing for, along with
/// location information
DeclarationNameInfo getNameInfo() const { return NameInfo; }
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the compound statement that will be included in the
/// program only if the existence of the symbol matches the initial keyword.
- CompoundStmt *getSubStmt() const {
- return reinterpret_cast<CompoundStmt *>(SubStmt);
+ CompoundStmt *getSubStmt() const {
+ return reinterpret_cast<CompoundStmt *>(SubStmt);
}
-
+
SourceRange getSourceRange() const {
return SourceRange(KeywordLoc, SubStmt->getLocEnd());
}
-
+
child_range children() {
return child_range(&SubStmt, &SubStmt+1);
}
-
+
static bool classof(const Stmt *T) {
return T->getStmtClass() == MSDependentExistsStmtClass;
}
-
+
static bool classof(MSDependentExistsStmt *) { return true; }
};
diff --git a/include/clang/AST/Type.h b/include/clang/AST/Type.h
index 725ccc8eea..dfa594db1e 100644
--- a/include/clang/AST/Type.h
+++ b/include/clang/AST/Type.h
@@ -95,7 +95,7 @@ namespace clang {
class ExtQualsTypeCommonBase;
struct PrintingPolicy;
- template <typename> class CanQual;
+ template <typename> class CanQual;
typedef CanQual<Type> CanQualType;
// Provide forward declarations for all of the *Type classes
@@ -266,7 +266,7 @@ public:
ObjCLifetime lifetime = getObjCLifetime();
return (lifetime == OCL_Strong || lifetime == OCL_Weak);
}
-
+
bool hasAddressSpace() const { return Mask & AddressSpaceMask; }
unsigned getAddressSpace() const { return Mask >> AddressSpaceShift; }
void setAddressSpace(unsigned space) {
@@ -346,7 +346,7 @@ public:
/// Generally this answers the question of whether an object with the other
/// qualifiers can be safely used as an object with these qualifiers.
bool compatiblyIncludes(Qualifiers other) const {
- return
+ return
// Address spaces must match exactly.
getAddressSpace() == other.getAddressSpace() &&
// ObjC GC qualifiers can match, be added, or be removed, but can't be
@@ -363,24 +363,24 @@ public:
/// qualifiers from the narrow perspective of Objective-C ARC lifetime.
///
/// One set of Objective-C lifetime qualifiers compatibly includes the other
- /// if the lifetime qualifiers match, or if both are non-__weak and the
+ /// if the lifetime qualifiers match, or if both are non-__weak and the
/// including set also contains the 'const' qualifier.
bool compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(Qualifiers other) const {
if (getObjCLifetime() == other.getObjCLifetime())
return true;
-
+
if (getObjCLifetime() == OCL_Weak || other.getObjCLifetime() == OCL_Weak)
return false;
-
+
return hasConst();
}
-
+
bool isSupersetOf(Qualifiers Other) const;
/// \brief Determine whether this set of qualifiers is a strict superset of
/// another set of qualifiers, not considering qualifier compatibility.
bool isStrictSupersetOf(Qualifiers Other) const;
-
+
bool operator==(Qualifiers Other) const { return Mask == Other.Mask; }
bool operator!=(Qualifiers Other) const { return Mask != Other.Mask; }
@@ -397,7 +397,7 @@ public:
L += R;
return L;
}
-
+
Qualifiers &operator-=(Qualifiers R) {
Mask = Mask & ~(R.Mask);
return *this;
@@ -408,7 +408,7 @@ public:
L -= R;
return L;
}
-
+
std::string getAsString() const;
std::string getAsString(const PrintingPolicy &Policy) const {
std::string Buffer;
@@ -501,7 +501,7 @@ public:
/// This function requires that the type not be NULL. If the type might be
/// NULL, use the (slightly less efficient) \c getTypePtrOrNull().
const Type *getTypePtr() const;
-
+
const Type *getTypePtrOrNull() const;
/// Retrieves a pointer to the name of the base type.
@@ -534,27 +534,27 @@ public:
return Value.getPointer().isNull();
}
- /// \brief Determine whether this particular QualType instance has the
+ /// \brief Determine whether this particular QualType instance has the
/// "const" qualifier set, without looking through typedefs that may have
/// added "const" at a different level.
bool isLocalConstQualified() const {
return (getLocalFastQualifiers() & Qualifiers::Const);
}
-
+
/// \brief Determine whether this type is const-qualified.
bool isConstQualified() const;
-
- /// \brief Determine whether this particular QualType instance has the
+
+ /// \brief Determine whether this particular QualType instance has the
/// "restrict" qualifier set, without looking through typedefs that may have
/// added "restrict" at a different level.
bool isLocalRestrictQualified() const {
return (getLocalFastQualifiers() & Qualifiers::Restrict);
}
-
+
/// \brief Determine whether this type is restrict-qualified.
bool isRestrictQualified() const;
-
- /// \brief Determine whether this particular QualType instance has the
+
+ /// \brief Determine whether this particular QualType instance has the
/// "volatile" qualifier set, without looking through typedefs that may have
/// added "volatile" at a different level.
bool isLocalVolatileQualified() const {
@@ -563,9 +563,9 @@ public:
/// \brief Determine whether this type is volatile-qualified.
bool isVolatileQualified() const;
-
+
/// \brief Determine whether this particular QualType instance has any
- /// qualifiers, without looking through any typedefs that might add
+ /// qualifiers, without looking through any typedefs that might add
/// qualifiers at a different level.
bool hasLocalQualifiers() const {
return getLocalFastQualifiers() || hasLocalNonFastQualifiers();
@@ -573,7 +573,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Determine whether this type has any qualifiers.
bool hasQualifiers() const;
-
+
/// \brief Determine whether this particular QualType instance has any
/// "non-fast" qualifiers, e.g., those that are stored in an ExtQualType
/// instance.
@@ -588,15 +588,15 @@ public:
/// \brief Retrieve the set of qualifiers applied to this type.
Qualifiers getQualifiers() const;
-
- /// \brief Retrieve the set of CVR (const-volatile-restrict) qualifiers
+
+ /// \brief Retrieve the set of CVR (const-volatile-restrict) qualifiers
/// local to this particular QualType instance, not including any qualifiers
/// acquired through typedefs or other sugar.
unsigned getLocalCVRQualifiers() const {
return getLocalFastQualifiers();
}
- /// \brief Retrieve the set of CVR (const-volatile-restrict) qualifiers
+ /// \brief Retrieve the set of CVR (const-volatile-restrict) qualifiers
/// applied to this type.
unsigned getCVRQualifiers() const;
@@ -612,10 +612,10 @@ public:
/// compilation's language.
/// (C++0x [basic.types]p9)
bool isCXX11PODType(ASTContext &Context) const;
-
+
/// isTrivialType - Return true if this is a trivial type
/// (C++0x [basic.types]p9)
- bool isTrivialType(ASTContext &Context) const;
+ bool isTrivialType(ASTContext &Context) const;
/// isTriviallyCopyableType - Return true if this is a trivially
/// copyable type (C++0x [basic.types]p9)
@@ -624,7 +624,7 @@ public:
// Don't promise in the API that anything besides 'const' can be
// easily added.
- /// addConst - add the specified type qualifier to this QualType.
+ /// addConst - add the specified type qualifier to this QualType.
void addConst() {
addFastQualifiers(Qualifiers::Const);
}
@@ -632,7 +632,7 @@ public:
return withFastQualifiers(Qualifiers::Const);
}
- /// addVolatile - add the specified type qualifier to this QualType.
+ /// addVolatile - add the specified type qualifier to this QualType.
void addVolatile() {
addFastQualifiers(Qualifiers::Volatile);
}
@@ -719,7 +719,7 @@ public:
/// type. To strip qualifiers even from within an array type, use
/// ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType.
inline SplitQualType getSplitUnqualifiedType() const;
-
+
/// \brief Determine whether this type is more qualified than the other
/// given type, requiring exact equality for non-CVR qualifiers.
bool isMoreQualifiedThan(QualType Other) const;
@@ -727,19 +727,19 @@ public:
/// \brief Determine whether this type is at least as qualified as the other
/// given type, requiring exact equality for non-CVR qualifiers.
bool isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(QualType Other) const;
-
+
QualType getNonReferenceType() const;
/// \brief Determine the type of a (typically non-lvalue) expression with the
/// specified result type.
- ///
+ ///
/// This routine should be used for expressions for which the return type is
/// explicitly specified (e.g., in a cast or call) and isn't necessarily
- /// an lvalue. It removes a top-level reference (since there are no
+ /// an lvalue. It removes a top-level reference (since there are no
/// expressions of reference type) and deletes top-level cvr-qualifiers
/// from non-class types (in C++) or all types (in C).
QualType getNonLValueExprType(ASTContext &Context) const;
-
+
/// getDesugaredType - Return the specified type with any "sugar" removed from
/// the type. This takes off typedefs, typeof's etc. If the outer level of
/// the type is already concrete, it returns it unmodified. This is similar
@@ -757,12 +757,12 @@ public:
}
/// \brief Return the specified type with one level of "sugar" removed from
- /// the type.
+ /// the type.
///
/// This routine takes off the first typedef, typeof, etc. If the outer level
/// of the type is already concrete, it returns it unmodified.
QualType getSingleStepDesugaredType(const ASTContext &Context) const;
-
+
/// IgnoreParens - Returns the specified type after dropping any
/// outer-level parentheses.
QualType IgnoreParens() const {
@@ -855,7 +855,7 @@ public:
return isDestructedTypeImpl(*this);
}
- /// \brief Determine whether expressions of the given type are forbidden
+ /// \brief Determine whether expressions of the given type are forbidden
/// from being lvalues in C.
///
/// The expression types that are forbidden to be lvalues are:
@@ -870,7 +870,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Determine whether this type has trivial copy/move-assignment
/// semantics.
bool hasTrivialAssignment(ASTContext &Context, bool Copying) const;
-
+
private:
// These methods are implemented in a separate translation unit;
// "static"-ize them to avoid creating temporary QualTypes in the
@@ -915,7 +915,7 @@ public:
namespace clang {
-/// \brief Base class that is common to both the \c ExtQuals and \c Type
+/// \brief Base class that is common to both the \c ExtQuals and \c Type
/// classes, which allows \c QualType to access the common fields between the
/// two.
///
@@ -926,7 +926,7 @@ class ExtQualsTypeCommonBase {
/// \brief The "base" type of an extended qualifiers type (\c ExtQuals) or
/// a self-referential pointer (for \c Type).
///
- /// This pointer allows an efficient mapping from a QualType to its
+ /// This pointer allows an efficient mapping from a QualType to its
/// underlying type pointer.
const Type *const BaseType;
@@ -937,14 +937,14 @@ class ExtQualsTypeCommonBase {
friend class Type;
friend class ExtQuals;
};
-
+
/// ExtQuals - We can encode up to four bits in the low bits of a
/// type pointer, but there are many more type qualifiers that we want
/// to be able to apply to an arbitrary type. Therefore we have this
/// struct, intended to be heap-allocated and used by QualType to
/// store qualifiers.
///
-/// The current design tags the 'const', 'restrict', and 'volatile' qualifiers
+/// The current design tags the 'const', 'restrict', and 'volatile' qualifiers
/// in three low bits on the QualType pointer; a fourth bit records whether
/// the pointer is an ExtQuals node. The extended qualifiers (address spaces,
/// Objective-C GC attributes) are much more rare.
@@ -969,7 +969,7 @@ class ExtQuals : public ExtQualsTypeCommonBase, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
ExtQuals *this_() { return this; }
public:
- ExtQuals(const Type *baseType, QualType canon, Qualifiers quals)
+ ExtQuals(const Type *baseType, QualType canon, Qualifiers quals)
: ExtQualsTypeCommonBase(baseType,
canon.isNull() ? QualType(this_(), 0) : canon),
Quals(quals)
@@ -1008,8 +1008,8 @@ public:
}
};
-/// \brief The kind of C++0x ref-qualifier associated with a function type,
-/// which determines whether a member function's "this" object can be an
+/// \brief The kind of C++0x ref-qualifier associated with a function type,
+/// which determines whether a member function's "this" object can be an
/// lvalue, rvalue, or neither.
enum RefQualifierKind {
/// \brief No ref-qualifier was provided.
@@ -1019,7 +1019,7 @@ enum RefQualifierKind {
/// \brief An rvalue ref-qualifier was provided (\c &&).
RQ_RValue
};
-
+
/// Type - This is the base class of the type hierarchy. A central concept
/// with types is that each type always has a canonical type. A canonical type
/// is the type with any typedef names stripped out of it or the types it
@@ -1071,29 +1071,29 @@ private:
/// Note that this should stay at the end of the ivars for Type so that
/// subclasses can pack their bitfields into the same word.
unsigned Dependent : 1;
-
- /// \brief Whether this type somehow involves a template parameter, even
+
+ /// \brief Whether this type somehow involves a template parameter, even
/// if the resolution of the type does not depend on a template parameter.
unsigned InstantiationDependent : 1;
-
+
/// \brief Whether this type is a variably-modified type (C99 6.7.5).
unsigned VariablyModified : 1;
/// \brief Whether this type contains an unexpanded parameter pack
/// (for C++0x variadic templates).
unsigned ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack : 1;
-
+
/// \brief Nonzero if the cache (i.e. the bitfields here starting
/// with 'Cache') is valid. If so, then this is a
/// LangOptions::VisibilityMode+1.
mutable unsigned CacheValidAndVisibility : 2;
-
+
/// \brief Linkage of this type.
mutable unsigned CachedLinkage : 2;
- /// \brief Whether this type involves and local or unnamed types.
+ /// \brief Whether this type involves and local or unnamed types.
mutable unsigned CachedLocalOrUnnamed : 1;
-
+
/// \brief FromAST - Whether this type comes from an AST file.
mutable unsigned FromAST : 1;
@@ -1162,7 +1162,7 @@ protected:
/// C++ 8.3.5p4: The return type, the parameter type list and the
/// cv-qualifier-seq, [...], are part of the function type.
unsigned TypeQuals : 3;
-
+
/// \brief The ref-qualifier associated with a \c FunctionProtoType.
///
/// This is a value of type \c RefQualifierKind.
@@ -1247,7 +1247,7 @@ protected:
private:
/// \brief Set whether this type comes from an AST file.
- void setFromAST(bool V = true) const {
+ void setFromAST(bool V = true) const {
TypeBits.FromAST = V;
}
@@ -1256,7 +1256,7 @@ private:
protected:
// silence VC++ warning C4355: 'this' : used in base member initializer list
Type *this_() { return this; }
- Type(TypeClass tc, QualType canon, bool Dependent,
+ Type(TypeClass tc, QualType canon, bool Dependent,
bool InstantiationDependent, bool VariablyModified,
bool ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack)
: ExtQualsTypeCommonBase(this,
@@ -1273,14 +1273,14 @@ protected:
}
friend class ASTContext;
- void setDependent(bool D = true) {
- TypeBits.Dependent = D;
+ void setDependent(bool D = true) {
+ TypeBits.Dependent = D;
if (D)
TypeBits.InstantiationDependent = true;
}
- void setInstantiationDependent(bool D = true) {
+ void setInstantiationDependent(bool D = true) {
TypeBits.InstantiationDependent = D; }
- void setVariablyModified(bool VM = true) { TypeBits.VariablyModified = VM;
+ void setVariablyModified(bool VM = true) { TypeBits.VariablyModified = VM;
}
void setContainsUnexpandedParameterPack(bool PP = true) {
TypeBits.ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack = PP;
@@ -1306,8 +1306,8 @@ public:
/// };
/// \endcode
///
- /// Note that this routine does not specify which
- bool containsUnexpandedParameterPack() const {
+ /// Note that this routine does not specify which
+ bool containsUnexpandedParameterPack() const {
return TypeBits.ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack;
}
@@ -1331,11 +1331,11 @@ public:
bool isIncompleteOrObjectType() const {
return !isFunctionType();
}
-
+
/// \brief Determine whether this type is an object type.
bool isObjectType() const {
// C++ [basic.types]p8:
- // An object type is a (possibly cv-qualified) type that is not a
+ // An object type is a (possibly cv-qualified) type that is not a
// function type, not a reference type, and not a void type.
return !isReferenceType() && !isFunctionType() && !isVoidType();
}
@@ -1378,13 +1378,13 @@ public:
bool isChar32Type() const;
bool isAnyCharacterType() const;
bool isIntegralType(ASTContext &Ctx) const;
-
+
/// \brief Determine whether this type is an integral or enumeration type.
bool isIntegralOrEnumerationType() const;
/// \brief Determine whether this type is an integral or unscoped enumeration
/// type.
bool isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() const;
-
+
/// Floating point categories.
bool isRealFloatingType() const; // C99 6.2.5p10 (float, double, long double)
/// isComplexType() does *not* include complex integers (a GCC extension).
@@ -1479,32 +1479,32 @@ public:
/// that its definition somehow depends on a template parameter
/// (C++ [temp.dep.type]).
bool isDependentType() const { return TypeBits.Dependent; }
-
+
/// \brief Determine whether this type is an instantiation-dependent type,
/// meaning that the type involves a template parameter (even if the
/// definition does not actually depend on the type substituted for that
/// template parameter).
- bool isInstantiationDependentType() const {
- return TypeBits.InstantiationDependent;
+ bool isInstantiationDependentType() const {
+ return TypeBits.InstantiationDependent;
}
-
+
/// \brief Whether this type is a variably-modified type (C99 6.7.5).
bool isVariablyModifiedType() const { return TypeBits.VariablyModified; }
/// \brief Whether this type involves a variable-length array type
/// with a definite size.
bool hasSizedVLAType() const;
-
+
/// \brief Whether this type is or contains a local or unnamed type.
bool hasUnnamedOrLocalType() const;
-
+
bool isOverloadableType() const;
/// \brief Determine wither this type is a C++ elaborated-type-specifier.
bool isElaboratedTypeSpecifier() const;
bool canDecayToPointerType() const;
-
+
/// hasPointerRepresentation - Whether this type is represented
/// natively as a pointer; this includes pointers, references, block
/// pointers, and Objective-C interface, qualified id, and qualified
@@ -1547,7 +1547,7 @@ public:
const CXXRecordDecl *getCXXRecordDeclForPointerType() const;
/// \brief Retrieves the CXXRecordDecl that this type refers to, either
- /// because the type is a RecordType or because it is the injected-class-name
+ /// because the type is a RecordType or because it is the injected-class-name
/// type of a class template or class template partial specialization.
CXXRecordDecl *getAsCXXRecordDecl() const;
@@ -1555,7 +1555,7 @@ public:
/// an initializer of this type. This looks through declarators like pointer
/// types, but not through decltype or typedefs.
AutoType *getContainedAutoType() const;
-
+
/// Member-template getAs<specific type>'. Look through sugar for
/// an instance of <specific type>. This scheme will eventually
/// replace the specific getAsXXXX methods above.
@@ -1608,15 +1608,15 @@ public:
bool isSignedIntegerType() const;
/// isUnsignedIntegerType - Return true if this is an integer type that is
- /// unsigned, according to C99 6.2.5p6 [which returns true for _Bool],
+ /// unsigned, according to C99 6.2.5p6 [which returns true for _Bool],
/// or an enum decl which has an unsigned representation.
bool isUnsignedIntegerType() const;
- /// Determines whether this is an integer type that is signed or an
+ /// Determines whether this is an integer type that is signed or an
/// enumeration types whose underlying type is a signed integer type.
bool isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType() const;
-
- /// Determines whether this is an integer type that is unsigned or an
+
+ /// Determines whether this is an integer type that is unsigned or an
/// enumeration types whose underlying type is a unsigned integer type.
bool isUnsignedIntegerOrEnumerationType() const;
@@ -1637,10 +1637,10 @@ public:
/// \brief Determine the linkage and visibility of this type.
std::pair<Linkage,Visibility> getLinkageAndVisibility() const;
-
+
/// \brief Note that the linkage is no longer known.
void ClearLinkageCache();
-
+
const char *getTypeClassName() const;
QualType getCanonicalTypeInternal() const {
@@ -1801,7 +1801,7 @@ class PointerType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
Type(Pointer, CanonicalPtr, Pointee->isDependentType(),
Pointee->isInstantiationDependentType(),
Pointee->isVariablyModifiedType(),
- Pointee->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()),
+ Pointee->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()),
PointeeType(Pointee) {
}
friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
@@ -1838,7 +1838,7 @@ class BlockPointerType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
PointeeType(Pointee) {
}
friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
-
+
public:
// Get the pointee type. Pointee is required to always be a function type.
@@ -1871,17 +1871,17 @@ protected:
Type(tc, CanonicalRef, Referencee->isDependentType(),
Referencee->isInstantiationDependentType(),
Referencee->isVariablyModifiedType(),
- Referencee->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()),
- PointeeType(Referencee)
+ Referencee->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()),
+ PointeeType(Referencee)
{
ReferenceTypeBits.SpelledAsLValue = SpelledAsLValue;
ReferenceTypeBits.InnerRef = Referencee->isReferenceType();
}
-
+
public:
bool isSpelledAsLValue() const { return ReferenceTypeBits.SpelledAsLValue; }
bool isInnerRef() const { return ReferenceTypeBits.InnerRef; }
-
+
QualType getPointeeTypeAsWritten() const { return PointeeType; }
QualType getPointeeType() const {
// FIXME: this might strip inner qualifiers; okay?
@@ -1954,15 +1954,15 @@ class MemberPointerType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
MemberPointerType(QualType Pointee, const Type *Cls, QualType CanonicalPtr) :
Type(MemberPointer, CanonicalPtr,
Cls->isDependentType() || Pointee->isDependentType(),
- (Cls->isInstantiationDependentType() ||
+ (Cls->isInstantiationDependentType() ||
Pointee->isInstantiationDependentType()),
Pointee->isVariablyModifiedType(),
- (Cls->containsUnexpandedParameterPack() ||
+ (Cls->containsUnexpandedParameterPack() ||
Pointee->containsUnexpandedParameterPack())),
PointeeType(Pointee), Class(Cls) {
}
friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
-
+
public:
QualType getPointeeType() const { return PointeeType; }
@@ -2069,7 +2069,7 @@ class ConstantArrayType : public ArrayType {
protected:
ConstantArrayType(TypeClass tc, QualType et, QualType can,
const llvm::APInt &size, ArraySizeModifier sm, unsigned tq)
- : ArrayType(tc, et, can, sm, tq, et->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()),
+ : ArrayType(tc, et, can, sm, tq, et->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()),
Size(size) {}
friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
public:
@@ -2077,17 +2077,17 @@ public:
bool isSugared() const { return false; }
QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
-
+
/// \brief Determine the number of bits required to address a member of
// an array with the given element type and number of elements.
static unsigned getNumAddressingBits(ASTContext &Context,
QualType ElementType,
const llvm::APInt &NumElements);
-
+
/// \brief Determine the maximum number of active bits that an array's size
/// can require, which limits the maximum size of the array.
static unsigned getMaxSizeBits(ASTContext &Context);
-
+
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) {
Profile(ID, getElementType(), getSize(),
getSizeModifier(), getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers());
@@ -2113,7 +2113,7 @@ class IncompleteArrayType : public ArrayType {
IncompleteArrayType(QualType et, QualType can,
ArraySizeModifier sm, unsigned tq)
- : ArrayType(IncompleteArray, et, can, sm, tq,
+ : ArrayType(IncompleteArray, et, can, sm, tq,
et->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) {}
friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
public:
@@ -2165,7 +2165,7 @@ class VariableArrayType : public ArrayType {
VariableArrayType(QualType et, QualType can, Expr *e,
ArraySizeModifier sm, unsigned tq,
SourceRange brackets)
- : ArrayType(VariableArray, et, can, sm, tq,
+ : ArrayType(VariableArray, et, can, sm, tq,
et->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()),
SizeExpr((Stmt*) e), Brackets(brackets) {}
friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
@@ -2321,12 +2321,12 @@ protected:
VectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned nElements, QualType canonType,
VectorKind vecKind);
-
+
VectorType(TypeClass tc, QualType vecType, unsigned nElements,
QualType canonType, VectorKind vecKind);
friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
-
+
public:
QualType getElementType() const { return ElementType; }
@@ -2492,7 +2492,7 @@ class FunctionType : public Type {
bool getNoReturn() const { return Bits & NoReturnMask; }
bool getProducesResult() const { return Bits & ProducesResultMask; }
bool getHasRegParm() const { return (Bits >> RegParmOffset) != 0; }
- unsigned getRegParm() const {
+ unsigned getRegParm() const {
unsigned RegParm = Bits >> RegParmOffset;
if (RegParm > 0)
--RegParm;
@@ -2544,10 +2544,10 @@ protected:
unsigned typeQuals, RefQualifierKind RefQualifier,
QualType Canonical, bool Dependent,
bool InstantiationDependent,
- bool VariablyModified, bool ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack,
+ bool VariablyModified, bool ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack,
ExtInfo Info)
- : Type(tc, Canonical, Dependent, InstantiationDependent, VariablyModified,
- ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack),
+ : Type(tc, Canonical, Dependent, InstantiationDependent, VariablyModified,
+ ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack),
ResultType(res) {
FunctionTypeBits.ExtInfo = Info.Bits;
FunctionTypeBits.Variadic = variadic;
@@ -2556,7 +2556,7 @@ protected:
}
bool isVariadic() const { return FunctionTypeBits.Variadic; }
unsigned getTypeQuals() const { return FunctionTypeBits.TypeQuals; }
-
+
RefQualifierKind getRefQualifier() const {
return static_cast<RefQualifierKind>(FunctionTypeBits.RefQualifier);
}
@@ -2573,7 +2573,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Determine the type of an expression that calls a function of
/// this type.
- QualType getCallResultType(ASTContext &Context) const {
+ QualType getCallResultType(ASTContext &Context) const {
return getResultType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
}
@@ -2592,11 +2592,11 @@ class FunctionNoProtoType : public FunctionType, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
FunctionNoProtoType(QualType Result, QualType Canonical, ExtInfo Info)
: FunctionType(FunctionNoProto, Result, false, 0, RQ_None, Canonical,
/*Dependent=*/false, /*InstantiationDependent=*/false,
- Result->isVariablyModifiedType(),
+ Result->isVariablyModifiedType(),
/*ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack=*/false, Info) {}
friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
-
+
public:
// No additional state past what FunctionType provides.
@@ -2646,7 +2646,7 @@ public:
private:
/// \brief Determine whether there are any argument types that
/// contain an unexpanded parameter pack.
- static bool containsAnyUnexpandedParameterPack(const QualType *ArgArray,
+ static bool containsAnyUnexpandedParameterPack(const QualType *ArgArray,
unsigned numArgs) {
for (unsigned Idx = 0; Idx < numArgs; ++Idx)
if (ArgArray[Idx]->containsUnexpandedParameterPack())
@@ -2777,17 +2777,17 @@ public:
///
/// A function template whose last parameter is a parameter pack can be
/// called with an arbitrary number of arguments, much like a variadic
- /// function. However,
+ /// function. However,
bool isTemplateVariadic() const;
-
+
unsigned getTypeQuals() const { return FunctionType::getTypeQuals(); }
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the ref-qualifier associated with this function type.
RefQualifierKind getRefQualifier() const {
return FunctionType::getRefQualifier();
}
-
+
typedef const QualType *arg_type_iterator;
arg_type_iterator arg_type_begin() const {
return reinterpret_cast<const QualType *>(this+1);
@@ -2838,7 +2838,7 @@ class UnresolvedUsingType : public Type {
UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *Decl;
UnresolvedUsingType(const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *D)
- : Type(UnresolvedUsing, QualType(), true, true, false,
+ : Type(UnresolvedUsing, QualType(), true, true, false,
/*ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack=*/false),
Decl(const_cast<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl*>(D)) {}
friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these.
@@ -2868,9 +2868,9 @@ class TypedefType : public Type {
TypedefNameDecl *Decl;
protected:
TypedefType(TypeClass tc, const TypedefNameDecl *D, QualType can)
- : Type(tc, can, can->isDependentType(),
+ : Type(tc, can, can->isDependentType(),
can->isInstantiationDependentType(),
- can->isVariablyModifiedType(),
+ can->isVariablyModifiedType(),
/*ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack=*/false),
Decl(const_cast<TypedefNameDecl*>(D)) {
assert(!isa<TypedefType>(can) && "Invalid canonical type");
@@ -2933,10 +2933,10 @@ public:
class TypeOfType : public Type {
QualType TOType;
TypeOfType(QualType T, QualType can)
- : Type(TypeOf, can, T->isDependentType(),
+ : Type(TypeOf, can, T->isDependentType(),
T->isInstantiationDependentType(),
- T->isVariablyModifiedType(),
- T->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()),
+ T->isVariablyModifiedType(),
+ T->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()),
TOType(T) {
assert(!isa<TypedefType>(can) && "Invalid canonical type");
}
@@ -3026,7 +3026,7 @@ public:
QualType getBaseType() const { return BaseType; }
UTTKind getUTTKind() const { return UKind; }
-
+
static bool classof(const Type *T) {
return T->getTypeClass() == UnaryTransform;
}
@@ -3221,7 +3221,7 @@ class TemplateTypeParmType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
/// Build the canonical type.
TemplateTypeParmType(unsigned D, unsigned I, bool PP)
- : Type(TemplateTypeParm, QualType(this, 0),
+ : Type(TemplateTypeParm, QualType(this, 0),
/*Dependent=*/true,
/*InstantiationDependent=*/true,
/*VariablyModified=*/false, PP) {
@@ -3326,7 +3326,7 @@ public:
///
/// When a pack expansion in the source code contains multiple parameter packs
/// and those parameter packs correspond to different levels of template
-/// parameter lists, this type node is used to represent a template type
+/// parameter lists, this type node is used to represent a template type
/// parameter pack from an outer level, which has already had its argument pack
/// substituted but that still lives within a pack expansion that itself
/// could not be instantiated. When actually performing a substitution into
@@ -3336,38 +3336,38 @@ public:
class SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
/// \brief The original type parameter.
const TemplateTypeParmType *Replaced;
-
+
/// \brief A pointer to the set of template arguments that this
/// parameter pack is instantiated with.
const TemplateArgument *Arguments;
-
+
/// \brief The number of template arguments in \c Arguments.
unsigned NumArguments;
-
- SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(const TemplateTypeParmType *Param,
+
+ SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(const TemplateTypeParmType *Param,
QualType Canon,
const TemplateArgument &ArgPack);
-
+
friend class ASTContext;
-
+
public:
IdentifierInfo *getIdentifier() const { return Replaced->getIdentifier(); }
-
+
/// Gets the template parameter that was substituted for.
const TemplateTypeParmType *getReplacedParameter() const {
return Replaced;
}
-
+
bool isSugared() const { return false; }
QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
-
+
TemplateArgument getArgumentPack() const;
-
+
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID);
static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
const TemplateTypeParmType *Replaced,
const TemplateArgument &ArgPack);
-
+
static bool classof(const Type *T) {
return T->getTypeClass() == SubstTemplateTypeParmPack;
}
@@ -3583,7 +3583,7 @@ class InjectedClassNameType : public Type {
InjectedClassNameType(CXXRecordDecl *D, QualType TST)
: Type(InjectedClassName, QualType(), /*Dependent=*/true,
/*InstantiationDependent=*/true,
- /*VariablyModified=*/false,
+ /*VariablyModified=*/false,
/*ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack=*/false),
Decl(D), InjectedType(TST) {
assert(isa<TemplateSpecializationType>(TST));
@@ -3645,10 +3645,10 @@ enum ElaboratedTypeKeyword {
class TypeWithKeyword : public Type {
protected:
TypeWithKeyword(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword, TypeClass tc,
- QualType Canonical, bool Dependent,
- bool InstantiationDependent, bool VariablyModified,
+ QualType Canonical, bool Dependent,
+ bool InstantiationDependent, bool VariablyModified,
bool ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack)
- : Type(tc, Canonical, Dependent, InstantiationDependent, VariablyModified,
+ : Type(tc, Canonical, Dependent, InstantiationDependent, VariablyModified,
ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack) {
TypeWithKeywordBits.Keyword = Keyword;
}
@@ -3752,12 +3752,12 @@ public:
};
/// \brief Represents a qualified type name for which the type name is
-/// dependent.
+/// dependent.
///
-/// DependentNameType represents a class of dependent types that involve a
-/// dependent nested-name-specifier (e.g., "T::") followed by a (dependent)
+/// DependentNameType represents a class of dependent types that involve a
+/// dependent nested-name-specifier (e.g., "T::") followed by a (dependent)
/// name of a type. The DependentNameType may start with a "typename" (for a
-/// typename-specifier), "class", "struct", "union", or "enum" (for a
+/// typename-specifier), "class", "struct", "union", or "enum" (for a
/// dependent elaborated-type-specifier), or nothing (in contexts where we
/// know that we must be referring to a type, e.g., in a base class specifier).
class DependentNameType : public TypeWithKeyword, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
@@ -3768,7 +3768,7 @@ class DependentNameType : public TypeWithKeyword, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
/// \brief The type that this typename specifier refers to.
const IdentifierInfo *Name;
- DependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword, NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
+ DependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword, NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
const IdentifierInfo *Name, QualType CanonType)
: TypeWithKeyword(Keyword, DependentName, CanonType, /*Dependent=*/true,
/*InstantiationDependent=*/true,
@@ -3885,7 +3885,7 @@ public:
}
static bool classof(const DependentTemplateSpecializationType *T) {
return true;
- }
+ }
};
/// \brief Represents a pack expansion of types.
@@ -3902,7 +3902,7 @@ public:
/// \code
/// template<typename ...Types> struct tuple;
///
-/// template<typename ...Types>
+/// template<typename ...Types>
/// struct tuple_of_references {
/// typedef tuple<Types&...> type;
/// };
@@ -3915,24 +3915,24 @@ class PackExpansionType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
QualType Pattern;
/// \brief The number of expansions that this pack expansion will
- /// generate when substituted (+1), or indicates that
+ /// generate when substituted (+1), or indicates that
///
- /// This field will only have a non-zero value when some of the parameter
- /// packs that occur within the pattern have been substituted but others have
+ /// This field will only have a non-zero value when some of the parameter
+ /// packs that occur within the pattern have been substituted but others have
/// not.
unsigned NumExpansions;
-
+
PackExpansionType(QualType Pattern, QualType Canon,
llvm::Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions)
: Type(PackExpansion, Canon, /*Dependent=*/true,
/*InstantiationDependent=*/true,
/*VariableModified=*/Pattern->isVariablyModifiedType(),
/*ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack=*/false),
- Pattern(Pattern),
+ Pattern(Pattern),
NumExpansions(NumExpansions? *NumExpansions + 1: 0) { }
friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these
-
+
public:
/// \brief Retrieve the pattern of this pack expansion, which is the
/// type that will be repeatedly instantiated when instantiating the
@@ -3944,10 +3944,10 @@ public:
llvm::Optional<unsigned> getNumExpansions() const {
if (NumExpansions)
return NumExpansions - 1;
-
+
return llvm::Optional<unsigned>();
}
-
+
bool isSugared() const { return false; }
QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
@@ -3968,7 +3968,7 @@ public:
}
static bool classof(const PackExpansionType *T) {
return true;
- }
+ }
};
/// ObjCObjectType - Represents a class type in Objective C.
@@ -4012,7 +4012,7 @@ class ObjCObjectType : public Type {
ObjCProtocolDecl **getProtocolStorage();
protected:
- ObjCObjectType(QualType Canonical, QualType Base,
+ ObjCObjectType(QualType Canonical, QualType Base,
ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols, unsigned NumProtocols);
enum Nonce_ObjCInterface { Nonce_ObjCInterface };
@@ -4069,7 +4069,7 @@ public:
assert(I < getNumProtocols() && "Out-of-range protocol access");
return qual_begin()[I];
}
-
+
bool isSugared() const { return false; }
QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
@@ -4090,7 +4090,7 @@ class ObjCObjectTypeImpl : public ObjCObjectType, public llvm::FoldingSetNode {
// If anyone adds fields here, ObjCObjectType::getProtocolStorage()
// will need to be modified.
- ObjCObjectTypeImpl(QualType Canonical, QualType Base,
+ ObjCObjectTypeImpl(QualType Canonical, QualType Base,
ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
unsigned NumProtocols)
: ObjCObjectType(Canonical, Base, Protocols, NumProtocols) {}
@@ -4099,8 +4099,8 @@ public:
void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID);
static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
QualType Base,
- ObjCProtocolDecl *const *protocols,
- unsigned NumProtocols);
+ ObjCProtocolDecl *const *protocols,
+ unsigned NumProtocols);
};
inline ObjCProtocolDecl **ObjCObjectType::getProtocolStorage() {
@@ -4237,7 +4237,7 @@ public:
bool isObjCClassType() const {
return getObjectType()->isObjCUnqualifiedClass();
}
-
+
/// isObjCQualifiedIdType - True if this is equivalent to 'id<P>' for some
/// non-empty set of protocols.
bool isObjCQualifiedIdType() const {
@@ -4274,7 +4274,7 @@ public:
ObjCProtocolDecl *getProtocol(unsigned I) const {
return getObjectType()->getProtocol(I);
}
-
+
bool isSugared() const { return false; }
QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); }
@@ -4333,7 +4333,7 @@ public:
addFastQualifiers(type.getLocalFastQualifiers());
if (!type.hasLocalNonFastQualifiers())
return type.getTypePtrUnsafe();
-
+
const ExtQuals *extQuals = type.getExtQualsUnsafe();
addConsistentQualifiers(extQuals->getQualifiers());
return extQuals->getBaseType();
@@ -4400,7 +4400,7 @@ inline bool QualType::isCanonical() const {
inline bool QualType::isCanonicalAsParam() const {
if (!isCanonical()) return false;
if (hasLocalQualifiers()) return false;
-
+
const Type *T = getTypePtr();
if (T->isVariablyModifiedType() && T->hasSizedVLAType())
return false;
@@ -4409,21 +4409,21 @@ inline bool QualType::isCanonicalAsParam() const {
}
inline bool QualType::isConstQualified() const {
- return isLocalConstQualified() ||
+ return isLocalConstQualified() ||
getCommonPtr()->CanonicalType.isLocalConstQualified();
}
inline bool QualType::isRestrictQualified() const {
- return isLocalRestrictQualified() ||
+ return isLocalRestrictQualified() ||
getCommonPtr()->CanonicalType.isLocalRestrictQualified();
}
inline bool QualType::isVolatileQualified() const {
- return isLocalVolatileQualified() ||
+ return isLocalVolatileQualified() ||
getCommonPtr()->CanonicalType.isLocalVolatileQualified();
}
-
+
inline bool QualType::hasQualifiers() const {
return hasLocalQualifiers() ||
getCommonPtr()->CanonicalType.hasLocalQualifiers();
@@ -4442,7 +4442,7 @@ inline SplitQualType QualType::getSplitUnqualifiedType() const {
return getSplitUnqualifiedTypeImpl(*this);
}
-
+
inline void QualType::removeLocalConst() {
removeLocalFastQualifiers(Qualifiers::Const);
}
@@ -4553,7 +4553,8 @@ inline bool Type::isCompoundType() const {
isReferenceType() ||
// -- classes containing a sequence of objects of various types, [...];
isRecordType() ||
- // -- unions, which ar classes capable of containing objects of different types at different times;
+ // -- unions, which are classes capable of containing objects of different
+ // types at different times;
isUnionType() ||
// -- enumerations, which comprise a set of named constant values. [...];
isEnumeralType() ||
@@ -4643,7 +4644,7 @@ inline bool Type::isObjCObjectType() const {
return isa<ObjCObjectType>(CanonicalType);
}
inline bool Type::isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() const {
- return isa<ObjCInterfaceType>(CanonicalType) ||
+ return isa<ObjCInterfaceType>(CanonicalType) ||
isa<ObjCObjectType>(CanonicalType);
}
inline bool Type::isAtomicType() const {
@@ -4760,15 +4761,15 @@ template<typename T,
bool isArrayType = (llvm::is_same<T, ArrayType>::value ||
llvm::is_base_of<ArrayType, T>::value)>
struct ArrayType_cannot_be_used_with_getAs { };
-
+
template<typename T>
struct ArrayType_cannot_be_used_with_getAs<T, true>;
-
+
/// Member-template getAs<specific type>'.
template <typename T> const T *Type::getAs() const {
ArrayType_cannot_be_used_with_getAs<T> at;
(void)at;
-
+
// If this is directly a T type, return it.
if (const T *Ty = dyn_cast<T>(this))
return Ty;
diff --git a/include/clang/AST/TypeLoc.h b/include/clang/AST/TypeLoc.h
index 20acadab7c..40a9006b78 100644
--- a/include/clang/AST/TypeLoc.h
+++ b/include/clang/AST/TypeLoc.h
@@ -159,7 +159,8 @@ public:
static bool classof(const TypeLoc *TL) { return true; }
private:
- static void initializeImpl(ASTContext &Context, TypeLoc TL, SourceLocation Loc);
+ static void initializeImpl(ASTContext &Context, TypeLoc TL,
+ SourceLocation Loc);
static TypeLoc getNextTypeLocImpl(TypeLoc TL);
static TypeLoc IgnoreParensImpl(TypeLoc TL);
static SourceRange getLocalSourceRangeImpl(TypeLoc TL);
@@ -226,7 +227,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Returns the size of the type source info data block.
unsigned getFullDataSize() const {
- return getLocalDataSize() +
+ return getLocalDataSize() +
getFullDataSizeForType(getType().getLocalUnqualifiedType());
}
@@ -326,7 +327,7 @@ protected:
void *getExtraLocalData() const {
return getLocalData() + 1;
}
-
+
void *getNonLocalData() const {
return static_cast<char*>(Base::Data) + asDerived()->getLocalDataSize();
}
@@ -392,7 +393,7 @@ struct TypeSpecLocInfo {
/// \brief A reasonable base class for TypeLocs that correspond to
/// types that are written as a type-specifier.
-class TypeSpecTypeLoc : public ConcreteTypeLoc<UnqualTypeLoc,
+class TypeSpecTypeLoc : public ConcreteTypeLoc<UnqualTypeLoc,
TypeSpecTypeLoc,
Type,
TypeSpecLocInfo> {
@@ -566,7 +567,7 @@ class TagTypeLoc : public InheritingConcreteTypeLoc<TypeSpecTypeLoc,
public:
TagDecl *getDecl() const { return getTypePtr()->getDecl(); }
- /// \brief True if the tag was defined in this type specifier.
+ /// \brief True if the tag was defined in this type specifier.
bool isDefinition() const {
return getDecl()->isCompleteDefinition() &&
(getNameLoc().isInvalid() || getNameLoc() == getDecl()->getLocation());
@@ -789,7 +790,7 @@ public:
assert(i < getNumProtocols() && "Index is out of bounds!");
return *(this->getTypePtr()->qual_begin() + i);
}
-
+
bool hasBaseTypeAsWritten() const {
return getLocalData()->HasBaseTypeAsWritten;
}
@@ -900,11 +901,11 @@ struct PointerLikeLocInfo {
SourceLocation StarLoc;
};
-/// A base class for
+/// A base class for
template <class Derived, class TypeClass, class LocalData = PointerLikeLocInfo>
class PointerLikeTypeLoc : public ConcreteTypeLoc<UnqualTypeLoc, Derived,
TypeClass, LocalData> {
-public:
+public:
SourceLocation getSigilLoc() const {
return this->getLocalData()->StarLoc;
}
@@ -1476,9 +1477,9 @@ class AutoTypeLoc : public InheritingConcreteTypeLoc<TypeSpecTypeLoc,
struct ElaboratedLocInfo {
SourceLocation KeywordLoc;
-
+
/// \brief Opaque data pointer used to reconstruct a nested-name-specifier
- /// from
+ /// from
void *QualifierData;
};
@@ -1495,12 +1496,12 @@ public:
}
NestedNameSpecifierLoc getQualifierLoc() const {
- return NestedNameSpecifierLoc(getTypePtr()->getQualifier(),
+ return NestedNameSpecifierLoc(getTypePtr()->getQualifier(),
getLocalData()->QualifierData);
}
-
+
void setQualifierLoc(NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc) {
- assert(QualifierLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier()
+ assert(QualifierLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier()
== getTypePtr()->getQualifier() &&
"Inconsistent nested-name-specifier pointer");
getLocalData()->QualifierData = QualifierLoc.getOpaqueData();
@@ -1537,7 +1538,7 @@ public:
// type is some sort of TypeDeclTypeLoc.
struct DependentNameLocInfo : ElaboratedLocInfo {
SourceLocation NameLoc;
-
+
/// \brief Data associated with the nested-name-specifier location.
void *QualifierData;
};
@@ -1555,17 +1556,17 @@ public:
}
NestedNameSpecifierLoc getQualifierLoc() const {
- return NestedNameSpecifierLoc(getTypePtr()->getQualifier(),
+ return NestedNameSpecifierLoc(getTypePtr()->getQualifier(),
getLocalData()->QualifierData);
}
-
+
void setQualifierLoc(NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc) {
- assert(QualifierLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier()
+ assert(QualifierLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier()
== getTypePtr()->getQualifier() &&
"Inconsistent nested-name-specifier pointer");
getLocalData()->QualifierData = QualifierLoc.getOpaqueData();
}
-
+
SourceLocation getNameLoc() const {
return this->getLocalData()->NameLoc;
}
@@ -1612,22 +1613,22 @@ public:
NestedNameSpecifierLoc getQualifierLoc() const {
if (!getLocalData()->QualifierData)
return NestedNameSpecifierLoc();
-
- return NestedNameSpecifierLoc(getTypePtr()->getQualifier(),
+
+ return NestedNameSpecifierLoc(getTypePtr()->getQualifier(),
getLocalData()->QualifierData);
}
-
+
void setQualifierLoc(NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc) {
if (!QualifierLoc) {
- // Even if we have a nested-name-specifier in the dependent
+ // Even if we have a nested-name-specifier in the dependent
// template specialization type, we won't record the nested-name-specifier
// location information when this type-source location information is
// part of a nested-name-specifier.
getLocalData()->QualifierData = 0;
return;
}
-
- assert(QualifierLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier()
+
+ assert(QualifierLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier()
== getTypePtr()->getQualifier() &&
"Inconsistent nested-name-specifier pointer");
getLocalData()->QualifierData = QualifierLoc.getOpaqueData();
@@ -1702,7 +1703,7 @@ struct PackExpansionTypeLocInfo {
};
class PackExpansionTypeLoc
- : public ConcreteTypeLoc<UnqualTypeLoc, PackExpansionTypeLoc,
+ : public ConcreteTypeLoc<UnqualTypeLoc, PackExpansionTypeLoc,
PackExpansionType, PackExpansionTypeLocInfo> {
public:
SourceLocation getEllipsisLoc() const {
@@ -1736,7 +1737,7 @@ struct AtomicTypeLocInfo {
class AtomicTypeLoc : public ConcreteTypeLoc<UnqualTypeLoc, AtomicTypeLoc,
AtomicType, AtomicTypeLocInfo> {
-public:
+public:
TypeLoc getValueLoc() const {
return this->getInnerTypeLoc();
}
diff --git a/include/clang/AST/VTableBuilder.h b/include/clang/AST/VTableBuilder.h
index 59bab03826..2aa9a3dec9 100644
--- a/include/clang/AST/VTableBuilder.h
+++ b/include/clang/AST/VTableBuilder.h
@@ -34,16 +34,16 @@ public:
CK_OffsetToTop,
CK_RTTI,
CK_FunctionPointer,
-
+
/// CK_CompleteDtorPointer - A pointer to the complete destructor.
CK_CompleteDtorPointer,
-
+
/// CK_DeletingDtorPointer - A pointer to the deleting destructor.
CK_DeletingDtorPointer,
-
+
/// CK_UnusedFunctionPointer - In some cases, a vtable function pointer
/// will end up never being called. Such vtable function pointers are
- /// represented as a CK_UnusedFunctionPointer.
+ /// represented as a CK_UnusedFunctionPointer.
CK_UnusedFunctionPointer
};
@@ -60,34 +60,34 @@ public:
static VTableComponent MakeOffsetToTop(CharUnits Offset) {
return VTableComponent(CK_OffsetToTop, Offset);
}
-
+
static VTableComponent MakeRTTI(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) {
return VTableComponent(CK_RTTI, reinterpret_cast<uintptr_t>(RD));
}
static VTableComponent MakeFunction(const CXXMethodDecl *MD) {
- assert(!isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD) &&
+ assert(!isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD) &&
"Don't use MakeFunction with destructors!");
- return VTableComponent(CK_FunctionPointer,
+ return VTableComponent(CK_FunctionPointer,
reinterpret_cast<uintptr_t>(MD));
}
-
+
static VTableComponent MakeCompleteDtor(const CXXDestructorDecl *DD) {
return VTableComponent(CK_CompleteDtorPointer,
reinterpret_cast<uintptr_t>(DD));
}
static VTableComponent MakeDeletingDtor(const CXXDestructorDecl *DD) {
- return VTableComponent(CK_DeletingDtorPointer,
+ return VTableComponent(CK_DeletingDtorPointer,
reinterpret_cast<uintptr_t>(DD));
}
static VTableComponent MakeUnusedFunction(const CXXMethodDecl *MD) {
- assert(!isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD) &&
+ assert(!isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD) &&
"Don't use MakeUnusedFunction with destructors!");
return VTableComponent(CK_UnusedFunctionPointer,
- reinterpret_cast<uintptr_t>(MD));
+ reinterpret_cast<uintptr_t>(MD));
}
static VTableComponent getFromOpaqueInteger(uint64_t I) {
@@ -101,88 +101,88 @@ public:
CharUnits getVCallOffset() const {
assert(getKind() == CK_VCallOffset && "Invalid component kind!");
-
+
return getOffset();
}
CharUnits getVBaseOffset() const {
assert(getKind() == CK_VBaseOffset && "Invalid component kind!");
-
+
return getOffset();
}
CharUnits getOffsetToTop() const {
assert(getKind() == CK_OffsetToTop && "Invalid component kind!");
-
+
return getOffset();
}
-
+
const CXXRecordDecl *getRTTIDecl() const {
assert(getKind() == CK_RTTI && "Invalid component kind!");
-
+
return reinterpret_cast<CXXRecordDecl *>(getPointer());
}
-
+
const CXXMethodDecl *getFunctionDecl() const {
assert(getKind() == CK_FunctionPointer);
-
+
return reinterpret_cast<CXXMethodDecl *>(getPointer());
}
const CXXDestructorDecl *getDestructorDecl() const {
assert((getKind() == CK_CompleteDtorPointer ||
getKind() == CK_DeletingDtorPointer) && "Invalid component kind!");
-
+
return reinterpret_cast<CXXDestructorDecl *>(getPointer());
}
const CXXMethodDecl *getUnusedFunctionDecl() const {
assert(getKind() == CK_UnusedFunctionPointer);
-
+
return reinterpret_cast<CXXMethodDecl *>(getPointer());
}
-
+
private:
VTableComponent(Kind ComponentKind, CharUnits Offset) {
- assert((ComponentKind == CK_VCallOffset ||
+ assert((ComponentKind == CK_VCallOffset ||
ComponentKind == CK_VBaseOffset ||
ComponentKind == CK_OffsetToTop) && "Invalid component kind!");
assert(Offset.getQuantity() <= ((1LL << 56) - 1) && "Offset is too big!");
-
+
Value = ((Offset.getQuantity() << 3) | ComponentKind);
}
VTableComponent(Kind ComponentKind, uintptr_t Ptr) {
- assert((ComponentKind == CK_RTTI ||
+ assert((ComponentKind == CK_RTTI ||
ComponentKind == CK_FunctionPointer ||
ComponentKind == CK_CompleteDtorPointer ||
ComponentKind == CK_DeletingDtorPointer ||
ComponentKind == CK_UnusedFunctionPointer) &&
"Invalid component kind!");
-
+
assert((Ptr & 7) == 0 && "Pointer not sufficiently aligned!");
-
+
Value = Ptr | ComponentKind;
}
-
+
CharUnits getOffset() const {
assert((getKind() == CK_VCallOffset || getKind() == CK_VBaseOffset ||
getKind() == CK_OffsetToTop) && "Invalid component kind!");
-
+
return CharUnits::fromQuantity(Value >> 3);
}
uintptr_t getPointer() const {
- assert((getKind() == CK_RTTI ||
+ assert((getKind() == CK_RTTI ||
getKind() == CK_FunctionPointer ||
getKind() == CK_CompleteDtorPointer ||
getKind() == CK_DeletingDtorPointer ||
getKind() == CK_UnusedFunctionPointer) &&
"Invalid component kind!");
-
+
return static_cast<uintptr_t>(Value & ~7ULL);
}
-
+
explicit VTableComponent(uint64_t Value)
: Value(Value) { }
@@ -210,7 +210,7 @@ private:
/// VTableThunks - Contains thunks needed by vtables.
uint64_t NumVTableThunks;
VTableThunkTy *VTableThunks;
-
+
/// Address points - Address points for all vtables.
AddressPointsMapTy AddressPoints;
@@ -265,10 +265,10 @@ class VTableContext {
ASTContext &Context;
public:
- typedef SmallVector<std::pair<uint64_t, ThunkInfo>, 1>
+ typedef SmallVector<std::pair<uint64_t, ThunkInfo>, 1>
VTableThunksTy;
typedef SmallVector<ThunkInfo, 1> ThunkInfoVectorTy;
-
+
private:
/// MethodVTableIndices - Contains the index (relative to the vtable address
/// point) where the function pointer for a virtual function is stored.
@@ -279,22 +279,22 @@ private:
VTableLayoutMapTy;
VTableLayoutMapTy VTableLayouts;
- /// NumVirtualFunctionPointers - Contains the number of virtual function
+ /// NumVirtualFunctionPointers - Contains the number of virtual function
/// pointers in the vtable for a given record decl.
llvm::DenseMap<const CXXRecordDecl *, uint64_t> NumVirtualFunctionPointers;
typedef std::pair<const CXXRecordDecl *,
const CXXRecordDecl *> ClassPairTy;
- /// VirtualBaseClassOffsetOffsets - Contains the vtable offset (relative to
+ /// VirtualBaseClassOffsetOffsets - Contains the vtable offset (relative to
/// the address point) in chars where the offsets for virtual bases of a class
/// are stored.
- typedef llvm::DenseMap<ClassPairTy, CharUnits>
+ typedef llvm::DenseMap<ClassPairTy, CharUnits>
VirtualBaseClassOffsetOffsetsMapTy;
VirtualBaseClassOffsetOffsetsMapTy VirtualBaseClassOffsetOffsets;
typedef llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, ThunkInfoVectorTy> ThunksMapTy;
-
+
/// Thunks - Contains all thunks that a given method decl will need.
ThunksMapTy Thunks;
@@ -312,7 +312,7 @@ public:
const VTableLayout &getVTableLayout(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) {
ComputeVTableRelatedInformation(RD);
assert(VTableLayouts.count(RD) && "No layout for this record decl!");
-
+
return *VTableLayouts[RD];
}
@@ -337,14 +337,14 @@ public:
/// getNumVirtualFunctionPointers - Return the number of virtual function
/// pointers in the vtable for a given record decl.
uint64_t getNumVirtualFunctionPointers(const CXXRecordDecl *RD);
-
+
/// getMethodVTableIndex - Return the index (relative to the vtable address
/// point) where the function pointer for the given virtual function is
/// stored.
uint64_t getMethodVTableIndex(GlobalDecl GD);
/// getVirtualBaseOffsetOffset - Return the offset in chars (relative to the
- /// vtable address point) where the offset of the virtual base that contains
+ /// vtable address point) where the offset of the virtual base that contains
/// the given base is stored, otherwise, if no virtual base contains the given
/// class, return 0. Base must be a virtual base class or an unambigious
/// base.
diff --git a/include/clang/Analysis/Analyses/Dominators.h b/include/clang/Analysis/Analyses/Dominators.h
index d8299a431e..98a9bf1222 100644
--- a/include/clang/Analysis/Analyses/Dominators.h
+++ b/include/clang/Analysis/Analyses/Dominators.h
@@ -7,7 +7,8 @@
//
//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
//
-// This file implements a simple, fast dominance algorithm for source-level CFGs.
+// This file implements a simple, fast dominance algorithm for source-level
+// CFGs.
//
//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
@@ -27,7 +28,7 @@ class DominatorTree : public ManagedAnalysis {
typedef llvm::DenseMap<const CFGBlock *, CFGBlock*> CFGBlockMapTy;
public:
- DominatorTree(AnalysisDeclContext &ac)
+ DominatorTree(AnalysisDeclContext &ac)
: AC(ac) {}
virtual ~DominatorTree();
@@ -50,7 +51,7 @@ public:
/// Find nearest common dominator for blocks A and B.
/// Common dominator always exists, ex: entry block.
- const CFGBlock *findNearestCommonDominator(const CFGBlock *A,
+ const CFGBlock *findNearestCommonDominator(const CFGBlock *A,
const CFGBlock *B) const;
/// Constructs immediate dominator tree for a given CFG based on the algorithm
@@ -61,7 +62,7 @@ public:
/// Software-Practice and Expreience, 2001;4:1-10.
///
/// This implementation is simple and runs faster in practice than the classis
- /// Lengauer-Tarjan algorithm. For detailed discussions, refer to the paper.
+ /// Lengauer-Tarjan algorithm. For detailed discussions, refer to the paper.
void BuildDominatorTree();
/// Dump the immediate dominance tree
diff --git a/include/clang/Analysis/Analyses/FormatString.h b/include/clang/Analysis/Analyses/FormatString.h
index ac15cfc64d..b2d45e36cb 100644
--- a/include/clang/Analysis/Analyses/FormatString.h
+++ b/include/clang/Analysis/Analyses/FormatString.h
@@ -104,7 +104,7 @@ private:
const char *Position;
Kind kind;
};
-
+
class ConversionSpecifier {
public:
enum Kind {
@@ -113,14 +113,14 @@ public:
cArg,
dArg,
iArg,
- IntArgBeg = cArg, IntArgEnd = iArg,
-
+ IntArgBeg = cArg, IntArgEnd = iArg,
+
oArg,
uArg,
xArg,
XArg,
UIntArgBeg = oArg, UIntArgEnd = XArg,
-
+
fArg,
FArg,
eArg,
@@ -130,44 +130,44 @@ public:
aArg,
AArg,
DoubleArgBeg = fArg, DoubleArgEnd = AArg,
-
+
sArg,
pArg,
nArg,
PercentArg,
CArg,
SArg,
-
+
// ** Printf-specific **
-
+
// Objective-C specific specifiers.
ObjCObjArg, // '@'
ObjCBeg = ObjCObjArg, ObjCEnd = ObjCObjArg,
-
+
// GlibC specific specifiers.
PrintErrno, // 'm'
-
+
PrintfConvBeg = ObjCObjArg, PrintfConvEnd = PrintErrno,
-
- // ** Scanf-specific **
+
+ // ** Scanf-specific **
ScanListArg, // '['
ScanfConvBeg = ScanListArg, ScanfConvEnd = ScanListArg
};
-
+
ConversionSpecifier(bool isPrintf)
: IsPrintf(isPrintf), Position(0), EndScanList(0), kind(InvalidSpecifier) {}
-
+
ConversionSpecifier(bool isPrintf, const char *pos, Kind k)
: IsPrintf(isPrintf), Position(pos), EndScanList(0), kind(k) {}
-
+
const char *getStart() const {
return Position;
}
-
+
StringRef getCharacters() const {
return StringRef(getStart(), getLength());
}
-
+
bool consumesDataArgument() const {
switch (kind) {
case PrintErrno:
@@ -178,15 +178,15 @@ public:
return true;
}
}
-
+
Kind getKind() const { return kind; }
void setKind(Kind k) { kind = k; }
unsigned getLength() const {
return EndScanList ? EndScanList - Position : 1;
}
-
+
const char *toString() const;
-
+
bool isPrintfKind() const { return IsPrintf; }
protected:
@@ -337,7 +337,7 @@ public:
}
bool usesPositionalArg() const { return UsesPositionalArg; }
-
+
bool hasValidLengthModifier() const;
};
@@ -348,7 +348,7 @@ public:
namespace analyze_printf {
-class PrintfConversionSpecifier :
+class PrintfConversionSpecifier :
public analyze_format_string::ConversionSpecifier {
public:
PrintfConversionSpecifier()
@@ -360,7 +360,7 @@ public:
bool isObjCArg() const { return kind >= ObjCBeg && kind <= ObjCEnd; }
bool isIntArg() const { return kind >= IntArgBeg && kind <= IntArgEnd; }
bool isUIntArg() const { return kind >= UIntArgBeg && kind <= UIntArgEnd; }
- bool isDoubleArg() const { return kind >= DoubleArgBeg &&
+ bool isDoubleArg() const { return kind >= DoubleArgBeg &&
kind <= DoubleArgBeg; }
unsigned getLength() const {
// Conversion specifiers currently only are represented by
@@ -438,7 +438,7 @@ public:
const OptionalAmount &getPrecision() const {
return Precision;
}
-
+
bool consumesDataArgument() const {
return getConversionSpecifier().consumesDataArgument();
}
@@ -450,7 +450,7 @@ public:
/// more than one type.
ArgTypeResult getArgType(ASTContext &Ctx) const;
- const OptionalFlag &hasThousandsGrouping() const {
+ const OptionalFlag &hasThousandsGrouping() const {
return HasThousandsGrouping;
}
const OptionalFlag &isLeftJustified() const { return IsLeftJustified; }
@@ -467,7 +467,7 @@ public:
void toString(raw_ostream &os) const;
- // Validation methods - to check if any element results in undefined behavior
+ // Validation methods - to check if any element results in undefined behavior
bool hasValidPlusPrefix() const;
bool hasValidAlternativeForm() const;
bool hasValidLeadingZeros() const;
@@ -495,10 +495,10 @@ public:
: ConversionSpecifier(false, pos, k) {}
void setEndScanList(const char *pos) { EndScanList = pos; }
-
+
static bool classof(const analyze_format_string::ConversionSpecifier *CS) {
return !CS->isPrintfKind();
- }
+ }
};
using analyze_format_string::LengthModifier;
@@ -528,7 +528,7 @@ public:
const ScanfConversionSpecifier &getConversionSpecifier() const {
return cast<ScanfConversionSpecifier>(CS);
}
-
+
bool consumesDataArgument() const {
return CS.consumesDataArgument() && !SuppressAssignment;
}
diff --git a/include/clang/Analysis/Analyses/PostOrderCFGView.h b/include/clang/Analysis/Analyses/PostOrderCFGView.h
index 6c7eaf9014..57db398054 100644
--- a/include/clang/Analysis/Analyses/PostOrderCFGView.h
+++ b/include/clang/Analysis/Analyses/PostOrderCFGView.h
@@ -25,15 +25,15 @@
#include "clang/Analysis/CFG.h"
namespace clang {
-
+
class PostOrderCFGView : public ManagedAnalysis {
public:
/// \brief Implements a set of CFGBlocks using a BitVector.
///
/// This class contains a minimal interface, primarily dictated by the SetType
- /// template parameter of the llvm::po_iterator template, as used with external
- /// storage. We also use this set to keep track of which CFGBlocks we visit
- /// during the analysis.
+ /// template parameter of the llvm::po_iterator template, as used with
+ /// external storage. We also use this set to keep track of which CFGBlocks we
+ /// visit during the analysis.
class CFGBlockSet {
llvm::BitVector VisitedBlockIDs;
public:
@@ -47,8 +47,8 @@ public:
/// \brief Set the bit associated with a particular CFGBlock.
/// This is the important method for the SetType template parameter.
bool insert(const CFGBlock *Block) {
- // Note that insert() is called by po_iterator, which doesn't check to make
- // sure that Block is non-null. Moreover, the CFGBlock iterator will
+ // Note that insert() is called by po_iterator, which doesn't check to
+ // make sure that Block is non-null. Moreover, the CFGBlock iterator will
// occasionally hand out null pointers for pruned edges, so we catch those
// here.
if (Block == 0)
@@ -60,30 +60,30 @@ public:
}
/// \brief Check if the bit for a CFGBlock has been already set.
- /// This method is for tracking visited blocks in the main threadsafety loop.
- /// Block must not be null.
+ /// This method is for tracking visited blocks in the main threadsafety
+ /// loop. Block must not be null.
bool alreadySet(const CFGBlock *Block) {
return VisitedBlockIDs.test(Block->getBlockID());
}
};
private:
- typedef llvm::po_iterator<const CFG*, CFGBlockSet, true> po_iterator;
+ typedef llvm::po_iterator<const CFG*, CFGBlockSet, true> po_iterator;
std::vector<const CFGBlock*> Blocks;
-
+
typedef llvm::DenseMap<const CFGBlock *, unsigned> BlockOrderTy;
BlockOrderTy BlockOrder;
-
+
public:
typedef std::vector<const CFGBlock*>::reverse_iterator iterator;
-
+
PostOrderCFGView(const CFG *cfg);
-
+
iterator begin() { return Blocks.rbegin(); }
iterator end() { return Blocks.rend(); }
-
+
bool empty() { return begin() == end(); }
-
+
struct BlockOrderCompare;
friend struct BlockOrderCompare;
@@ -91,9 +91,9 @@ public:
const PostOrderCFGView &POV;
public:
BlockOrderCompare(const PostOrderCFGView &pov) : POV(pov) {}
- bool operator()(const CFGBlock *b1, const CFGBlock *b2) const;
+ bool operator()(const CFGBlock *b1, const CFGBlock *b2) const;
};
-
+
BlockOrderCompare getComparator() const {
return BlockOrderCompare(*this);
}
@@ -103,7 +103,7 @@ public:
static PostOrderCFGView *create(AnalysisDeclContext &analysisContext);
};
-
+
} // end clang namespace
#endif
diff --git a/include/clang/Analysis/Analyses/ThreadSafety.h b/include/clang/Analysis/Analyses/ThreadSafety.h
index b2e71bca73..6988ec06a8 100644
--- a/include/clang/Analysis/Analyses/ThreadSafety.h
+++ b/include/clang/Analysis/Analyses/ThreadSafety.h
@@ -93,7 +93,8 @@ public:
/// 3. or when a mutex is locked but not unlocked inside a function.
/// \param LockName -- A StringRef name for the lock expression, to be printed
/// in the error message.
- /// \param Loc -- The location of the lock expression where the mutex is locked
+ /// \param Loc -- The location of the lock expression where the mutex is
+ /// locked
/// \param LEK -- which of the three above cases we should warn for
virtual void handleMutexHeldEndOfScope(Name LockName, SourceLocation Loc,
LockErrorKind LEK){}
@@ -143,7 +144,8 @@ public:
/// We traverse the blocks in the CFG, compute the set of mutexes that are held
/// at the end of each block, and issue warnings for thread safety violations.
/// Each block in the CFG is traversed exactly once.
-void runThreadSafetyAnalysis(AnalysisDeclContext &AC, ThreadSafetyHandler &Handler);
+void runThreadSafetyAnalysis(AnalysisDeclContext &AC,
+ ThreadSafetyHandler &Handler);
/// \brief Helper function that returns a LockKind required for the given level
/// of access.
diff --git a/include/clang/Analysis/Analyses/UninitializedValues.h b/include/clang/Analysis/Analyses/UninitializedValues.h
index de057eb4bf..4ee66986be 100644
--- a/include/clang/Analysis/Analyses/UninitializedValues.h
+++ b/include/clang/Analysis/Analyses/UninitializedValues.h
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
-//= UninitializedValues.h - Finding uses of uninitialized values --*- C++ -*-==//
+//= UninitializedValues.h - Finding uses of uninitialized values -*- C++ -*-==//
//
// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
//
@@ -18,11 +18,11 @@
namespace clang {
class AnalysisDeclContext;
-class CFG;
+class CFG;
class DeclContext;
class Expr;
class VarDecl;
-
+
class UninitVariablesHandler {
public:
UninitVariablesHandler() {}
@@ -32,7 +32,7 @@ public:
virtual void handleUseOfUninitVariable(const Expr *ex,
const VarDecl *vd,
bool isAlwaysUninit) {}
-
+
/// Called when the uninitialized variable analysis detects the
/// idiom 'int x = x'. All other uses of 'x' within the initializer
/// are handled by handleUseOfUninitVariable.
diff --git a/include/clang/Analysis/AnalysisContext.h b/include/clang/Analysis/AnalysisContext.h
index 1c7f075512..a204d83009 100644
--- a/include/clang/Analysis/AnalysisContext.h
+++ b/include/clang/Analysis/AnalysisContext.h
@@ -7,8 +7,8 @@
//
//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
//
-// This file defines AnalysisDeclContext, a class that manages the analysis context
-// data for path sensitive analysis.
+// This file defines AnalysisDeclContext, a class that manages the analysis
+// context data for path sensitive analysis.
//
//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
@@ -39,7 +39,7 @@ class ImplicitParamDecl;
class LocationContextManager;
class StackFrameContext;
class AnalysisDeclContextManager;
-class LocationContext;
+class LocationContext;
namespace idx { class TranslationUnit; }
@@ -50,7 +50,7 @@ protected:
ManagedAnalysis() {}
public:
virtual ~ManagedAnalysis();
-
+
// Subclasses need to implement:
//
// static const void *getTag();
@@ -62,15 +62,15 @@ public:
//
// which creates the analysis object given an AnalysisDeclContext.
};
-
-
-/// AnalysisDeclContext contains the context data for the function or method under
-/// analysis.
+
+
+/// AnalysisDeclContext contains the context data for the function or method
+/// under analysis.
class AnalysisDeclContext {
- /// Backpoint to the AnalysisManager object that created this AnalysisDeclContext.
- /// This may be null.
+ /// Backpoint to the AnalysisManager object that created this
+ /// AnalysisDeclContext. This may be null.
AnalysisDeclContextManager *Manager;
-
+
const Decl *D;
// TranslationUnit is NULL if we don't have multiple translation units.
@@ -81,7 +81,7 @@ class AnalysisDeclContext {
CFG::BuildOptions cfgBuildOptions;
CFG::BuildOptions::ForcedBlkExprs *forcedBlkExprs;
-
+
bool builtCFG, builtCompleteCFG;
llvm::OwningPtr<LiveVariables> liveness;
@@ -122,12 +122,12 @@ public:
const CFG::BuildOptions &getCFGBuildOptions() const {
return cfgBuildOptions;
}
-
+
/// getAddEHEdges - Return true iff we are adding exceptional edges from
/// callExprs. If this is false, then try/catch statements and blocks
/// reachable from them can appear to be dead in the CFG, analysis passes must
/// cope with that.
- bool getAddEHEdges() const { return cfgBuildOptions.AddEHEdges; }
+ bool getAddEHEdges() const { return cfgBuildOptions.AddEHEdges; }
bool getUseUnoptimizedCFG() const {
return !cfgBuildOptions.PruneTriviallyFalseEdges;
}
@@ -136,14 +136,14 @@ public:
void registerForcedBlockExpression(const Stmt *stmt);
const CFGBlock *getBlockForRegisteredExpression(const Stmt *stmt);
-
+
Stmt *getBody() const;
CFG *getCFG();
-
+
CFGStmtMap *getCFGStmtMap();
CFGReverseBlockReachabilityAnalysis *getCFGReachablityAnalysis();
-
+
/// Return a version of the CFG without any edges pruned.
CFG *getUnoptimizedCFG();
@@ -165,12 +165,12 @@ public:
/// Return the ImplicitParamDecl* associated with 'self' if this
/// AnalysisDeclContext wraps an ObjCMethodDecl. Returns NULL otherwise.
const ImplicitParamDecl *getSelfDecl() const;
-
+
const StackFrameContext *getStackFrame(LocationContext const *Parent,
const Stmt *S,
const CFGBlock *Blk,
- unsigned Idx);
-
+ unsigned Idx);
+
/// Return the specified analysis object, lazily running the analysis if
/// necessary. Return NULL if the analysis could not run.
template <typename T>
@@ -184,7 +184,7 @@ public:
}
private:
ManagedAnalysis *&getAnalysisImpl(const void* tag);
-
+
LocationContextManager &getLocationContextManager();
};
@@ -195,7 +195,8 @@ public:
private:
ContextKind Kind;
- // AnalysisDeclContext can't be const since some methods may modify its member.
+ // AnalysisDeclContext can't be const since some methods may modify its
+ // member.
AnalysisDeclContext *Ctx;
const LocationContext *Parent;
@@ -212,8 +213,8 @@ public:
AnalysisDeclContext *getAnalysisDeclContext() const { return Ctx; }
- idx::TranslationUnit *getTranslationUnit() const {
- return Ctx->getTranslationUnit();
+ idx::TranslationUnit *getTranslationUnit() const {
+ return Ctx->getTranslationUnit();
}
const LocationContext *getParent() const { return Parent; }
@@ -265,7 +266,7 @@ class StackFrameContext : public LocationContext {
friend class LocationContextManager;
StackFrameContext(AnalysisDeclContext *ctx, const LocationContext *parent,
- const Stmt *s, const CFGBlock *blk,
+ const Stmt *s, const CFGBlock *blk,
unsigned idx)
: LocationContext(StackFrame, ctx, parent), CallSite(s),
Block(blk), Index(idx) {}
@@ -324,7 +325,8 @@ class BlockInvocationContext : public LocationContext {
friend class LocationContextManager;
- BlockInvocationContext(AnalysisDeclContext *ctx, const LocationContext *parent,
+ BlockInvocationContext(AnalysisDeclContext *ctx,
+ const LocationContext *parent,
const BlockDecl *bd)
: LocationContext(Block, ctx, parent), BD(bd) {}
@@ -370,28 +372,28 @@ private:
class AnalysisDeclContextManager {
typedef llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AnalysisDeclContext*> ContextMap;
-
+
ContextMap Contexts;
LocationContextManager LocContexts;
CFG::BuildOptions cfgBuildOptions;
-
+
public:
AnalysisDeclContextManager(bool useUnoptimizedCFG = false,
bool addImplicitDtors = false,
bool addInitializers = false);
-
+
~AnalysisDeclContextManager();
-
+
AnalysisDeclContext *getContext(const Decl *D, idx::TranslationUnit *TU = 0);
-
+
bool getUseUnoptimizedCFG() const {
return !cfgBuildOptions.PruneTriviallyFalseEdges;
}
-
+
CFG::BuildOptions &getCFGBuildOptions() {
return cfgBuildOptions;
}
-
+
const StackFrameContext *getStackFrame(AnalysisDeclContext *Ctx,
LocationContext const *Parent,
const Stmt *S,
@@ -399,15 +401,15 @@ public:
unsigned Idx) {
return LocContexts.getStackFrame(Ctx, Parent, S, Blk, Idx);
}
-
+
// Get the top level stack frame.
- const StackFrameContext *getStackFrame(Decl const *D,
+ const StackFrameContext *getStackFrame(Decl const *D,
idx::TranslationUnit *TU) {
return LocContexts.getStackFrame(getContext(D, TU), 0, 0, 0, 0);
}
-
+
// Get a stack frame with parent.
- StackFrameContext const *getStackFrame(const Decl *D,
+ StackFrameContext const *getStackFrame(const Decl *D,
LocationContext const *Parent,
const Stmt *S,
const CFGBlock *Blk,
@@ -415,7 +417,7 @@ public:
return LocContexts.getStackFrame(getContext(D), Parent, S, Blk, Idx);
}
-
+
/// Discard all previously created AnalysisDeclContexts.
void clear();
diff --git a/include/clang/Analysis/CFG.h b/include/clang/Analysis/CFG.h
index f191c80281..66b7a6de64 100644
--- a/include/clang/Analysis/CFG.h
+++ b/include/clang/Analysis/CFG.h
@@ -67,22 +67,22 @@ protected:
CFGElement(Kind kind, const void *Ptr1, const void *Ptr2 = 0)
: Data1(const_cast<void*>(Ptr1), ((unsigned) kind) & 0x3),
- Data2(const_cast<void*>(Ptr2), (((unsigned) kind) >> 2) & 0x3) {}
+ Data2(const_cast<void*>(Ptr2), (((unsigned) kind) >> 2) & 0x3) {}
public:
CFGElement() {}
- Kind getKind() const {
+ Kind getKind() const {
unsigned x = Data2.getInt();
x <<= 2;
x |= Data1.getInt();
return (Kind) x;
}
-
+
bool isValid() const { return getKind() != Invalid; }
operator bool() const { return isValid(); }
-
+
template<class ElemTy> const ElemTy *getAs() const {
if (llvm::isa<ElemTy>(this))
return static_cast<const ElemTy*>(this);
@@ -96,7 +96,7 @@ class CFGStmt : public CFGElement {
public:
CFGStmt(Stmt *S) : CFGElement(Statement, S) {}
- const Stmt *getStmt() const {
+ const Stmt *getStmt() const {
return static_cast<const Stmt *>(Data1.getPointer());
}
@@ -125,9 +125,9 @@ public:
/// by compiler on various occasions.
class CFGImplicitDtor : public CFGElement {
protected:
- CFGImplicitDtor(Kind kind, const void *data1, const void *data2 = 0)
+ CFGImplicitDtor(Kind kind, const void *data1, const void *data2 = 0)
: CFGElement(kind, data1, data2) {
- assert(kind >= DTOR_BEGIN && kind <= DTOR_END);
+ assert(kind >= DTOR_BEGIN && kind <= DTOR_END);
}
public:
@@ -272,12 +272,12 @@ class CFGBlock {
ImplTy Impl;
public:
ElementList(BumpVectorContext &C) : Impl(C, 4) {}
-
+
typedef std::reverse_iterator<ImplTy::iterator> iterator;
typedef std::reverse_iterator<ImplTy::const_iterator> const_iterator;
typedef ImplTy::iterator reverse_iterator;
- typedef ImplTy::const_iterator const_reverse_iterator;
-
+ typedef ImplTy::const_iterator const_reverse_iterator;
+
void push_back(CFGElement e, BumpVectorContext &C) { Impl.push_back(e, C); }
reverse_iterator insert(reverse_iterator I, size_t Cnt, CFGElement E,
BumpVectorContext &C) {
@@ -286,7 +286,7 @@ class CFGBlock {
CFGElement front() const { return Impl.back(); }
CFGElement back() const { return Impl.front(); }
-
+
iterator begin() { return Impl.rbegin(); }
iterator end() { return Impl.rend(); }
const_iterator begin() const { return Impl.rbegin(); }
@@ -300,7 +300,7 @@ class CFGBlock {
assert(i < Impl.size());
return Impl[Impl.size() - 1 - i];
}
-
+
size_t size() const { return Impl.size(); }
bool empty() const { return Impl.empty(); }
};
@@ -492,13 +492,13 @@ public:
void dump(const CFG *cfg, const LangOptions &LO) const;
void print(raw_ostream &OS, const CFG* cfg, const LangOptions &LO) const;
void printTerminator(raw_ostream &OS, const LangOptions &LO) const;
-
+
void addSuccessor(CFGBlock *Block, BumpVectorContext &C) {
if (Block)
Block->Preds.push_back(this, C);
Succs.push_back(Block, C);
}
-
+
void appendStmt(Stmt *statement, BumpVectorContext &C) {
Elements.push_back(CFGStmt(statement), C);
}
@@ -515,7 +515,7 @@ public:
void appendMemberDtor(FieldDecl *FD, BumpVectorContext &C) {
Elements.push_back(CFGMemberDtor(FD), C);
}
-
+
void appendTemporaryDtor(CXXBindTemporaryExpr *E, BumpVectorContext &C) {
Elements.push_back(CFGTemporaryDtor(E), C);
}
@@ -554,22 +554,22 @@ public:
llvm::BitVector alwaysAddMask;
public:
typedef llvm::DenseMap<const Stmt *, const CFGBlock*> ForcedBlkExprs;
- ForcedBlkExprs **forcedBlkExprs;
+ ForcedBlkExprs **forcedBlkExprs;
bool PruneTriviallyFalseEdges;
bool AddEHEdges;
bool AddInitializers;
bool AddImplicitDtors;
-
+
bool alwaysAdd(const Stmt *stmt) const {
return alwaysAddMask[stmt->getStmtClass()];
}
-
+
BuildOptions &setAlwaysAdd(Stmt::StmtClass stmtClass, bool val = true) {
alwaysAddMask[stmtClass] = val;
return *this;
}
-
+
BuildOptions &setAllAlwaysAdd() {
alwaysAddMask.set();
return *this;
@@ -605,7 +605,7 @@ public:
// Block Iterators
//===--------------------------------------------------------------------===//
- typedef BumpVector<CFGBlock*> CFGBlockListTy;
+ typedef BumpVector<CFGBlock*> CFGBlockListTy;
typedef CFGBlockListTy::iterator iterator;
typedef CFGBlockListTy::const_iterator const_iterator;
typedef std::reverse_iterator<iterator> reverse_iterator;
@@ -631,7 +631,7 @@ public:
CFGBlock * getIndirectGotoBlock() { return IndirectGotoBlock; }
const CFGBlock * getIndirectGotoBlock() const { return IndirectGotoBlock; }
-
+
typedef std::vector<const CFGBlock*>::const_iterator try_block_iterator;
try_block_iterator try_blocks_begin() const {
return TryDispatchBlocks.begin();
@@ -639,7 +639,7 @@ public:
try_block_iterator try_blocks_end() const {
return TryDispatchBlocks.end();
}
-
+
void addTryDispatchBlock(const CFGBlock *block) {
TryDispatchBlocks.push_back(block);
}
@@ -701,7 +701,7 @@ public:
llvm::BumpPtrAllocator& getAllocator() {
return BlkBVC.getAllocator();
}
-
+
BumpVectorContext &getBumpVectorContext() {
return BlkBVC;
}
@@ -717,11 +717,11 @@ private:
// It represents a map from Expr* to integers to record the set of
// block-level expressions and their "statement number" in the CFG.
void * BlkExprMap;
-
+
BumpVectorContext BlkBVC;
-
+
CFGBlockListTy Blocks;
-
+
/// C++ 'try' statements are modeled with an indirect dispatch block.
/// This is the collection of such blocks present in the CFG.
std::vector<const CFGBlock *> TryDispatchBlocks;
diff --git a/include/clang/Frontend/Utils.h b/include/clang/Frontend/Utils.h
index 929beb079e..6a81459800 100644
--- a/include/clang/Frontend/Utils.h
+++ b/include/clang/Frontend/Utils.h
@@ -66,7 +66,8 @@ void InitializePreprocessor(Preprocessor &PP,
/// ProcessWarningOptions - Initialize the diagnostic client and process the
/// warning options specified on the command line.
-void ProcessWarningOptions(DiagnosticsEngine &Diags, const DiagnosticOptions &Opts);
+void ProcessWarningOptions(DiagnosticsEngine &Diags,
+ const DiagnosticOptions &Opts);
/// DoPrintPreprocessedInput - Implement -E mode.
void DoPrintPreprocessedInput(Preprocessor &PP, raw_ostream* OS,
diff --git a/include/clang/Index/ASTLocation.h b/include/clang/Index/ASTLocation.h
index 7b66e7ea4f..5fc2be2dbe 100644
--- a/include/clang/Index/ASTLocation.h
+++ b/include/clang/Index/ASTLocation.h
@@ -42,7 +42,7 @@ public:
struct NamedRef {
NamedDecl *ND;
SourceLocation Loc;
-
+
NamedRef() : ND(0) { }
NamedRef(NamedDecl *nd, SourceLocation loc) : ND(nd), Loc(loc) { }
};
@@ -95,14 +95,14 @@ public:
bool isValid() const { return ParentDecl.getPointer() != 0; }
bool isInvalid() const { return !isValid(); }
-
+
NodeKind getKind() const {
assert(isValid());
return (NodeKind)ParentDecl.getInt();
}
-
+
Decl *getParentDecl() const { return ParentDecl.getPointer(); }
-
+
Decl *AsDecl() const {
assert(getKind() == N_Decl);
return D;
@@ -121,14 +121,16 @@ public:
}
Decl *dyn_AsDecl() const { return isValid() && getKind() == N_Decl ? D : 0; }
- Stmt *dyn_AsStmt() const { return isValid() && getKind() == N_Stmt ? Stm : 0; }
+ Stmt *dyn_AsStmt() const {
+ return isValid() && getKind() == N_Stmt ? Stm : 0;
+ }
NamedRef dyn_AsNamedRef() const {
return getKind() == N_Type ? AsNamedRef() : NamedRef();
}
TypeLoc dyn_AsTypeLoc() const {
return getKind() == N_Type ? AsTypeLoc() : TypeLoc();
}
-
+
bool isDecl() const { return isValid() && getKind() == N_Decl; }
bool isStmt() const { return isValid() && getKind() == N_Stmt; }
bool isNamedRef() const { return isValid() && getKind() == N_NamedRef; }
diff --git a/include/clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h b/include/clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h
index 50d6a2adc9..bcd3c4b274 100644
--- a/include/clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h
+++ b/include/clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h
@@ -50,7 +50,7 @@ class CodeCompletionHandler;
class DirectoryLookup;
class PreprocessingRecord;
class ModuleLoader;
-
+
/// Preprocessor - This object engages in a tight little dance with the lexer to
/// efficiently preprocess tokens. Lexers know only about tokens within a
/// single source file, and don't know anything about preprocessor-level issues
@@ -69,7 +69,7 @@ class Preprocessor : public llvm::RefCountedBase<Preprocessor> {
/// \brief External source of macros.
ExternalPreprocessorSource *ExternalSource;
-
+
/// PTH - An optional PTHManager object used for getting tokens from
/// a token cache rather than lexing the original source file.
llvm::OwningPtr<PTHManager> PTH;
@@ -108,7 +108,7 @@ class Preprocessor : public llvm::RefCountedBase<Preprocessor> {
bool KeepMacroComments : 1;
bool SuppressIncludeNotFoundError : 1;
bool AutoModuleImport : 1;
-
+
// State that changes while the preprocessor runs:
bool InMacroArgs : 1; // True if parsing fn macro invocation args.
@@ -147,7 +147,7 @@ class Preprocessor : public llvm::RefCountedBase<Preprocessor> {
/// \brief The code-completion handler.
CodeCompletionHandler *CodeComplete;
-
+
/// \brief The file that we're performing code-completion for, if any.
const FileEntry *CodeCompletionFile;
@@ -170,7 +170,7 @@ class Preprocessor : public llvm::RefCountedBase<Preprocessor> {
/// \brief The source location of the currently-active
/// #pragma clang arc_cf_code_audited begin.
SourceLocation PragmaARCCFCodeAuditedLoc;
-
+
/// \brief True if we hit the code-completion point.
bool CodeCompletionReached;
@@ -179,7 +179,7 @@ class Preprocessor : public llvm::RefCountedBase<Preprocessor> {
/// with a flag that indicates whether skipping this number of bytes will
/// place the lexer at the start of a line.
std::pair<unsigned, bool> SkipMainFilePreamble;
-
+
/// CurLexer - This is the current top of the stack that we're lexing from if
/// not expanding a macro and we are lexing directly from source code.
/// Only one of CurLexer, CurPTHLexer, or CurTokenLexer will be non-null.
@@ -194,7 +194,7 @@ class Preprocessor : public llvm::RefCountedBase<Preprocessor> {
/// if not expanding a macro. This is an alias for either CurLexer or
/// CurPTHLexer.
PreprocessorLexer *CurPPLexer;
-
+
/// CurLookup - The DirectoryLookup structure used to find the current
/// FileEntry, if CurLexer is non-null and if applicable. This allows us to
/// implement #include_next and find directory-specific properties.
@@ -205,10 +205,10 @@ class Preprocessor : public llvm::RefCountedBase<Preprocessor> {
llvm::OwningPtr<TokenLexer> CurTokenLexer;
/// \brief The kind of lexer we're currently working with.
- enum CurLexerKind {
- CLK_Lexer,
- CLK_PTHLexer,
- CLK_TokenLexer,
+ enum CurLexerKind {
+ CLK_Lexer,
+ CLK_PTHLexer,
+ CLK_TokenLexer,
CLK_CachingLexer,
CLK_LexAfterModuleImport
} CurLexerKind;
@@ -224,10 +224,10 @@ class Preprocessor : public llvm::RefCountedBase<Preprocessor> {
TokenLexer *TheTokenLexer;
const DirectoryLookup *TheDirLookup;
- IncludeStackInfo(enum CurLexerKind K, Lexer *L, PTHLexer* P,
+ IncludeStackInfo(enum CurLexerKind K, Lexer *L, PTHLexer* P,
PreprocessorLexer* PPL,
TokenLexer* TL, const DirectoryLookup *D)
- : CurLexerKind(K), TheLexer(L), ThePTHLexer(P), ThePPLexer(PPL),
+ : CurLexerKind(K), TheLexer(L), ThePTHLexer(P), ThePPLexer(PPL),
TheTokenLexer(TL), TheDirLookup(D) {}
};
std::vector<IncludeStackInfo> IncludeMacroStack;
@@ -254,9 +254,9 @@ class Preprocessor : public llvm::RefCountedBase<Preprocessor> {
/// reused for quick allocation.
MacroArgs *MacroArgCache;
friend class MacroArgs;
-
- /// PragmaPushMacroInfo - For each IdentifierInfo used in a #pragma
- /// push_macro directive, we keep a MacroInfo stack used to restore
+
+ /// PragmaPushMacroInfo - For each IdentifierInfo used in a #pragma
+ /// push_macro directive, we keep a MacroInfo stack used to restore
/// previous macro value.
llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, std::vector<MacroInfo*> > PragmaPushMacroInfo;
@@ -286,12 +286,12 @@ class Preprocessor : public llvm::RefCountedBase<Preprocessor> {
std::vector<std::pair<TokenLexer *, size_t> > MacroExpandingLexersStack;
/// \brief A record of the macro definitions and expansions that
- /// occurred during preprocessing.
+ /// occurred during preprocessing.
///
/// This is an optional side structure that can be enabled with
/// \c createPreprocessingRecord() prior to preprocessing.
PreprocessingRecord *Record;
-
+
private: // Cached tokens state.
typedef SmallVector<Token, 1> CachedTokensTy;
@@ -325,7 +325,7 @@ private: // Cached tokens state.
MacroInfoChain *MICache;
MacroInfo *getInfoForMacro(IdentifierInfo *II) const;
-
+
public:
Preprocessor(DiagnosticsEngine &diags, LangOptions &opts,
const TargetInfo *target,
@@ -342,7 +342,7 @@ public:
///
/// \param Target Information about the target.
void Initialize(const TargetInfo &Target);
-
+
DiagnosticsEngine &getDiagnostics() const { return *Diags; }
void setDiagnostics(DiagnosticsEngine &D) { Diags = &D; }
@@ -371,7 +371,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Retrieve the module loader associated with this preprocessor.
ModuleLoader &getModuleLoader() const { return TheModuleLoader; }
-
+
/// SetCommentRetentionState - Control whether or not the preprocessor retains
/// comments in output.
void SetCommentRetentionState(bool KeepComments, bool KeepMacroComments) {
@@ -393,7 +393,7 @@ public:
void setAutoModuleImport(bool AutoModuleImport = true) {
this->AutoModuleImport = AutoModuleImport;
}
-
+
/// isCurrentLexer - Return true if we are lexing directly from the specified
/// lexer.
bool isCurrentLexer(const PreprocessorLexer *L) const {
@@ -425,7 +425,7 @@ public:
MacroInfo *getMacroInfo(IdentifierInfo *II) const {
if (!II->hasMacroDefinition())
return 0;
-
+
return getInfoForMacro(II);
}
@@ -484,29 +484,29 @@ public:
void setCodeCompletionHandler(CodeCompletionHandler &Handler) {
CodeComplete = &Handler;
}
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the current code-completion handler.
CodeCompletionHandler *getCodeCompletionHandler() const {
return CodeComplete;
}
-
+
/// \brief Clear out the code completion handler.
void clearCodeCompletionHandler() {
CodeComplete = 0;
}
-
+
/// \brief Hook used by the lexer to invoke the "natural language" code
/// completion point.
void CodeCompleteNaturalLanguage();
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the preprocessing record, or NULL if there is no
/// preprocessing record.
PreprocessingRecord *getPreprocessingRecord() const { return Record; }
-
- /// \brief Create a new preprocessing record, which will keep track of
+
+ /// \brief Create a new preprocessing record, which will keep track of
/// all macro expansions, macro definitions, etc.
void createPreprocessingRecord(bool IncludeNestedMacroExpansions);
-
+
/// EnterMainSourceFile - Enter the specified FileID as the main source file,
/// which implicitly adds the builtin defines etc.
void EnterMainSourceFile();
@@ -588,7 +588,7 @@ public:
}
void LexAfterModuleImport(Token &Result);
-
+
/// LexNonComment - Lex a token. If it's a comment, keep lexing until we get
/// something not a comment. This is useful in -E -C mode where comments
/// would foul up preprocessor directive handling.
@@ -745,11 +745,11 @@ public:
///
/// \brief StartOfLine Whether skipping these bytes puts the lexer at the
/// start of a line.
- void setSkipMainFilePreamble(unsigned Bytes, bool StartOfLine) {
+ void setSkipMainFilePreamble(unsigned Bytes, bool StartOfLine) {
SkipMainFilePreamble.first = Bytes;
SkipMainFilePreamble.second = StartOfLine;
}
-
+
/// Diag - Forwarding function for diagnostics. This emits a diagnostic at
/// the specified Token's location, translating the token's start
/// position in the current buffer into a SourcePosition object for rendering.
@@ -795,7 +795,7 @@ public:
/// to point to a constant buffer with the data already in it (avoiding a
/// copy). The caller is not allowed to modify the returned buffer pointer
/// if an internal buffer is returned.
- unsigned getSpelling(const Token &Tok, const char *&Buffer,
+ unsigned getSpelling(const Token &Tok, const char *&Buffer,
bool *Invalid = 0) const {
return Lexer::getSpelling(Tok, Buffer, SourceMgr, Features, Invalid);
}
@@ -804,12 +804,12 @@ public:
/// SmallVector. Note that the returned StringRef may not point to the
/// supplied buffer if a copy can be avoided.
StringRef getSpelling(const Token &Tok,
- SmallVectorImpl<char> &Buffer,
+ SmallVectorImpl<char> &Buffer,
bool *Invalid = 0) const;
/// getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant - Tok is a numeric constant
/// with length 1, return the character.
- char getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(const Token &Tok,
+ char getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(const Token &Tok,
bool *Invalid = 0) const {
assert(Tok.is(tok::numeric_constant) &&
Tok.getLength() == 1 && "Called on unsupported token");
@@ -930,9 +930,18 @@ public:
private:
/// Identifiers used for SEH handling in Borland. These are only
/// allowed in particular circumstances
- IdentifierInfo *Ident__exception_code, *Ident___exception_code, *Ident_GetExceptionCode; // __except block
- IdentifierInfo *Ident__exception_info, *Ident___exception_info, *Ident_GetExceptionInfo; // __except filter expression
- IdentifierInfo *Ident__abnormal_termination, *Ident___abnormal_termination, *Ident_AbnormalTermination; // __finally
+ // __except block
+ IdentifierInfo *Ident__exception_code,
+ *Ident___exception_code,
+ *Ident_GetExceptionCode;
+ // __except filter expression
+ IdentifierInfo *Ident__exception_info,
+ *Ident___exception_info,
+ *Ident_GetExceptionInfo;
+ // __finally
+ IdentifierInfo *Ident__abnormal_termination,
+ *Ident___abnormal_termination,
+ *Ident_AbnormalTermination;
public:
void PoisonSEHIdentifiers(bool Poison = true); // Borland
@@ -1163,7 +1172,7 @@ private:
bool InCachingLexMode() const {
// If the Lexer pointers are 0 and IncludeMacroStack is empty, it means
// that we are past EOF, not that we are in CachingLex mode.
- return CurPPLexer == 0 && CurTokenLexer == 0 && CurPTHLexer == 0 &&
+ return CurPPLexer == 0 && CurTokenLexer == 0 && CurPTHLexer == 0 &&
!IncludeMacroStack.empty();
}
void EnterCachingLexMode();
@@ -1184,7 +1193,7 @@ private:
void HandleIdentSCCSDirective(Token &Tok);
void HandleMacroExportDirective(Token &Tok);
void HandleMacroPrivateDirective(Token &Tok);
-
+
// File inclusion.
void HandleIncludeDirective(SourceLocation HashLoc,
Token &Tok,
diff --git a/include/clang/Sema/CodeCompleteConsumer.h b/include/clang/Sema/CodeCompleteConsumer.h
index 69003d0b4e..7bf05910c3 100644
--- a/include/clang/Sema/CodeCompleteConsumer.h
+++ b/include/clang/Sema/CodeCompleteConsumer.h
@@ -24,14 +24,14 @@
namespace clang {
class Decl;
-
+
/// \brief Default priority values for code-completion results based
/// on their kind.
enum {
/// \brief Priority for the next initialization in a constructor initializer
/// list.
CCP_NextInitializer = 7,
- /// \brief Priority for an enumeration constant inside a switch whose
+ /// \brief Priority for an enumeration constant inside a switch whose
/// condition is of the enumeration type.
CCP_EnumInCase = 7,
/// \brief Priority for a send-to-super completion.
@@ -59,7 +59,7 @@ enum {
/// \brief Priority for a result that isn't likely to be what the user wants,
/// but is included for completeness.
CCP_Unlikely = 80,
-
+
/// \brief Priority for the Objective-C "_cmd" implicit parameter.
CCP_ObjC_cmd = CCP_Unlikely
};
@@ -76,15 +76,15 @@ enum {
/// of the current method, which might imply that some kind of delegation
/// is occurring.
CCD_SelectorMatch = -3,
-
+
/// \brief Adjustment to the "bool" type in Objective-C, where the typedef
/// "BOOL" is preferred.
CCD_bool_in_ObjC = 1,
-
+
/// \brief Adjustment for KVC code pattern priorities when it doesn't look
/// like the
CCD_ProbablyNotObjCCollection = 15,
-
+
/// \brief An Objective-C method being used as a property.
CCD_MethodAsProperty = 2
};
@@ -114,14 +114,14 @@ enum SimplifiedTypeClass {
STC_Record,
STC_Void
};
-
+
/// \brief Determine the simplified type class of the given canonical type.
SimplifiedTypeClass getSimplifiedTypeClass(CanQualType T);
-
+
/// \brief Determine the type that this declaration will have if it is used
/// as a type or in an expression.
QualType getDeclUsageType(ASTContext &C, NamedDecl *ND);
-
+
/// \brief Determine the priority to be given to a macro code completion result
/// with the given name.
///
@@ -131,14 +131,14 @@ QualType getDeclUsageType(ASTContext &C, NamedDecl *ND);
///
/// \param PreferredTypeIsPointer Whether the preferred type for the context
/// of this macro is a pointer type.
-unsigned getMacroUsagePriority(StringRef MacroName,
+unsigned getMacroUsagePriority(StringRef MacroName,
const LangOptions &LangOpts,
bool PreferredTypeIsPointer = false);
/// \brief Determine the libclang cursor kind associated with the given
/// declaration.
CXCursorKind getCursorKindForDecl(Decl *D);
-
+
class FunctionDecl;
class FunctionType;
class FunctionTemplateDecl;
@@ -182,22 +182,22 @@ public:
/// \brief Code completion occurred on the right-hand side of a member
/// access expression using the dot operator.
///
- /// The results of this completion are the members of the type being
- /// accessed. The type itself is available via
+ /// The results of this completion are the members of the type being
+ /// accessed. The type itself is available via
/// \c CodeCompletionContext::getType().
CCC_DotMemberAccess,
/// \brief Code completion occurred on the right-hand side of a member
/// access expression using the arrow operator.
///
- /// The results of this completion are the members of the type being
- /// accessed. The type itself is available via
+ /// The results of this completion are the members of the type being
+ /// accessed. The type itself is available via
/// \c CodeCompletionContext::getType().
CCC_ArrowMemberAccess,
/// \brief Code completion occurred on the right-hand side of an Objective-C
/// property access expression.
///
- /// The results of this completion are the members of the type being
- /// accessed. The type itself is available via
+ /// The results of this completion are the members of the type being
+ /// accessed. The type itself is available via
/// \c CodeCompletionContext::getType().
CCC_ObjCPropertyAccess,
/// \brief Code completion occurred after the "enum" keyword, to indicate
@@ -228,7 +228,7 @@ public:
CCC_MacroNameUse,
/// \brief Code completion occurred within a preprocessor expression.
CCC_PreprocessorExpression,
- /// \brief Code completion occurred where a preprocessor directive is
+ /// \brief Code completion occurred where a preprocessor directive is
/// expected.
CCC_PreprocessorDirective,
/// \brief Code completion occurred in a context where natural language is
@@ -246,14 +246,14 @@ public:
CCC_ParenthesizedExpression,
/// \brief Code completion where an Objective-C instance message is expcted.
CCC_ObjCInstanceMessage,
- /// \brief Code completion where an Objective-C class message is expected.
+ /// \brief Code completion where an Objective-C class message is expected.
CCC_ObjCClassMessage,
/// \brief Code completion where the name of an Objective-C class is
/// expected.
CCC_ObjCInterfaceName,
/// \brief Code completion where an Objective-C category name is expected.
CCC_ObjCCategoryName,
- /// \brief An unknown context, in which we are recovering from a parsing
+ /// \brief An unknown context, in which we are recovering from a parsing
/// error and don't know which completions we should give.
CCC_Recovery
};
@@ -264,27 +264,27 @@ private:
/// \brief The type that would prefer to see at this point (e.g., the type
/// of an initializer or function parameter).
QualType PreferredType;
-
+
/// \brief The type of the base object in a member access expression.
QualType BaseType;
-
+
/// \brief The identifiers for Objective-C selector parts.
IdentifierInfo **SelIdents;
-
+
/// \brief The number of Objective-C selector parts.
unsigned NumSelIdents;
-
+
public:
/// \brief Construct a new code-completion context of the given kind.
- CodeCompletionContext(enum Kind Kind) : Kind(Kind), SelIdents(NULL),
+ CodeCompletionContext(enum Kind Kind) : Kind(Kind), SelIdents(NULL),
NumSelIdents(0) { }
-
+
/// \brief Construct a new code-completion context of the given kind.
CodeCompletionContext(enum Kind Kind, QualType T,
IdentifierInfo **SelIdents = NULL,
unsigned NumSelIdents = 0) : Kind(Kind),
SelIdents(SelIdents),
- NumSelIdents(NumSelIdents) {
+ NumSelIdents(NumSelIdents) {
if (Kind == CCC_DotMemberAccess || Kind == CCC_ArrowMemberAccess ||
Kind == CCC_ObjCPropertyAccess || Kind == CCC_ObjCClassMessage ||
Kind == CCC_ObjCInstanceMessage)
@@ -292,22 +292,22 @@ public:
else
PreferredType = T;
}
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the kind of code-completion context.
enum Kind getKind() const { return Kind; }
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the type that this expression would prefer to have, e.g.,
/// if the expression is a variable initializer or a function argument, the
/// type of the corresponding variable or function parameter.
QualType getPreferredType() const { return PreferredType; }
-
- /// \brief Retrieve the type of the base object in a member-access
+
+ /// \brief Retrieve the type of the base object in a member-access
/// expression.
QualType getBaseType() const { return BaseType; }
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the Objective-C selector identifiers.
IdentifierInfo **getSelIdents() const { return SelIdents; }
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the number of Objective-C selector identifiers.
unsigned getNumSelIdents() const { return NumSelIdents; }
@@ -320,10 +320,10 @@ public:
/// \brief A "string" used to describe how code completion can
/// be performed for an entity.
///
-/// A code completion string typically shows how a particular entity can be
+/// A code completion string typically shows how a particular entity can be
/// used. For example, the code completion string for a function would show
-/// the syntax to call it, including the parentheses, placeholders for the
-/// arguments, etc.
+/// the syntax to call it, including the parentheses, placeholders for the
+/// arguments, etc.
class CodeCompletionString {
public:
/// \brief The different kinds of "chunks" that can occur within a code
@@ -340,7 +340,7 @@ public:
/// an optional code completion string that describes the default arguments
/// in a function call.
CK_Optional,
- /// \brief A string that acts as a placeholder for, e.g., a function
+ /// \brief A string that acts as a placeholder for, e.g., a function
/// call argument.
CK_Placeholder,
/// \brief A piece of text that describes something about the result but
@@ -383,30 +383,30 @@ public:
/// platform).
CK_VerticalSpace
};
-
+
/// \brief One piece of the code completion string.
struct Chunk {
- /// \brief The kind of data stored in this piece of the code completion
+ /// \brief The kind of data stored in this piece of the code completion
/// string.
ChunkKind Kind;
-
+
union {
/// \brief The text string associated with a CK_Text, CK_Placeholder,
/// CK_Informative, or CK_Comma chunk.
- /// The string is owned by the chunk and will be deallocated
+ /// The string is owned by the chunk and will be deallocated
/// (with delete[]) when the chunk is destroyed.
const char *Text;
-
+
/// \brief The code completion string associated with a CK_Optional chunk.
/// The optional code completion string is owned by the chunk, and will
/// be deallocated (with delete) when the chunk is destroyed.
CodeCompletionString *Optional;
};
-
+
Chunk() : Kind(CK_Text), Text(0) { }
-
+
Chunk(ChunkKind Kind, const char *Text = "");
-
+
/// \brief Create a new text chunk.
static Chunk CreateText(const char *Text);
@@ -425,49 +425,49 @@ public:
/// \brief Create a new current-parameter chunk.
static Chunk CreateCurrentParameter(const char *CurrentParameter);
};
-
+
private:
/// \brief The number of chunks stored in this string.
unsigned NumChunks : 16;
-
+
/// \brief The number of annotations for this code-completion result.
unsigned NumAnnotations : 16;
/// \brief The priority of this code-completion string.
unsigned Priority : 30;
-
+
/// \brief The availability of this code-completion result.
unsigned Availability : 2;
CodeCompletionString(const CodeCompletionString &); // DO NOT IMPLEMENT
CodeCompletionString &operator=(const CodeCompletionString &); // DITTO
-
+
CodeCompletionString(const Chunk *Chunks, unsigned NumChunks,
unsigned Priority, CXAvailabilityKind Availability,
const char **Annotations, unsigned NumAnnotations);
~CodeCompletionString() { }
-
+
friend class CodeCompletionBuilder;
friend class CodeCompletionResult;
-
+
public:
typedef const Chunk *iterator;
iterator begin() const { return reinterpret_cast<const Chunk *>(this + 1); }
iterator end() const { return begin() + NumChunks; }
bool empty() const { return NumChunks == 0; }
unsigned size() const { return NumChunks; }
-
+
const Chunk &operator[](unsigned I) const {
assert(I < size() && "Chunk index out-of-range");
return begin()[I];
}
-
+
/// \brief Returns the text in the TypedText chunk.
const char *getTypedText() const;
/// \brief Retrieve the priority of this code completion result.
unsigned getPriority() const { return Priority; }
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the availability of this code completion result.
unsigned getAvailability() const { return Availability; }
@@ -476,26 +476,26 @@ public:
/// \brief Retrieve the annotation string specified by \c AnnotationNr.
const char *getAnnotation(unsigned AnnotationNr) const;
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve a string representation of the code completion string,
/// which is mainly useful for debugging.
- std::string getAsString() const;
+ std::string getAsString() const;
};
/// \brief An allocator used specifically for the purpose of code completion.
-class CodeCompletionAllocator : public llvm::BumpPtrAllocator {
+class CodeCompletionAllocator : public llvm::BumpPtrAllocator {
public:
/// \brief Copy the given string into this allocator.
const char *CopyString(StringRef String);
/// \brief Copy the given string into this allocator.
const char *CopyString(Twine String);
-
+
// \brief Copy the given string into this allocator.
const char *CopyString(const char *String) {
return CopyString(StringRef(String));
}
-
+
/// \brief Copy the given string into this allocator.
const char *CopyString(const std::string &String) {
return CopyString(StringRef(String));
@@ -514,78 +514,78 @@ namespace clang {
/// \brief A builder class used to construct new code-completion strings.
class CodeCompletionBuilder {
-public:
+public:
typedef CodeCompletionString::Chunk Chunk;
-
+
private:
CodeCompletionAllocator &Allocator;
unsigned Priority;
CXAvailabilityKind Availability;
-
+
/// \brief The chunks stored in this string.
SmallVector<Chunk, 4> Chunks;
SmallVector<const char *, 2> Annotations;
-
+
public:
- CodeCompletionBuilder(CodeCompletionAllocator &Allocator)
+ CodeCompletionBuilder(CodeCompletionAllocator &Allocator)
: Allocator(Allocator), Priority(0), Availability(CXAvailability_Available){
}
-
+
CodeCompletionBuilder(CodeCompletionAllocator &Allocator,
- unsigned Priority, CXAvailabilityKind Availability)
+ unsigned Priority, CXAvailabilityKind Availability)
: Allocator(Allocator), Priority(Priority), Availability(Availability) { }
/// \brief Retrieve the allocator into which the code completion
/// strings should be allocated.
CodeCompletionAllocator &getAllocator() const { return Allocator; }
-
- /// \brief Take the resulting completion string.
+
+ /// \brief Take the resulting completion string.
///
/// This operation can only be performed once.
CodeCompletionString *TakeString();
-
+
/// \brief Add a new typed-text chunk.
- void AddTypedTextChunk(const char *Text) {
+ void AddTypedTextChunk(const char *Text) {
Chunks.push_back(Chunk(CodeCompletionString::CK_TypedText, Text));
}
-
+
/// \brief Add a new text chunk.
- void AddTextChunk(const char *Text) {
- Chunks.push_back(Chunk::CreateText(Text));
+ void AddTextChunk(const char *Text) {
+ Chunks.push_back(Chunk::CreateText(Text));
}
/// \brief Add a new optional chunk.
void AddOptionalChunk(CodeCompletionString *Optional) {
Chunks.push_back(Chunk::CreateOptional(Optional));
}
-
+
/// \brief Add a new placeholder chunk.
void AddPlaceholderChunk(const char *Placeholder) {
Chunks.push_back(Chunk::CreatePlaceholder(Placeholder));
}
-
+
/// \brief Add a new informative chunk.
void AddInformativeChunk(const char *Text) {
Chunks.push_back(Chunk::CreateInformative(Text));
}
-
+
/// \brief Add a new result-type chunk.
void AddResultTypeChunk(const char *ResultType) {
Chunks.push_back(Chunk::CreateResultType(ResultType));
}
-
+
/// \brief Add a new current-parameter chunk.
void AddCurrentParameterChunk(const char *CurrentParameter) {
Chunks.push_back(Chunk::CreateCurrentParameter(CurrentParameter));
}
-
+
/// \brief Add a new chunk.
void AddChunk(Chunk C) { Chunks.push_back(C); }
void AddAnnotation(const char *A) { Annotations.push_back(A); }
};
-
+
/// \brief Captures a result of code completion.
class CodeCompletionResult {
public:
@@ -596,23 +596,23 @@ public:
RK_Macro, //< Refers to a macro
RK_Pattern //< Refers to a precomputed pattern.
};
-
+
/// \brief The kind of result stored here.
ResultKind Kind;
-
+
union {
/// \brief When Kind == RK_Declaration, the declaration we are referring
/// to.
NamedDecl *Declaration;
-
- /// \brief When Kind == RK_Keyword, the string representing the keyword
+
+ /// \brief When Kind == RK_Keyword, the string representing the keyword
/// or symbol's spelling.
const char *Keyword;
-
+
/// \brief When Kind == RK_Pattern, the code-completion string that
/// describes the completion text to insert.
CodeCompletionString *Pattern;
-
+
/// \brief When Kind == RK_Macro, the identifier that refers to a macro.
IdentifierInfo *Macro;
};
@@ -622,21 +622,21 @@ public:
/// \brief The cursor kind that describes this result.
CXCursorKind CursorKind;
-
+
/// \brief The availability of this result.
CXAvailabilityKind Availability;
-
+
/// \brief Specifies which parameter (of a function, Objective-C method,
/// macro, etc.) we should start with when formatting the result.
unsigned StartParameter;
-
+
/// \brief Whether this result is hidden by another name.
bool Hidden : 1;
-
+
/// \brief Whether this result was found via lookup into a base class.
bool QualifierIsInformative : 1;
-
- /// \brief Whether this declaration is the beginning of a
+
+ /// \brief Whether this declaration is the beginning of a
/// nested-name-specifier and, therefore, should be followed by '::'.
bool StartsNestedNameSpecifier : 1;
@@ -647,43 +647,43 @@ public:
/// \brief Whether we're completing a declaration of the given entity,
/// rather than a use of that entity.
bool DeclaringEntity : 1;
-
+
/// \brief If the result should have a nested-name-specifier, this is it.
- /// When \c QualifierIsInformative, the nested-name-specifier is
+ /// When \c QualifierIsInformative, the nested-name-specifier is
/// informative rather than required.
NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier;
-
+
/// \brief Build a result that refers to a declaration.
- CodeCompletionResult(NamedDecl *Declaration,
+ CodeCompletionResult(NamedDecl *Declaration,
NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0,
bool QualifierIsInformative = false,
bool Accessible = true)
- : Kind(RK_Declaration), Declaration(Declaration),
- Priority(getPriorityFromDecl(Declaration)),
- Availability(CXAvailability_Available), StartParameter(0),
+ : Kind(RK_Declaration), Declaration(Declaration),
+ Priority(getPriorityFromDecl(Declaration)),
+ Availability(CXAvailability_Available), StartParameter(0),
Hidden(false), QualifierIsInformative(QualifierIsInformative),
StartsNestedNameSpecifier(false), AllParametersAreInformative(false),
- DeclaringEntity(false), Qualifier(Qualifier) {
+ DeclaringEntity(false), Qualifier(Qualifier) {
computeCursorKindAndAvailability(Accessible);
}
-
+
/// \brief Build a result that refers to a keyword or symbol.
CodeCompletionResult(const char *Keyword, unsigned Priority = CCP_Keyword)
- : Kind(RK_Keyword), Keyword(Keyword), Priority(Priority),
- Availability(CXAvailability_Available),
- StartParameter(0), Hidden(false), QualifierIsInformative(0),
+ : Kind(RK_Keyword), Keyword(Keyword), Priority(Priority),
+ Availability(CXAvailability_Available),
+ StartParameter(0), Hidden(false), QualifierIsInformative(0),
StartsNestedNameSpecifier(false), AllParametersAreInformative(false),
DeclaringEntity(false), Qualifier(0) {
computeCursorKindAndAvailability();
}
-
+
/// \brief Build a result that refers to a macro.
CodeCompletionResult(IdentifierInfo *Macro, unsigned Priority = CCP_Macro)
- : Kind(RK_Macro), Macro(Macro), Priority(Priority),
- Availability(CXAvailability_Available), StartParameter(0),
- Hidden(false), QualifierIsInformative(0),
+ : Kind(RK_Macro), Macro(Macro), Priority(Priority),
+ Availability(CXAvailability_Available), StartParameter(0),
+ Hidden(false), QualifierIsInformative(0),
StartsNestedNameSpecifier(false), AllParametersAreInformative(false),
- DeclaringEntity(false), Qualifier(0) {
+ DeclaringEntity(false), Qualifier(0) {
computeCursorKindAndAvailability();
}
@@ -692,26 +692,26 @@ public:
unsigned Priority = CCP_CodePattern,
CXCursorKind CursorKind = CXCursor_NotImplemented,
CXAvailabilityKind Availability = CXAvailability_Available)
- : Kind(RK_Pattern), Pattern(Pattern), Priority(Priority),
- CursorKind(CursorKind), Availability(Availability), StartParameter(0),
- Hidden(false), QualifierIsInformative(0),
- StartsNestedNameSpecifier(false), AllParametersAreInformative(false),
- DeclaringEntity(false), Qualifier(0)
- {
+ : Kind(RK_Pattern), Pattern(Pattern), Priority(Priority),
+ CursorKind(CursorKind), Availability(Availability), StartParameter(0),
+ Hidden(false), QualifierIsInformative(0),
+ StartsNestedNameSpecifier(false), AllParametersAreInformative(false),
+ DeclaringEntity(false), Qualifier(0)
+ {
}
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the declaration stored in this result.
NamedDecl *getDeclaration() const {
assert(Kind == RK_Declaration && "Not a declaration result");
return Declaration;
}
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the keyword stored in this result.
const char *getKeyword() const {
assert(Kind == RK_Keyword && "Not a keyword result");
return Keyword;
}
-
+
/// \brief Create a new code-completion string that describes how to insert
/// this result into a program.
///
@@ -721,36 +721,36 @@ public:
/// string itself.
CodeCompletionString *CreateCodeCompletionString(Sema &S,
CodeCompletionAllocator &Allocator);
-
+
/// \brief Determine a base priority for the given declaration.
static unsigned getPriorityFromDecl(NamedDecl *ND);
-
+
private:
void computeCursorKindAndAvailability(bool Accessible = true);
};
-
+
bool operator<(const CodeCompletionResult &X, const CodeCompletionResult &Y);
-
-inline bool operator>(const CodeCompletionResult &X,
+
+inline bool operator>(const CodeCompletionResult &X,
const CodeCompletionResult &Y) {
return Y < X;
}
-
-inline bool operator<=(const CodeCompletionResult &X,
+
+inline bool operator<=(const CodeCompletionResult &X,
const CodeCompletionResult &Y) {
return !(Y < X);
}
-inline bool operator>=(const CodeCompletionResult &X,
+inline bool operator>=(const CodeCompletionResult &X,
const CodeCompletionResult &Y) {
return !(X < Y);
}
-
-raw_ostream &operator<<(raw_ostream &OS,
+
+raw_ostream &operator<<(raw_ostream &OS,
const CodeCompletionString &CCS);
-/// \brief Abstract interface for a consumer of code-completion
+/// \brief Abstract interface for a consumer of code-completion
/// information.
class CodeCompleteConsumer {
protected:
@@ -760,15 +760,15 @@ protected:
/// \brief Whether to include code patterns (such as for loops) within
/// the completion results.
bool IncludeCodePatterns;
-
+
/// \brief Whether to include global (top-level) declarations and names in
/// the completion results.
bool IncludeGlobals;
-
+
/// \brief Whether the output format for the code-completion consumer is
/// binary.
bool OutputIsBinary;
-
+
public:
class OverloadCandidate {
public:
@@ -782,25 +782,25 @@ public:
/// for which we only have a function prototype.
CK_FunctionType
};
-
+
private:
/// \brief The kind of overload candidate.
CandidateKind Kind;
-
+
union {
- /// \brief The function overload candidate, available when
+ /// \brief The function overload candidate, available when
/// Kind == CK_Function.
FunctionDecl *Function;
-
+
/// \brief The function template overload candidate, available when
/// Kind == CK_FunctionTemplate.
FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate;
-
+
/// \brief The function type that describes the entity being called,
/// when Kind == CK_FunctionType.
const FunctionType *Type;
};
-
+
public:
OverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function)
: Kind(CK_Function), Function(Function) { }
@@ -813,55 +813,55 @@ public:
/// \brief Determine the kind of overload candidate.
CandidateKind getKind() const { return Kind; }
-
- /// \brief Retrieve the function overload candidate or the templated
+
+ /// \brief Retrieve the function overload candidate or the templated
/// function declaration for a function template.
FunctionDecl *getFunction() const;
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the function template overload candidate.
FunctionTemplateDecl *getFunctionTemplate() const {
assert(getKind() == CK_FunctionTemplate && "Not a function template");
return FunctionTemplate;
}
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the function type of the entity, regardless of how the
/// function is stored.
const FunctionType *getFunctionType() const;
-
+
/// \brief Create a new code-completion string that describes the function
/// signature of this overload candidate.
- CodeCompletionString *CreateSignatureString(unsigned CurrentArg,
+ CodeCompletionString *CreateSignatureString(unsigned CurrentArg,
Sema &S,
CodeCompletionAllocator &Allocator) const;
};
-
+
CodeCompleteConsumer() : IncludeMacros(false), IncludeCodePatterns(false),
IncludeGlobals(true), OutputIsBinary(false) { }
-
+
CodeCompleteConsumer(bool IncludeMacros, bool IncludeCodePatterns,
bool IncludeGlobals, bool OutputIsBinary)
: IncludeMacros(IncludeMacros), IncludeCodePatterns(IncludeCodePatterns),
IncludeGlobals(IncludeGlobals), OutputIsBinary(OutputIsBinary) { }
-
+
/// \brief Whether the code-completion consumer wants to see macros.
bool includeMacros() const { return IncludeMacros; }
/// \brief Whether the code-completion consumer wants to see code patterns.
bool includeCodePatterns() const { return IncludeCodePatterns; }
-
+
/// \brief Whether to include global (top-level) declaration results.
bool includeGlobals() const { return IncludeGlobals; }
-
+
/// \brief Determine whether the output of this consumer is binary.
bool isOutputBinary() const { return OutputIsBinary; }
-
+
/// \brief Deregisters and destroys this code-completion consumer.
virtual ~CodeCompleteConsumer();
/// \name Code-completion callbacks
//@{
/// \brief Process the finalized code-completion results.
- virtual void ProcessCodeCompleteResults(Sema &S,
+ virtual void ProcessCodeCompleteResults(Sema &S,
CodeCompletionContext Context,
CodeCompletionResult *Results,
unsigned NumResults) { }
@@ -878,20 +878,20 @@ public:
OverloadCandidate *Candidates,
unsigned NumCandidates) { }
//@}
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the allocator that will be used to allocate
/// code completion strings.
virtual CodeCompletionAllocator &getAllocator() = 0;
};
-/// \brief A simple code-completion consumer that prints the results it
+/// \brief A simple code-completion consumer that prints the results it
/// receives in a simple format.
class PrintingCodeCompleteConsumer : public CodeCompleteConsumer {
/// \brief The raw output stream.
raw_ostream &OS;
-
+
CodeCompletionAllocator Allocator;
-
+
public:
/// \brief Create a new printing code-completion consumer that prints its
/// results to the given raw output stream.
@@ -900,20 +900,20 @@ public:
raw_ostream &OS)
: CodeCompleteConsumer(IncludeMacros, IncludeCodePatterns, IncludeGlobals,
false), OS(OS) {}
-
+
/// \brief Prints the finalized code-completion results.
- virtual void ProcessCodeCompleteResults(Sema &S,
+ virtual void ProcessCodeCompleteResults(Sema &S,
CodeCompletionContext Context,
CodeCompletionResult *Results,
unsigned NumResults);
-
+
virtual void ProcessOverloadCandidates(Sema &S, unsigned CurrentArg,
OverloadCandidate *Candidates,
- unsigned NumCandidates);
-
+ unsigned NumCandidates);
+
virtual CodeCompletionAllocator &getAllocator() { return Allocator; }
};
-
+
} // end namespace clang
#endif // LLVM_CLANG_SEMA_CODECOMPLETECONSUMER_H
diff --git a/include/clang/Sema/LocInfoType.h b/include/clang/Sema/LocInfoType.h
index e1d3ae9051..93cb8cbda4 100644
--- a/include/clang/Sema/LocInfoType.h
+++ b/include/clang/Sema/LocInfoType.h
@@ -36,16 +36,16 @@ class LocInfoType : public Type {
TypeSourceInfo *DeclInfo;
LocInfoType(QualType ty, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo)
- : Type((TypeClass)LocInfo, ty, ty->isDependentType(),
+ : Type((TypeClass)LocInfo, ty, ty->isDependentType(),
ty->isInstantiationDependentType(),
ty->isVariablyModifiedType(),
- ty->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()),
- DeclInfo(TInfo) {
- assert(getTypeClass() == (TypeClass)LocInfo && "LocInfo didn't fit in TC?");
- }
+ ty->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()),
+ DeclInfo(TInfo) {
+ assert(getTypeClass() == (TypeClass)LocInfo && "LocInfo didn't fit in TC?");
+ }
friend class Sema;
- public:
+public:
QualType getType() const { return getCanonicalTypeInternal(); }
TypeSourceInfo *getTypeSourceInfo() const { return DeclInfo; }
diff --git a/include/clang/Sema/PrettyDeclStackTrace.h b/include/clang/Sema/PrettyDeclStackTrace.h
index a31312cdc6..aa55705263 100644
--- a/include/clang/Sema/PrettyDeclStackTrace.h
+++ b/include/clang/Sema/PrettyDeclStackTrace.h
@@ -33,9 +33,10 @@ class PrettyDeclStackTraceEntry : public llvm::PrettyStackTraceEntry {
Decl *TheDecl;
SourceLocation Loc;
const char *Message;
-
+
public:
- PrettyDeclStackTraceEntry(Sema &S, Decl *D, SourceLocation Loc, const char *Msg)
+ PrettyDeclStackTraceEntry(Sema &S, Decl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
+ const char *Msg)
: S(S), TheDecl(D), Loc(Loc), Message(Msg) {}
virtual void print(raw_ostream &OS) const;
diff --git a/include/clang/Sema/Sema.h b/include/clang/Sema/Sema.h
index 9113f7ab2e..4c87dd6d3c 100644
--- a/include/clang/Sema/Sema.h
+++ b/include/clang/Sema/Sema.h
@@ -156,7 +156,7 @@ namespace clang {
class VisibilityAttr;
class VisibleDeclConsumer;
class IndirectFieldDecl;
-
+
namespace sema {
class AccessedEntity;
class BlockScopeInfo;
@@ -213,7 +213,7 @@ public:
/// PackContext - Manages the stack for #pragma pack. An alignment
/// of 0 indicates default alignment.
void *PackContext; // Really a "PragmaPackStack*"
-
+
bool MSStructPragmaOn; // True when #pragma ms_struct on
/// VisContext - Manages the stack for #pragma GCC visibility.
@@ -235,7 +235,7 @@ public:
/// the current full expression.
SmallVector<CXXTemporary*, 8> ExprTemporaries;
- typedef LazyVector<TypedefNameDecl *, ExternalSemaSource,
+ typedef LazyVector<TypedefNameDecl *, ExternalSemaSource,
&ExternalSemaSource::ReadExtVectorDecls, 2, 2>
ExtVectorDeclsType;
@@ -284,27 +284,27 @@ public:
/// we find this declaration of "foo" and complain that it is
/// not visible.
llvm::DenseMap<DeclarationName, NamedDecl *> LocallyScopedExternalDecls;
-
+
/// \brief Look for a locally scoped external declaration by the given name.
llvm::DenseMap<DeclarationName, NamedDecl *>::iterator
findLocallyScopedExternalDecl(DeclarationName Name);
-
- typedef LazyVector<VarDecl *, ExternalSemaSource,
+
+ typedef LazyVector<VarDecl *, ExternalSemaSource,
&ExternalSemaSource::ReadTentativeDefinitions, 2, 2>
TentativeDefinitionsType;
/// \brief All the tentative definitions encountered in the TU.
TentativeDefinitionsType TentativeDefinitions;
- typedef LazyVector<const DeclaratorDecl *, ExternalSemaSource,
+ typedef LazyVector<const DeclaratorDecl *, ExternalSemaSource,
&ExternalSemaSource::ReadUnusedFileScopedDecls, 2, 2>
UnusedFileScopedDeclsType;
-
+
/// \brief The set of file scoped decls seen so far that have not been used
/// and must warn if not used. Only contains the first declaration.
UnusedFileScopedDeclsType UnusedFileScopedDecls;
- typedef LazyVector<CXXConstructorDecl *, ExternalSemaSource,
+ typedef LazyVector<CXXConstructorDecl *, ExternalSemaSource,
&ExternalSemaSource::ReadDelegatingConstructors, 2, 2>
DelegatingCtorDeclsType;
@@ -322,11 +322,11 @@ public:
/// \brief Callback to the parser to parse templated functions when needed.
typedef void LateTemplateParserCB(void *P, const FunctionDecl *FD);
LateTemplateParserCB *LateTemplateParser;
- void *OpaqueParser;
+ void *OpaqueParser;
void SetLateTemplateParser(LateTemplateParserCB *LTP, void *P) {
LateTemplateParser = LTP;
- OpaqueParser = P;
+ OpaqueParser = P;
}
class DelayedDiagnostics;
@@ -418,7 +418,7 @@ public:
assert(ParsingDepth == 0);
ActiveStackBase = state.SavedActiveStackBase;
ParsingDepth = state.SavedParsingDepth;
- }
+ }
} DelayedDiagnostics;
/// A RAII object to temporarily push a declaration context.
@@ -427,11 +427,11 @@ public:
Sema &S;
DeclContext *SavedContext;
ProcessingContextState SavedContextState;
-
+
public:
ContextRAII(Sema &S, DeclContext *ContextToPush)
- : S(S), SavedContext(S.CurContext),
- SavedContextState(S.DelayedDiagnostics.pushContext())
+ : S(S), SavedContext(S.CurContext),
+ SavedContextState(S.DelayedDiagnostics.pushContext())
{
assert(ContextToPush && "pushing null context");
S.CurContext = ContextToPush;
@@ -456,7 +456,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Load weak undeclared identifiers from the external source.
void LoadExternalWeakUndeclaredIdentifiers();
-
+
/// WeakTopLevelDecl - Translation-unit scoped declarations generated by
/// #pragma weak during processing of other Decls.
/// I couldn't figure out a clean way to generate these in-line, so
@@ -480,7 +480,7 @@ public:
/// \brief The C++ "type_info" declaration, which is defined in <typeinfo>.
RecordDecl *CXXTypeInfoDecl;
-
+
/// \brief The MSVC "_GUID" struct, which is defined in MSVC header files.
RecordDecl *MSVCGuidDecl;
@@ -526,7 +526,7 @@ public:
/// \c typeid expression, whose argument is potentially evaluated only when
/// it is an lvalue of polymorphic class type (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2).
PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated,
-
+
/// \brief The current expression is potentially evaluated, but any
/// declarations referenced inside that expression are only used if
/// in fact the current expression is used.
@@ -648,16 +648,16 @@ public:
typedef llvm::DenseMap<ParmVarDecl *, SmallVector<ParmVarDecl *, 1> >
UnparsedDefaultArgInstantiationsMap;
-
+
/// \brief A mapping from parameters with unparsed default arguments to the
/// set of instantiations of each parameter.
///
/// This mapping is a temporary data structure used when parsing
/// nested class templates or nested classes of class templates,
/// where we might end up instantiating an inner class before the
- /// default arguments of its methods have been parsed.
+ /// default arguments of its methods have been parsed.
UnparsedDefaultArgInstantiationsMap UnparsedDefaultArgInstantiations;
-
+
// Contains the locations of the beginning of unparsed default
// argument locations.
llvm::DenseMap<ParmVarDecl *,SourceLocation> UnparsedDefaultArgLocs;
@@ -675,7 +675,7 @@ public:
/// of selectors are "overloaded").
GlobalMethodPool MethodPool;
- /// Method selectors used in a @selector expression. Used for implementation
+ /// Method selectors used in a @selector expression. Used for implementation
/// of -Wselector.
llvm::DenseMap<Selector, SourceLocation> ReferencedSelectors;
@@ -688,11 +688,11 @@ public:
TranslationUnitKind TUKind = TU_Complete,
CodeCompleteConsumer *CompletionConsumer = 0);
~Sema();
-
+
/// \brief Perform initialization that occurs after the parser has been
/// initialized but before it parses anything.
void Initialize();
-
+
const LangOptions &getLangOptions() const { return LangOpts; }
OpenCLOptions &getOpenCLOptions() { return OpenCLFeatures; }
FPOptions &getFPOptions() { return FPFeatures; }
@@ -787,7 +787,7 @@ public:
SourceLocation AttrLoc);
QualType BuildFunctionType(QualType T,
QualType *ParamTypes, unsigned NumParamTypes,
- bool Variadic, unsigned Quals,
+ bool Variadic, unsigned Quals,
RefQualifierKind RefQualifier,
SourceLocation Loc, DeclarationName Entity,
FunctionType::ExtInfo Info);
@@ -831,11 +831,11 @@ public:
const FunctionProtoType *Source, SourceLocation SourceLoc);
TypeResult ActOnTypeName(Scope *S, Declarator &D);
-
+
/// \brief The parser has parsed the context-sensitive type 'instancetype'
/// in an Objective-C message declaration. Return the appropriate type.
ParsedType ActOnObjCInstanceType(SourceLocation Loc);
-
+
bool RequireCompleteType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T,
const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
std::pair<SourceLocation, PartialDiagnostic> Note);
@@ -895,36 +895,36 @@ public:
NC_TypeTemplate,
NC_FunctionTemplate
};
-
+
class NameClassification {
NameClassificationKind Kind;
ExprResult Expr;
TemplateName Template;
ParsedType Type;
const IdentifierInfo *Keyword;
-
+
explicit NameClassification(NameClassificationKind Kind) : Kind(Kind) {}
-
+
public:
NameClassification(ExprResult Expr) : Kind(NC_Expression), Expr(Expr) {}
-
+
NameClassification(ParsedType Type) : Kind(NC_Type), Type(Type) {}
-
- NameClassification(const IdentifierInfo *Keyword)
+
+ NameClassification(const IdentifierInfo *Keyword)
: Kind(NC_Keyword), Keyword(Keyword) { }
-
- static NameClassification Error() {
- return NameClassification(NC_Error);
+
+ static NameClassification Error() {
+ return NameClassification(NC_Error);
}
-
- static NameClassification Unknown() {
- return NameClassification(NC_Unknown);
+
+ static NameClassification Unknown() {
+ return NameClassification(NC_Unknown);
}
-
+
static NameClassification NestedNameSpecifier() {
return NameClassification(NC_NestedNameSpecifier);
}
-
+
static NameClassification TypeTemplate(TemplateName Name) {
NameClassification Result(NC_TypeTemplate);
Result.Template = Name;
@@ -936,19 +936,19 @@ public:
Result.Template = Name;
return Result;
}
-
+
NameClassificationKind getKind() const { return Kind; }
-
+
ParsedType getType() const {
assert(Kind == NC_Type);
return Type;
}
-
+
ExprResult getExpression() const {
assert(Kind == NC_Expression);
return Expr;
}
-
+
TemplateName getTemplateName() const {
assert(Kind == NC_TypeTemplate || Kind == NC_FunctionTemplate);
return Template;
@@ -959,7 +959,7 @@ public:
return Kind == NC_TypeTemplate? TNK_Type_template : TNK_Function_template;
}
};
-
+
/// \brief Perform name lookup on the given name, classifying it based on
/// the results of name lookup and the following token.
///
@@ -976,14 +976,14 @@ public:
///
/// \param NameLoc The location of the identifier.
///
- /// \param NextToken The token following the identifier. Used to help
+ /// \param NextToken The token following the identifier. Used to help
/// disambiguate the name.
NameClassification ClassifyName(Scope *S,
CXXScopeSpec &SS,
IdentifierInfo *&Name,
SourceLocation NameLoc,
const Token &NextToken);
-
+
Decl *ActOnDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D);
Decl *HandleDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D,
@@ -1029,7 +1029,8 @@ public:
/// \brief Produce notes explaining why an instantiation was not constexpr.
CCK_NoteNonConstexprInstantiation
};
- bool CheckConstexprFunctionDecl(const FunctionDecl *FD, CheckConstexprKind CCK);
+ bool CheckConstexprFunctionDecl(const FunctionDecl *FD,
+ CheckConstexprKind CCK);
bool CheckConstexprFunctionBody(const FunctionDecl *FD, Stmt *Body);
void DiagnoseHiddenVirtualMethods(CXXRecordDecl *DC, CXXMethodDecl *MD);
@@ -1113,13 +1114,13 @@ public:
DeclResult ActOnModuleImport(SourceLocation ImportLoc,
IdentifierInfo &ModuleName,
SourceLocation ModuleNameLoc);
-
+
/// \brief Diagnose that \p New is a module-private redeclaration of
/// \p Old.
void diagnoseModulePrivateRedeclaration(NamedDecl *New, NamedDecl *Old,
SourceLocation ModulePrivateKeyword
= SourceLocation());
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve a suitable printing policy.
PrintingPolicy getPrintingPolicy() const;
@@ -1132,14 +1133,14 @@ public:
Decl *ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(Scope *S, AccessSpecifier AS,
DeclSpec &DS,
MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParams);
-
+
StmtResult ActOnVlaStmt(const DeclSpec &DS);
Decl *BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion(Scope *S, DeclSpec &DS,
AccessSpecifier AS,
RecordDecl *Record);
- Decl *BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct(Scope *S, DeclSpec &DS,
+ Decl *BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct(Scope *S, DeclSpec &DS,
RecordDecl *Record);
bool isAcceptableTagRedeclaration(const TagDecl *Previous,
@@ -1208,7 +1209,7 @@ public:
bool CheckNontrivialField(FieldDecl *FD);
void DiagnoseNontrivial(const RecordType* Record, CXXSpecialMember mem);
CXXSpecialMember getSpecialMember(const CXXMethodDecl *MD);
- void ActOnLastBitfield(SourceLocation DeclStart,
+ void ActOnLastBitfield(SourceLocation DeclStart,
SmallVectorImpl<Decl *> &AllIvarDecls);
Decl *ActOnIvar(Scope *S, SourceLocation DeclStart,
Declarator &D, Expr *BitfieldWidth,
@@ -1309,7 +1310,7 @@ public:
///
/// \param Name The name of the externally-produced declaration.
void pushExternalDeclIntoScope(NamedDecl *D, DeclarationName Name);
-
+
/// isDeclInScope - If 'Ctx' is a function/method, isDeclInScope returns true
/// if 'D' is in Scope 'S', otherwise 'S' is ignored and isDeclInScope returns
/// true if 'D' belongs to the given declaration context.
@@ -1363,7 +1364,7 @@ public:
Ovl_NonFunction
};
OverloadKind CheckOverload(Scope *S,
- FunctionDecl *New,
+ FunctionDecl *New,
const LookupResult &OldDecls,
NamedDecl *&OldDecl,
bool IsForUsingDecl);
@@ -1396,9 +1397,9 @@ public:
QualType &ConvertedType);
bool IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
QualType& ConvertedType);
- bool FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType,
+ bool FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType,
const FunctionProtoType *NewType);
-
+
CastKind PrepareCastToObjCObjectPointer(ExprResult &E);
bool CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
CastKind &Kind,
@@ -1438,7 +1439,7 @@ public:
ExprResult PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From);
ExprResult PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From);
- ExprResult
+ ExprResult
ConvertToIntegralOrEnumerationType(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *FromE,
const PartialDiagnostic &NotIntDiag,
const PartialDiagnostic &IncompleteDiag,
@@ -1447,7 +1448,7 @@ public:
const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigDiag,
const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigNote,
const PartialDiagnostic &ConvDiag);
-
+
ExprResult PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *From,
NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
@@ -1541,11 +1542,11 @@ public:
// Emit as a 'note' the specific overload candidate
void NoteOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Fn);
-
+
// Emit as a series of 'note's all template and non-templates
// identified by the expression Expr
void NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr* E);
-
+
// [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return]
// NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType
// R (A) --> R(A)
@@ -1554,7 +1555,8 @@ public:
// R (S::*)(A) --> R (A)
QualType ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType);
- FunctionDecl *ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr, QualType TargetType,
+ FunctionDecl *ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr,
+ QualType TargetType,
bool Complain,
DeclAccessPair &Found);
@@ -1565,9 +1567,9 @@ public:
bool ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
ExprResult &SrcExpr,
bool DoFunctionPointerConverion = false,
- bool Complain = false,
- const SourceRange& OpRangeForComplaining = SourceRange(),
- QualType DestTypeForComplaining = QualType(),
+ bool Complain = false,
+ const SourceRange& OpRangeForComplaining = SourceRange(),
+ QualType DestTypeForComplaining = QualType(),
unsigned DiagIDForComplaining = 0);
@@ -1730,7 +1732,7 @@ private:
/// \brief Whether we have already loaded known namespaces from an extenal
/// source.
bool LoadedExternalKnownNamespaces;
-
+
public:
/// \brief Look up a name, looking for a single declaration. Return
/// null if the results were absent, ambiguous, or overloaded.
@@ -1782,7 +1784,7 @@ public:
void LookupVisibleDecls(DeclContext *Ctx, LookupNameKind Kind,
VisibleDeclConsumer &Consumer,
bool IncludeGlobalScope = true);
-
+
/// \brief The context in which typo-correction occurs.
///
/// The typo-correction context affects which keywords (if any) are
@@ -1860,7 +1862,7 @@ public:
void WarnConflictingTypedMethods(ObjCMethodDecl *Method,
ObjCMethodDecl *MethodDecl,
bool IsProtocolMethodDecl);
-
+
void CheckConflictingOverridingMethod(ObjCMethodDecl *Method,
ObjCMethodDecl *Overridden,
bool IsProtocolMethodDecl);
@@ -1876,7 +1878,7 @@ public:
typedef llvm::DenseSet<Selector, llvm::DenseMapInfo<Selector> > SelectorSet;
typedef llvm::DenseMap<Selector, ObjCMethodDecl*> ProtocolsMethodsMap;
-
+
/// CheckProtocolMethodDefs - This routine checks unimplemented
/// methods declared in protocol, and those referenced by it.
/// \param IDecl - Used for checking for methods which may have been
@@ -1906,18 +1908,18 @@ public:
ObjCContainerDecl *CDecl,
const SelectorSet &InsMap);
- /// DefaultSynthesizeProperties - This routine default synthesizes all
+ /// DefaultSynthesizeProperties - This routine default synthesizes all
/// properties which must be synthesized in class's @implementation.
void DefaultSynthesizeProperties (Scope *S, ObjCImplDecl* IMPDecl,
ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl);
void DefaultSynthesizeProperties(Scope *S, Decl *D);
-
+
/// CollectImmediateProperties - This routine collects all properties in
/// the class and its conforming protocols; but not those it its super class.
void CollectImmediateProperties(ObjCContainerDecl *CDecl,
llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo *, ObjCPropertyDecl*>& PropMap,
llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo *, ObjCPropertyDecl*>& SuperPropMap);
-
+
/// LookupPropertyDecl - Looks up a property in the current class and all
/// its protocols.
@@ -1990,7 +1992,7 @@ public:
/// CheckCategoryVsClassMethodMatches - Checks that methods implemented in
/// category matches with those implemented in its primary class and
- /// warns each time an exact match is found.
+ /// warns each time an exact match is found.
void CheckCategoryVsClassMethodMatches(ObjCCategoryImplDecl *CatIMP);
private:
@@ -2027,7 +2029,7 @@ public:
ObjCMethodDecl *LookupInstanceMethodInGlobalPool(Selector Sel, SourceRange R,
bool receiverIdOrClass=false,
bool warn=true) {
- return LookupMethodInGlobalPool(Sel, R, receiverIdOrClass,
+ return LookupMethodInGlobalPool(Sel, R, receiverIdOrClass,
warn, /*instance*/true);
}
@@ -2055,7 +2057,7 @@ public:
class FullExprArg {
public:
FullExprArg(Sema &actions) : E(0) { }
-
+
// FIXME: The const_cast here is ugly. RValue references would make this
// much nicer (or we could duplicate a bunch of the move semantics
// emulation code from Ownership.h).
@@ -2107,7 +2109,7 @@ public:
Stmt *SubStmt, Scope *CurScope);
StmtResult ActOnLabelStmt(SourceLocation IdentLoc, LabelDecl *TheDecl,
SourceLocation ColonLoc, Stmt *SubStmt);
-
+
StmtResult ActOnIfStmt(SourceLocation IfLoc,
FullExprArg CondVal, Decl *CondVar,
Stmt *ThenVal,
@@ -2161,7 +2163,7 @@ public:
const VarDecl *getCopyElisionCandidate(QualType ReturnType, Expr *E,
bool AllowFunctionParameters);
-
+
StmtResult ActOnReturnStmt(SourceLocation ReturnLoc, Expr *RetValExp);
StmtResult ActOnBlockReturnStmt(SourceLocation ReturnLoc, Expr *RetValExp);
@@ -2230,7 +2232,7 @@ public:
void DiagnoseReturnInConstructorExceptionHandler(CXXTryStmt *TryBlock);
bool ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(const DeclaratorDecl *D) const;
-
+
/// \brief If it's a file scoped decl that must warn if not used, keep track
/// of it.
void MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(const DeclaratorDecl *D);
@@ -2239,7 +2241,7 @@ public:
/// whose result is unused, warn.
void DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(const Stmt *S);
void DiagnoseUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *ND);
-
+
ParsingDeclState PushParsingDeclaration() {
return DelayedDiagnostics.pushParsingDecl();
}
@@ -2256,7 +2258,7 @@ public:
}
void EmitDeprecationWarning(NamedDecl *D, StringRef Message,
- SourceLocation Loc,
+ SourceLocation Loc,
const ObjCInterfaceDecl *UnknownObjCClass=0);
void HandleDelayedDeprecationCheck(sema::DelayedDiagnostic &DD, Decl *Ctx);
@@ -2310,7 +2312,7 @@ public:
// Primary Expressions.
SourceRange getExprRange(Expr *E) const;
-
+
ExprResult ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, UnqualifiedId &Id,
bool HasTrailingLParen, bool IsAddressOfOperand);
@@ -2558,7 +2560,7 @@ public:
/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
ExprResult ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc, SourceLocation LabLoc,
LabelDecl *TheDecl);
-
+
ExprResult ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
SourceLocation RPLoc); // "({..})"
@@ -2606,25 +2608,25 @@ public:
enum IfExistsResult {
/// \brief The symbol exists.
IER_Exists,
-
+
/// \brief The symbol does not exist.
IER_DoesNotExist,
-
+
/// \brief The name is a dependent name, so the results will differ
/// from one instantiation to the next.
IER_Dependent,
-
+
/// \brief An error occurred.
IER_Error
};
- IfExistsResult
- CheckMicrosoftIfExistsSymbol(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
+ IfExistsResult
+ CheckMicrosoftIfExistsSymbol(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
const DeclarationNameInfo &TargetNameInfo);
- IfExistsResult
+ IfExistsResult
CheckMicrosoftIfExistsSymbol(Scope *S, SourceLocation KeywordLoc,
- bool IsIfExists, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
+ bool IsIfExists, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
UnqualifiedId &Name);
StmtResult BuildMSDependentExistsStmt(SourceLocation KeywordLoc,
@@ -2632,11 +2634,11 @@ public:
NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc,
DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo,
Stmt *Nested);
- StmtResult ActOnMSDependentExistsStmt(SourceLocation KeywordLoc,
+ StmtResult ActOnMSDependentExistsStmt(SourceLocation KeywordLoc,
bool IsIfExists,
CXXScopeSpec &SS, UnqualifiedId &Name,
Stmt *Nested);
-
+
//===------------------------- "Block" Extension ------------------------===//
/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is
@@ -2657,12 +2659,12 @@ public:
Scope *CurScope);
//===---------------------------- OpenCL Features -----------------------===//
-
+
/// __builtin_astype(...)
ExprResult ActOnAsTypeExpr(Expr *E, ParsedType ParsedDestTy,
- SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
+ SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
SourceLocation RParenLoc);
-
+
//===---------------------------- C++ Features --------------------------===//
// Act on C++ namespaces
@@ -2784,7 +2786,7 @@ public:
/// constructed variable.
void FinalizeVarWithDestructor(VarDecl *VD, const RecordType *DeclInitType);
- /// \brief Helper class that collects exception specifications for
+ /// \brief Helper class that collects exception specifications for
/// implicitly-declared special member functions.
class ImplicitExceptionSpecification {
// Pointer to allow copying
@@ -2812,7 +2814,7 @@ public:
}
public:
- explicit ImplicitExceptionSpecification(ASTContext &Context)
+ explicit ImplicitExceptionSpecification(ASTContext &Context)
: Context(&Context), ComputedEST(EST_BasicNoexcept) {
if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x)
ComputedEST = EST_DynamicNone;
@@ -2901,13 +2903,13 @@ public:
/// \brief Declare the implicit default constructor for the given class.
///
- /// \param ClassDecl The class declaration into which the implicit
+ /// \param ClassDecl The class declaration into which the implicit
/// default constructor will be added.
///
/// \returns The implicitly-declared default constructor.
CXXConstructorDecl *DeclareImplicitDefaultConstructor(
CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl);
-
+
/// DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor - Checks for feasibility of
/// defining this constructor as the default constructor.
void DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(SourceLocation CurrentLocation,
@@ -2915,12 +2917,12 @@ public:
/// \brief Declare the implicit destructor for the given class.
///
- /// \param ClassDecl The class declaration into which the implicit
+ /// \param ClassDecl The class declaration into which the implicit
/// destructor will be added.
///
/// \returns The implicitly-declared destructor.
CXXDestructorDecl *DeclareImplicitDestructor(CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl);
-
+
/// DefineImplicitDestructor - Checks for feasibility of
/// defining this destructor as the default destructor.
void DefineImplicitDestructor(SourceLocation CurrentLocation,
@@ -2941,12 +2943,12 @@ public:
/// \brief Declare the implicit copy constructor for the given class.
///
- /// \param ClassDecl The class declaration into which the implicit
+ /// \param ClassDecl The class declaration into which the implicit
/// copy constructor will be added.
///
/// \returns The implicitly-declared copy constructor.
CXXConstructorDecl *DeclareImplicitCopyConstructor(CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl);
-
+
/// DefineImplicitCopyConstructor - Checks for feasibility of
/// defining this constructor as the copy constructor.
void DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(SourceLocation CurrentLocation,
@@ -2960,7 +2962,7 @@ public:
/// \returns The implicitly-declared move constructor, or NULL if it wasn't
/// declared.
CXXConstructorDecl *DeclareImplicitMoveConstructor(CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl);
-
+
/// DefineImplicitMoveConstructor - Checks for feasibility of
/// defining this constructor as the move constructor.
void DefineImplicitMoveConstructor(SourceLocation CurrentLocation,
@@ -2968,12 +2970,12 @@ public:
/// \brief Declare the implicit copy assignment operator for the given class.
///
- /// \param ClassDecl The class declaration into which the implicit
+ /// \param ClassDecl The class declaration into which the implicit
/// copy assignment operator will be added.
///
/// \returns The implicitly-declared copy assignment operator.
CXXMethodDecl *DeclareImplicitCopyAssignment(CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl);
-
+
/// \brief Defines an implicitly-declared copy assignment operator.
void DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(SourceLocation CurrentLocation,
CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl);
@@ -2986,7 +2988,7 @@ public:
/// \returns The implicitly-declared move assignment operator, or NULL if it
/// wasn't declared.
CXXMethodDecl *DeclareImplicitMoveAssignment(CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl);
-
+
/// \brief Defines an implicitly-declared move assignment operator.
void DefineImplicitMoveAssignment(SourceLocation CurrentLocation,
CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl);
@@ -2994,7 +2996,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Force the declaration of any implicitly-declared members of this
/// class.
void ForceDeclarationOfImplicitMembers(CXXRecordDecl *Class);
-
+
/// MaybeBindToTemporary - If the passed in expression has a record type with
/// a non-trivial destructor, this will return CXXBindTemporaryExpr. Otherwise
/// it simply returns the passed in expression.
@@ -3081,9 +3083,9 @@ public:
//// ActOnCXXThrow - Parse throw expressions.
ExprResult ActOnCXXThrow(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *expr);
- ExprResult BuildCXXThrow(SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *Ex,
+ ExprResult BuildCXXThrow(SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *Ex,
bool IsThrownVarInScope);
- ExprResult CheckCXXThrowOperand(SourceLocation ThrowLoc, Expr *E,
+ ExprResult CheckCXXThrowOperand(SourceLocation ThrowLoc, Expr *E,
bool IsThrownVarInScope);
/// ActOnCXXTypeConstructExpr - Parse construction of a specified type.
@@ -3271,7 +3273,7 @@ public:
/// \returns true if an error occurred, false otherwise.
bool ActOnCXXGlobalScopeSpecifier(Scope *S, SourceLocation CCLoc,
CXXScopeSpec &SS);
-
+
bool isAcceptableNestedNameSpecifier(NamedDecl *SD);
NamedDecl *FindFirstQualifierInScope(Scope *S, NestedNameSpecifier *NNS);
@@ -3300,7 +3302,7 @@ public:
///
/// \param CCLoc The location of the '::'.
///
- /// \param ObjectType The type of the object, if we're parsing
+ /// \param ObjectType The type of the object, if we're parsing
/// nested-name-specifier in a member access expression.
///
/// \param EnteringContext Whether we're entering the context nominated by
@@ -3327,7 +3329,7 @@ public:
ParsedType ObjectType,
bool EnteringContext);
- /// \brief The parser has parsed a nested-name-specifier
+ /// \brief The parser has parsed a nested-name-specifier
/// 'template[opt] template-name < template-args >::'.
///
/// \param S The scope in which this nested-name-specifier occurs.
@@ -3338,7 +3340,7 @@ public:
/// parameter (the nested-name-specifier before this type) and an
/// output parameter (containing the full nested-name-specifier,
/// including this new type).
- ///
+ ///
/// \param TemplateLoc the location of the 'template' keyword, if any.
/// \param TemplateName The template name.
/// \param TemplateNameLoc The location of the template name.
@@ -3346,15 +3348,15 @@ public:
/// \param TemplateArgs The template arguments.
/// \param RAngleLoc The location of the closing angle bracket ('>').
/// \param CCLoc The location of the '::'.
-
- /// \param EnteringContext Whether we're entering the context of the
+
+ /// \param EnteringContext Whether we're entering the context of the
/// nested-name-specifier.
///
///
/// \returns true if an error occurred, false otherwise.
bool ActOnCXXNestedNameSpecifier(Scope *S,
- SourceLocation TemplateLoc,
- CXXScopeSpec &SS,
+ SourceLocation TemplateLoc,
+ CXXScopeSpec &SS,
TemplateTy Template,
SourceLocation TemplateNameLoc,
SourceLocation LAngleLoc,
@@ -3364,29 +3366,29 @@ public:
bool EnteringContext);
/// \brief Given a C++ nested-name-specifier, produce an annotation value
- /// that the parser can use later to reconstruct the given
+ /// that the parser can use later to reconstruct the given
/// nested-name-specifier.
///
/// \param SS A nested-name-specifier.
///
- /// \returns A pointer containing all of the information in the
+ /// \returns A pointer containing all of the information in the
/// nested-name-specifier \p SS.
void *SaveNestedNameSpecifierAnnotation(CXXScopeSpec &SS);
-
- /// \brief Given an annotation pointer for a nested-name-specifier, restore
+
+ /// \brief Given an annotation pointer for a nested-name-specifier, restore
/// the nested-name-specifier structure.
///
- /// \param Annotation The annotation pointer, produced by
+ /// \param Annotation The annotation pointer, produced by
/// \c SaveNestedNameSpecifierAnnotation().
///
/// \param AnnotationRange The source range corresponding to the annotation.
///
/// \param SS The nested-name-specifier that will be updated with the contents
/// of the annotation pointer.
- void RestoreNestedNameSpecifierAnnotation(void *Annotation,
+ void RestoreNestedNameSpecifierAnnotation(void *Annotation,
SourceRange AnnotationRange,
CXXScopeSpec &SS);
-
+
bool ShouldEnterDeclaratorScope(Scope *S, const CXXScopeSpec &SS);
/// ActOnCXXEnterDeclaratorScope - Called when a C++ scope specifier (global
@@ -3528,9 +3530,9 @@ public:
bool SetCtorInitializers(CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor,
CXXCtorInitializer **Initializers,
unsigned NumInitializers, bool AnyErrors);
-
+
void SetIvarInitializers(ObjCImplementationDecl *ObjCImplementation);
-
+
/// MarkBaseAndMemberDestructorsReferenced - Given a record decl,
/// mark all the non-trivial destructors of its members and bases as
@@ -3555,8 +3557,8 @@ public:
/// \brief Load any externally-stored vtable uses.
void LoadExternalVTableUses();
-
- typedef LazyVector<CXXRecordDecl *, ExternalSemaSource,
+
+ typedef LazyVector<CXXRecordDecl *, ExternalSemaSource,
&ExternalSemaSource::ReadDynamicClasses, 2, 2>
DynamicClassesType;
@@ -3652,7 +3654,7 @@ public:
BaseResult ActOnBaseSpecifier(Decl *classdecl,
SourceRange SpecifierRange,
bool Virtual, AccessSpecifier Access,
- ParsedType basetype,
+ ParsedType basetype,
SourceLocation BaseLoc,
SourceLocation EllipsisLoc);
@@ -3702,7 +3704,7 @@ public:
/// C++0x [class.virtual]p3.
bool CheckIfOverriddenFunctionIsMarkedFinal(const CXXMethodDecl *New,
const CXXMethodDecl *Old);
-
+
//===--------------------------------------------------------------------===//
// C++ Access Control
@@ -3771,7 +3773,7 @@ public:
/// \brief When true, access checking violations are treated as SFINAE
/// failures rather than hard errors.
bool AccessCheckingSFINAE;
-
+
void ActOnStartSuppressingAccessChecks();
void ActOnStopSuppressingAccessChecks();
@@ -3804,7 +3806,7 @@ public:
//
void FilterAcceptableTemplateNames(LookupResult &R);
bool hasAnyAcceptableTemplateNames(LookupResult &R);
-
+
void LookupTemplateName(LookupResult &R, Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
QualType ObjectType, bool EnteringContext,
bool &MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
@@ -3891,7 +3893,7 @@ public:
IdentifierInfo *Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
AttributeList *Attr,
TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams,
- AccessSpecifier AS,
+ AccessSpecifier AS,
SourceLocation ModulePrivateLoc,
unsigned NumOuterTemplateParamLists,
TemplateParameterList **OuterTemplateParamLists);
@@ -3900,7 +3902,7 @@ public:
TemplateArgumentListInfo &Out);
void NoteAllFoundTemplates(TemplateName Name);
-
+
QualType CheckTemplateIdType(TemplateName Template,
SourceLocation TemplateLoc,
TemplateArgumentListInfo &TemplateArgs);
@@ -3915,18 +3917,18 @@ public:
/// \brief Parsed an elaborated-type-specifier that refers to a template-id,
/// such as \c class T::template apply<U>.
///
- /// \param TUK
+ /// \param TUK
TypeResult ActOnTagTemplateIdType(TagUseKind TUK,
TypeSpecifierType TagSpec,
SourceLocation TagLoc,
CXXScopeSpec &SS,
- TemplateTy TemplateD,
+ TemplateTy TemplateD,
SourceLocation TemplateLoc,
SourceLocation LAngleLoc,
ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsIn,
SourceLocation RAngleLoc);
-
+
ExprResult BuildTemplateIdExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
LookupResult &R,
bool RequiresADL,
@@ -4081,7 +4083,7 @@ public:
ExprResult CheckTemplateArgument(NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *Param,
QualType InstantiatedParamType, Expr *Arg,
TemplateArgument &Converted,
- CheckTemplateArgumentKind CTAK = CTAK_Specified);
+ CheckTemplateArgumentKind CTAK = CTAK_Specified);
bool CheckTemplateArgument(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Param,
const TemplateArgumentLoc &Arg);
@@ -4145,8 +4147,8 @@ public:
/// \param II the identifier we're retrieving (e.g., 'type' in the example).
/// \param IdLoc the location of the identifier.
TypeResult
- ActOnTypenameType(Scope *S, SourceLocation TypenameLoc,
- const CXXScopeSpec &SS, const IdentifierInfo &II,
+ ActOnTypenameType(Scope *S, SourceLocation TypenameLoc,
+ const CXXScopeSpec &SS, const IdentifierInfo &II,
SourceLocation IdLoc);
/// \brief Called when the parser has parsed a C++ typename
@@ -4163,9 +4165,9 @@ public:
/// \param TemplateArgs The template arguments.
/// \param RAngleLoc The location of the closing angle bracket ('>').
TypeResult
- ActOnTypenameType(Scope *S, SourceLocation TypenameLoc,
- const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
- SourceLocation TemplateLoc,
+ ActOnTypenameType(Scope *S, SourceLocation TypenameLoc,
+ const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
+ SourceLocation TemplateLoc,
TemplateTy Template,
SourceLocation TemplateNameLoc,
SourceLocation LAngleLoc,
@@ -4186,7 +4188,7 @@ public:
ExprResult RebuildExprInCurrentInstantiation(Expr *E);
bool RebuildTemplateParamsInCurrentInstantiation(
TemplateParameterList *Params);
-
+
std::string
getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(const TemplateParameterList *Params,
const TemplateArgumentList &Args);
@@ -4241,19 +4243,19 @@ public:
/// \brief An initializer.
UPPC_Initializer,
-
+
/// \brief A default argument.
UPPC_DefaultArgument,
-
+
/// \brief The type of a non-type template parameter.
UPPC_NonTypeTemplateParameterType,
/// \brief The type of an exception.
UPPC_ExceptionType,
-
+
/// \brief Partial specialization.
UPPC_PartialSpecialization,
-
+
/// \brief Microsoft __if_exists.
UPPC_IfExists,
@@ -4265,7 +4267,7 @@ public:
///
/// \param Loc The location at which we should emit the diagnostic.
///
- /// \param UPPC The context in which we are diagnosing unexpanded
+ /// \param UPPC The context in which we are diagnosing unexpanded
/// parameter packs.
///
/// \param Unexpanded the set of unexpanded parameter packs.
@@ -4320,7 +4322,7 @@ public:
///
/// \param Loc The location of the template name.
///
- /// \param Template The template name that is being checked for unexpanded
+ /// \param Template The template name that is being checked for unexpanded
/// parameter packs.
///
/// \returns true if an error occurred, false otherwise.
@@ -4328,18 +4330,18 @@ public:
TemplateName Template,
UnexpandedParameterPackContext UPPC);
- /// \brief If the given template argument contains an unexpanded parameter
+ /// \brief If the given template argument contains an unexpanded parameter
/// pack, diagnose the error.
///
- /// \param Arg The template argument that is being checked for unexpanded
+ /// \param Arg The template argument that is being checked for unexpanded
/// parameter packs.
///
/// \returns true if an error occurred, false otherwise.
bool DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(TemplateArgumentLoc Arg,
UnexpandedParameterPackContext UPPC);
-
+
/// \brief Collect the set of unexpanded parameter packs within the given
- /// template argument.
+ /// template argument.
///
/// \param Arg The template argument that will be traversed to find
/// unexpanded parameter packs.
@@ -4347,7 +4349,7 @@ public:
SmallVectorImpl<UnexpandedParameterPack> &Unexpanded);
/// \brief Collect the set of unexpanded parameter packs within the given
- /// template argument.
+ /// template argument.
///
/// \param Arg The template argument that will be traversed to find
/// unexpanded parameter packs.
@@ -4355,7 +4357,7 @@ public:
SmallVectorImpl<UnexpandedParameterPack> &Unexpanded);
/// \brief Collect the set of unexpanded parameter packs within the given
- /// type.
+ /// type.
///
/// \param T The type that will be traversed to find
/// unexpanded parameter packs.
@@ -4363,7 +4365,7 @@ public:
SmallVectorImpl<UnexpandedParameterPack> &Unexpanded);
/// \brief Collect the set of unexpanded parameter packs within the given
- /// type.
+ /// type.
///
/// \param TL The type that will be traversed to find
/// unexpanded parameter packs.
@@ -4371,7 +4373,7 @@ public:
SmallVectorImpl<UnexpandedParameterPack> &Unexpanded);
/// \brief Collect the set of unexpanded parameter packs within the given
- /// nested-name-specifier.
+ /// nested-name-specifier.
///
/// \param SS The nested-name-specifier that will be traversed to find
/// unexpanded parameter packs.
@@ -4379,7 +4381,7 @@ public:
SmallVectorImpl<UnexpandedParameterPack> &Unexpanded);
/// \brief Collect the set of unexpanded parameter packs within the given
- /// name.
+ /// name.
///
/// \param NameInfo The name that will be traversed to find
/// unexpanded parameter packs.
@@ -4447,7 +4449,7 @@ public:
/// \param PatternRange The source range that covers the entire pattern of
/// the pack expansion.
///
- /// \param Unexpanded The set of unexpanded parameter packs within the
+ /// \param Unexpanded The set of unexpanded parameter packs within the
/// pattern.
///
/// \param NumUnexpanded The number of unexpanded parameter packs in
@@ -4470,9 +4472,9 @@ public:
/// The callee must set this value when \c ShouldExpand is \c true; it may
/// set this value in other cases.
///
- /// \returns true if an error occurred (e.g., because the parameter packs
- /// are to be instantiated with arguments of different lengths), false
- /// otherwise. If false, \c ShouldExpand (and possibly \c NumExpansions)
+ /// \returns true if an error occurred (e.g., because the parameter packs
+ /// are to be instantiated with arguments of different lengths), false
+ /// otherwise. If false, \c ShouldExpand (and possibly \c NumExpansions)
/// must be set.
bool CheckParameterPacksForExpansion(SourceLocation EllipsisLoc,
SourceRange PatternRange,
@@ -4488,9 +4490,9 @@ public:
/// This routine already assumes that the pack expansion type can be
/// expanded and that the number of arguments in the expansion is
/// consistent across all of the unexpanded parameter packs in its pattern.
- unsigned getNumArgumentsInExpansion(QualType T,
+ unsigned getNumArgumentsInExpansion(QualType T,
const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs);
-
+
/// \brief Determine whether the given declarator contains any unexpanded
/// parameter packs.
///
@@ -4507,11 +4509,11 @@ public:
/// \returns true if the declarator contains any unexpanded parameter packs,
/// false otherwise.
bool containsUnexpandedParameterPacks(Declarator &D);
-
+
//===--------------------------------------------------------------------===//
// C++ Template Argument Deduction (C++ [temp.deduct])
//===--------------------------------------------------------------------===//
-
+
/// \brief Describes the result of template argument deduction.
///
/// The TemplateDeductionResult enumeration describes the result of
@@ -4573,20 +4575,20 @@ public:
QualType *FunctionType,
sema::TemplateDeductionInfo &Info);
- /// brief A function argument from which we performed template argument
+ /// brief A function argument from which we performed template argument
// deduction for a call.
struct OriginalCallArg {
OriginalCallArg(QualType OriginalParamType,
unsigned ArgIdx,
QualType OriginalArgType)
- : OriginalParamType(OriginalParamType), ArgIdx(ArgIdx),
+ : OriginalParamType(OriginalParamType), ArgIdx(ArgIdx),
OriginalArgType(OriginalArgType) { }
-
+
QualType OriginalParamType;
unsigned ArgIdx;
QualType OriginalArgType;
};
-
+
TemplateDeductionResult
FinishTemplateArgumentDeduction(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
SmallVectorImpl<DeducedTemplateArgument> &Deduced,
@@ -4705,8 +4707,8 @@ public:
/// \brief The point of instantiation within the source code.
SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation;
- /// \brief The template (or partial specialization) in which we are
- /// performing the instantiation, for substitutions of prior template
+ /// \brief The template (or partial specialization) in which we are
+ /// performing the instantiation, for substitutions of prior template
/// arguments.
NamedDecl *Template;
@@ -4720,7 +4722,7 @@ public:
/// \brief The number of template arguments in TemplateArgs.
unsigned NumTemplateArgs;
- /// \brief The template deduction info object associated with the
+ /// \brief The template deduction info object associated with the
/// substitution or checking of explicit or deduced template arguments.
sema::TemplateDeductionInfo *DeductionInfo;
@@ -4788,7 +4790,7 @@ public:
/// This is used when setting up a SFINAE trap (\c see SFINAETrap) outside
/// of a template instantiation or template argument deduction.
bool InNonInstantiationSFINAEContext;
-
+
/// \brief The number of ActiveTemplateInstantiation entries in
/// \c ActiveTemplateInstantiations that are not actual instantiations and,
/// therefore, should not be counted as part of the instantiation depth.
@@ -4806,7 +4808,7 @@ public:
/// \brief The current index into pack expansion arguments that will be
/// used for substitution of parameter packs.
///
- /// The pack expansion index will be -1 to indicate that parameter packs
+ /// The pack expansion index will be -1 to indicate that parameter packs
/// should be instantiated as themselves. Otherwise, the index specifies
/// which argument within the parameter pack will be used for substitution.
int ArgumentPackSubstitutionIndex;
@@ -4818,26 +4820,26 @@ public:
class ArgumentPackSubstitutionIndexRAII {
Sema &Self;
int OldSubstitutionIndex;
-
+
public:
ArgumentPackSubstitutionIndexRAII(Sema &Self, int NewSubstitutionIndex)
: Self(Self), OldSubstitutionIndex(Self.ArgumentPackSubstitutionIndex) {
Self.ArgumentPackSubstitutionIndex = NewSubstitutionIndex;
}
-
+
~ArgumentPackSubstitutionIndexRAII() {
Self.ArgumentPackSubstitutionIndex = OldSubstitutionIndex;
}
};
-
+
friend class ArgumentPackSubstitutionRAII;
-
+
/// \brief The stack of calls expression undergoing template instantiation.
///
/// The top of this stack is used by a fixit instantiating unresolved
/// function calls to fix the AST to match the textual change it prints.
SmallVector<CallExpr *, 8> CallsUndergoingInstantiation;
-
+
/// \brief For each declaration that involved template argument deduction, the
/// set of diagnostics that were suppressed during that template argument
/// deduction.
@@ -4845,7 +4847,7 @@ public:
/// FIXME: Serialize this structure to the AST file.
llvm::DenseMap<Decl *, SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 1> >
SuppressedDiagnostics;
-
+
/// \brief A stack object to be created when performing template
/// instantiation.
///
@@ -4947,15 +4949,15 @@ public:
};
void PrintInstantiationStack();
-
+
/// \brief Determines whether we are currently in a context where
/// template argument substitution failures are not considered
/// errors.
///
/// \returns An empty \c llvm::Optional if we're not in a SFINAE context.
- /// Otherwise, contains a pointer that, if non-NULL, contains the nearest
- /// template-deduction context object, which can be used to capture
- /// diagnostics that will be suppressed.
+ /// Otherwise, contains a pointer that, if non-NULL, contains the nearest
+ /// template-deduction context object, which can be used to capture
+ /// diagnostics that will be suppressed.
llvm::Optional<sema::TemplateDeductionInfo *> isSFINAEContext() const;
/// \brief RAII class used to determine whether SFINAE has
@@ -4966,22 +4968,22 @@ public:
unsigned PrevSFINAEErrors;
bool PrevInNonInstantiationSFINAEContext;
bool PrevAccessCheckingSFINAE;
-
+
public:
explicit SFINAETrap(Sema &SemaRef, bool AccessCheckingSFINAE = false)
: SemaRef(SemaRef), PrevSFINAEErrors(SemaRef.NumSFINAEErrors),
PrevInNonInstantiationSFINAEContext(
SemaRef.InNonInstantiationSFINAEContext),
PrevAccessCheckingSFINAE(SemaRef.AccessCheckingSFINAE)
- {
+ {
if (!SemaRef.isSFINAEContext())
SemaRef.InNonInstantiationSFINAEContext = true;
SemaRef.AccessCheckingSFINAE = AccessCheckingSFINAE;
}
- ~SFINAETrap() {
- SemaRef.NumSFINAEErrors = PrevSFINAEErrors;
- SemaRef.InNonInstantiationSFINAEContext
+ ~SFINAETrap() {
+ SemaRef.NumSFINAEErrors = PrevSFINAEErrors;
+ SemaRef.InNonInstantiationSFINAEContext
= PrevInNonInstantiationSFINAEContext;
SemaRef.AccessCheckingSFINAE = PrevAccessCheckingSFINAE;
}
@@ -5001,7 +5003,7 @@ public:
typedef llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo *, TypoCorrection>
UnqualifiedTyposCorrectedMap;
-
+
/// \brief A cache containing the results of typo correction for unqualified
/// name lookup.
///
@@ -5009,7 +5011,7 @@ public:
/// there was no correction), while the boolean will be true when the
/// string represents a keyword.
UnqualifiedTyposCorrectedMap UnqualifiedTyposCorrected;
-
+
/// \brief Worker object for performing CFG-based warnings.
sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings AnalysisWarnings;
@@ -5058,14 +5060,14 @@ public:
const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs,
int indexAdjustment,
llvm::Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions);
- bool SubstParmTypes(SourceLocation Loc,
+ bool SubstParmTypes(SourceLocation Loc,
ParmVarDecl **Params, unsigned NumParams,
const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs,
SmallVectorImpl<QualType> &ParamTypes,
SmallVectorImpl<ParmVarDecl *> *OutParams = 0);
ExprResult SubstExpr(Expr *E,
const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs);
-
+
/// \brief Substitute the given template arguments into a list of
/// expressions, expanding pack expansions if required.
///
@@ -5130,7 +5132,7 @@ public:
SubstDeclarationNameInfo(const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs);
TemplateName
- SubstTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc, TemplateName Name,
+ SubstTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc, TemplateName Name,
SourceLocation Loc,
const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs);
bool Subst(const TemplateArgumentLoc *Args, unsigned NumArgs,
@@ -5239,7 +5241,7 @@ public:
/// setters and getters as needed.
/// \param property The property declaration being processed
/// \param DC The semantic container for the property
- /// \param redeclaredProperty Declaration for property if redeclared
+ /// \param redeclaredProperty Declaration for property if redeclared
/// in class extension.
/// \param lexicalDC Container for redeclaredProperty.
void ProcessPropertyDecl(ObjCPropertyDecl *property,
@@ -5334,7 +5336,7 @@ public:
bool IsInstance);
bool inferObjCARCLifetime(ValueDecl *decl);
-
+
ExprResult
HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT,
Expr *BaseExpr,
@@ -5363,7 +5365,7 @@ public:
/// name.
ObjCClassMessage
};
-
+
ObjCMessageKind getObjCMessageKind(Scope *S,
IdentifierInfo *Name,
SourceLocation NameLoc,
@@ -5419,7 +5421,7 @@ public:
SourceLocation BridgeKeywordLoc,
TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo,
Expr *SubExpr);
-
+
ExprResult ActOnObjCBridgedCast(Scope *S,
SourceLocation LParenLoc,
ObjCBridgeCastKind Kind,
@@ -5427,19 +5429,19 @@ public:
ParsedType Type,
SourceLocation RParenLoc,
Expr *SubExpr);
-
+
bool checkInitMethod(ObjCMethodDecl *method, QualType receiverTypeIfCall);
-
+
/// \brief Check whether the given new method is a valid override of the
/// given overridden method, and set any properties that should be inherited.
- void CheckObjCMethodOverride(ObjCMethodDecl *NewMethod,
+ void CheckObjCMethodOverride(ObjCMethodDecl *NewMethod,
const ObjCMethodDecl *Overridden,
bool IsImplementation);
/// \brief Check whether the given method overrides any methods in its class,
/// calling \c CheckObjCMethodOverride for each overridden method.
bool CheckObjCMethodOverrides(ObjCMethodDecl *NewMethod, DeclContext *DC);
-
+
enum PragmaOptionsAlignKind {
POAK_Native, // #pragma options align=native
POAK_Natural, // #pragma options align=natural
@@ -5473,7 +5475,7 @@ public:
SourceLocation PragmaLoc,
SourceLocation LParenLoc,
SourceLocation RParenLoc);
-
+
/// ActOnPragmaMSStruct - Called on well formed #pragms ms_struct [on|off].
void ActOnPragmaMSStruct(PragmaMSStructKind Kind);
@@ -5558,7 +5560,7 @@ public:
ExprResult ImpCastExprToType(Expr *E, QualType Type, CastKind CK,
ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue,
const CXXCastPath *BasePath = 0,
- CheckedConversionKind CCK
+ CheckedConversionKind CCK
= CCK_ImplicitConversion);
/// ScalarTypeToBooleanCastKind - Returns the cast kind corresponding
@@ -5652,9 +5654,9 @@ public:
IncompatiblePointer,
/// IncompatiblePointer - The assignment is between two pointers types which
- /// point to integers which have a different sign, but are otherwise identical.
- /// This is a subset of the above, but broken out because it's by far the most
- /// common case of incompatible pointers.
+ /// point to integers which have a different sign, but are otherwise
+ /// identical. This is a subset of the above, but broken out because it's by
+ /// far the most common case of incompatible pointers.
IncompatiblePointerSign,
/// CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers - The assignment discards
@@ -5797,7 +5799,7 @@ public:
BinaryOperatorKind Opcode,
Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS);
ExprResult checkPseudoObjectRValue(Expr *E);
-
+
QualType CheckConditionalOperands( // C99 6.5.15
ExprResult &Cond, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
ExprValueKind &VK, ExprObjectKind &OK, SourceLocation QuestionLoc);
@@ -5806,10 +5808,12 @@ public:
ExprValueKind &VK, ExprObjectKind &OK, SourceLocation questionLoc);
QualType FindCompositePointerType(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&E1, Expr *&E2,
bool *NonStandardCompositeType = 0);
- QualType FindCompositePointerType(SourceLocation Loc, ExprResult &E1, ExprResult &E2,
+ QualType FindCompositePointerType(SourceLocation Loc,
+ ExprResult &E1, ExprResult &E2,
bool *NonStandardCompositeType = 0) {
Expr *E1Tmp = E1.take(), *E2Tmp = E2.take();
- QualType Composite = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, E1Tmp, E2Tmp, NonStandardCompositeType);
+ QualType Composite = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, E1Tmp, E2Tmp,
+ NonStandardCompositeType);
E1 = Owned(E1Tmp);
E2 = Owned(E2Tmp);
return Composite;
@@ -5893,7 +5897,7 @@ public:
Expr *stripARCUnbridgedCast(Expr *e);
void diagnoseARCUnbridgedCast(Expr *e);
-
+
bool CheckObjCARCUnavailableWeakConversion(QualType castType,
QualType ExprType);
@@ -5931,7 +5935,7 @@ public:
/// \brief If the given expression involves a message send to a method
/// with a related result type, emit a note describing what happened.
void EmitRelatedResultTypeNote(const Expr *E);
-
+
/// CheckBooleanCondition - Diagnose problems involving the use of
/// the given expression as a boolean condition (e.g. in an if
/// statement). Also performs the standard function and array
@@ -5944,7 +5948,7 @@ public:
ExprResult ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
Expr *SubExpr);
-
+
/// DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition - Given that an expression is
/// being used as a boolean condition, warn if it's an assignment.
void DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E);
@@ -6032,7 +6036,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Code completion occurs within the condition of an if,
/// while, switch, or for statement.
PCC_Condition,
- /// \brief Code completion occurs within the body of a function on a
+ /// \brief Code completion occurs within the body of a function on a
/// recovery path, where we do not have a specific handle on our position
/// in the grammar.
PCC_RecoveryInFunction,
@@ -6041,7 +6045,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Code completion occurs in a parenthesized expression, which
/// might also be a type cast.
PCC_ParenthesizedExpression,
- /// \brief Code completion occurs within a sequence of declaration
+ /// \brief Code completion occurs within a sequence of declaration
/// specifiers within a function, method, or block.
PCC_LocalDeclarationSpecifiers
};
@@ -6051,9 +6055,9 @@ public:
void CodeCompleteDeclSpec(Scope *S, DeclSpec &DS,
bool AllowNonIdentifiers,
bool AllowNestedNameSpecifiers);
-
+
struct CodeCompleteExpressionData;
- void CodeCompleteExpression(Scope *S,
+ void CodeCompleteExpression(Scope *S,
const CodeCompleteExpressionData &Data);
void CodeCompleteMemberReferenceExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base,
SourceLocation OpLoc,
@@ -6067,7 +6071,7 @@ public:
void CodeCompleteReturn(Scope *S);
void CodeCompleteAfterIf(Scope *S);
void CodeCompleteAssignmentRHS(Scope *S, Expr *LHS);
-
+
void CodeCompleteQualifiedId(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
bool EnteringContext);
void CodeCompleteUsing(Scope *S);
@@ -6078,7 +6082,7 @@ public:
void CodeCompleteConstructorInitializer(Decl *Constructor,
CXXCtorInitializer** Initializers,
unsigned NumInitializers);
-
+
void CodeCompleteObjCAtDirective(Scope *S);
void CodeCompleteObjCAtVisibility(Scope *S);
void CodeCompleteObjCAtStatement(Scope *S);
@@ -6086,7 +6090,7 @@ public:
void CodeCompleteObjCPropertyFlags(Scope *S, ObjCDeclSpec &ODS);
void CodeCompleteObjCPropertyGetter(Scope *S);
void CodeCompleteObjCPropertySetter(Scope *S);
- void CodeCompleteObjCPassingType(Scope *S, ObjCDeclSpec &DS,
+ void CodeCompleteObjCPassingType(Scope *S, ObjCDeclSpec &DS,
bool IsParameter);
void CodeCompleteObjCMessageReceiver(Scope *S);
void CodeCompleteObjCSuperMessage(Scope *S, SourceLocation SuperLoc,
@@ -6103,7 +6107,7 @@ public:
unsigned NumSelIdents,
bool AtArgumentExpression,
ObjCInterfaceDecl *Super = 0);
- void CodeCompleteObjCForCollection(Scope *S,
+ void CodeCompleteObjCForCollection(Scope *S,
DeclGroupPtrTy IterationVar);
void CodeCompleteObjCSelector(Scope *S,
IdentifierInfo **SelIdents,
@@ -6128,7 +6132,7 @@ public:
void CodeCompleteObjCMethodDecl(Scope *S,
bool IsInstanceMethod,
ParsedType ReturnType);
- void CodeCompleteObjCMethodDeclSelector(Scope *S,
+ void CodeCompleteObjCMethodDeclSelector(Scope *S,
bool IsInstanceMethod,
bool AtParameterName,
ParsedType ReturnType,
@@ -6154,7 +6158,7 @@ public:
SourceLocation getLocationOfStringLiteralByte(const StringLiteral *SL,
unsigned ByteNo) const;
-private:
+private:
void CheckArrayAccess(const Expr *BaseExpr, const Expr *IndexExpr,
bool isSubscript=false, bool AllowOnePastEnd=true);
void CheckArrayAccess(const Expr *E);
@@ -6216,7 +6220,7 @@ private:
CMF_Strncat,
CMF_Strndup
};
-
+
void CheckMemaccessArguments(const CallExpr *Call, CheckedMemoryFunction CMF,
IdentifierInfo *FnName);
@@ -6235,13 +6239,13 @@ private:
///
/// The parser maintains this state here.
Scope *CurScope;
-
+
protected:
friend class Parser;
- friend class InitializationSequence;
+ friend class InitializationSequence;
friend class ASTReader;
friend class ASTWriter;
-
+
public:
/// \brief Retrieve the parser's current scope.
///
@@ -6252,7 +6256,7 @@ public:
/// itself and in routines directly invoked from the parser and *never* from
/// template substitution or instantiation.
Scope *getCurScope() const { return CurScope; }
-
+
Decl *getObjCDeclContext() const;
DeclContext *getCurLexicalContext() const {
diff --git a/include/clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h b/include/clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h
index 690129ab34..100d56ed33 100644
--- a/include/clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h
+++ b/include/clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h
@@ -23,7 +23,7 @@ class ASTContext;
class TemplateArgumentList;
namespace sema {
-
+
/// \brief Provides information about an attempted template argument
/// deduction, whose success or failure was described by a
/// TemplateDeductionResult value.
@@ -39,10 +39,10 @@ class TemplateDeductionInfo {
/// deduction is occurring.
SourceLocation Loc;
- /// \brief Warnings (and follow-on notes) that were suppressed due to
+ /// \brief Warnings (and follow-on notes) that were suppressed due to
/// SFINAE while performing template argument deduction.
SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 4> SuppressedDiagnostics;
-
+
// do not implement these
TemplateDeductionInfo(const TemplateDeductionInfo&);
TemplateDeductionInfo &operator=(const TemplateDeductionInfo&);
@@ -75,23 +75,24 @@ public:
Deduced = NewDeduced;
}
- /// \brief Add a new diagnostic to the set of diagnostics
- void addSuppressedDiagnostic(SourceLocation Loc, const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
+ /// \brief Add a new diagnostic to the set of diagnostics
+ void addSuppressedDiagnostic(SourceLocation Loc,
+ const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
SuppressedDiagnostics.push_back(std::make_pair(Loc, PD));
}
-
+
/// \brief Iterator over the set of suppressed diagnostics.
- typedef SmallVectorImpl<PartialDiagnosticAt>::const_iterator
+ typedef SmallVectorImpl<PartialDiagnosticAt>::const_iterator
diag_iterator;
-
+
/// \brief Returns an iterator at the beginning of the sequence of suppressed
/// diagnostics.
diag_iterator diag_begin() const { return SuppressedDiagnostics.begin(); }
-
+
/// \brief Returns an iterator at the end of the sequence of suppressed
/// diagnostics.
diag_iterator diag_end() const { return SuppressedDiagnostics.end(); }
-
+
/// \brief The template parameter to which a template argument
/// deduction failure refers.
///
diff --git a/include/clang/Serialization/ASTReader.h b/include/clang/Serialization/ASTReader.h
index d10f9ba18f..bef02f0d95 100644
--- a/include/clang/Serialization/ASTReader.h
+++ b/include/clang/Serialization/ASTReader.h
@@ -162,16 +162,16 @@ private:
void Error(const char *Msg);
};
-namespace serialization {
+namespace serialization {
class ReadMethodPoolVisitor;
-
+
namespace reader {
class ASTIdentifierLookupTrait;
}
-
+
} // end namespace serialization
-
+
/// \brief Reads an AST files chain containing the contents of a translation
/// unit.
///
@@ -191,7 +191,7 @@ class ASTReader
public ExternalSemaSource,
public IdentifierInfoLookup,
public ExternalIdentifierLookup,
- public ExternalSLocEntrySource
+ public ExternalSLocEntrySource
{
public:
enum ASTReadResult { Success, Failure, IgnorePCH };
@@ -205,11 +205,11 @@ public:
friend class ASTWriter;
friend class ASTUnit; // ASTUnit needs to remap source locations.
friend class serialization::ReadMethodPoolVisitor;
-
+
typedef serialization::Module Module;
typedef serialization::ModuleKind ModuleKind;
typedef serialization::ModuleManager ModuleManager;
-
+
typedef ModuleManager::ModuleIterator ModuleIterator;
typedef ModuleManager::ModuleConstIterator ModuleConstIterator;
typedef ModuleManager::ModuleReverseIterator ModuleReverseIterator;
@@ -224,7 +224,7 @@ private:
SourceManager &SourceMgr;
FileManager &FileMgr;
DiagnosticsEngine &Diags;
-
+
/// \brief The semantic analysis object that will be processing the
/// AST files and the translation unit that uses it.
Sema *SemaObj;
@@ -234,7 +234,7 @@ private:
/// \brief The AST context into which we'll read the AST files.
ASTContext &Context;
-
+
/// \brief The AST consumer.
ASTConsumer *Consumer;
@@ -249,11 +249,11 @@ private:
ContinuousRangeMap<unsigned, Module*, 64> GlobalSLocEntryMap;
typedef ContinuousRangeMap<unsigned, Module*, 64> GlobalSLocOffsetMapType;
-
+
/// \brief A map of reversed (SourceManager::MaxLoadedOffset - SLocOffset)
/// SourceLocation offsets to the modules containing them.
GlobalSLocOffsetMapType GlobalSLocOffsetMap;
-
+
/// \brief Types that have already been loaded from the chain.
///
/// When the pointer at index I is non-NULL, the type with
@@ -274,18 +274,18 @@ private:
/// = I + 1 has already been loaded.
std::vector<Decl *> DeclsLoaded;
- typedef ContinuousRangeMap<serialization::DeclID, Module *, 4>
+ typedef ContinuousRangeMap<serialization::DeclID, Module *, 4>
GlobalDeclMapType;
-
+
/// \brief Mapping from global declaration IDs to the module in which the
/// declaration resides.
GlobalDeclMapType GlobalDeclMap;
-
+
typedef std::pair<Module *, uint64_t> FileOffset;
typedef SmallVector<FileOffset, 2> FileOffsetsTy;
typedef llvm::DenseMap<serialization::DeclID, FileOffsetsTy>
DeclUpdateOffsetsMap;
-
+
/// \brief Declarations that have modifications residing in a later file
/// in the chain.
DeclUpdateOffsetsMap DeclUpdateOffsets;
@@ -348,7 +348,7 @@ private:
llvm::DenseSet<serialization::GlobalDeclID> ObjCChainedCategoriesInterfaces;
/// \brief Read the records that describe the contents of declcontexts.
- bool ReadDeclContextStorage(Module &M,
+ bool ReadDeclContextStorage(Module &M,
llvm::BitstreamCursor &Cursor,
const std::pair<uint64_t, uint64_t> &Offsets,
serialization::DeclContextInfo &Info);
@@ -361,9 +361,9 @@ private:
/// been loaded.
std::vector<IdentifierInfo *> IdentifiersLoaded;
- typedef ContinuousRangeMap<serialization::IdentID, Module *, 4>
+ typedef ContinuousRangeMap<serialization::IdentID, Module *, 4>
GlobalIdentifierMapType;
-
+
/// \brief Mapping from global identifer IDs to the module in which the
/// identifier resides along with the offset that should be added to the
/// global identifier ID to produce a local ID.
@@ -376,9 +376,9 @@ private:
/// been loaded.
SmallVector<Selector, 16> SelectorsLoaded;
- typedef ContinuousRangeMap<serialization::SelectorID, Module *, 4>
+ typedef ContinuousRangeMap<serialization::SelectorID, Module *, 4>
GlobalSelectorMapType;
-
+
/// \brief Mapping from global selector IDs to the module in which the
/// selector resides along with the offset that should be added to the
/// global selector ID to produce a local ID.
@@ -389,14 +389,14 @@ private:
/// record resides.
llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo *, uint64_t> UnreadMacroRecordOffsets;
- typedef ContinuousRangeMap<unsigned, Module *, 4>
+ typedef ContinuousRangeMap<unsigned, Module *, 4>
GlobalPreprocessedEntityMapType;
-
+
/// \brief Mapping from global preprocessing entity IDs to the module in
/// which the preprocessed entity resides along with the offset that should be
/// added to the global preprocessing entitiy ID to produce a local ID.
GlobalPreprocessedEntityMapType GlobalPreprocessedEntityMap;
-
+
/// \name CodeGen-relevant special data
/// \brief Fields containing data that is relevant to CodeGen.
//@{
@@ -444,7 +444,7 @@ private:
/// \brief A list of all the delegating constructors we've seen, to diagnose
/// cycles.
SmallVector<uint64_t, 4> DelegatingCtorDecls;
-
+
/// \brief Method selectors used in a @selector expression. Used for
/// implementation of -Wselector.
SmallVector<uint64_t, 64> ReferencedSelectorsData;
@@ -514,7 +514,7 @@ private:
/// \brief The file ID for the original file that was used to build the
/// primary AST file.
FileID OriginalFileID;
-
+
/// \brief The directory that the PCH was originally created in. Used to
/// allow resolving headers even after headers+PCH was moved to a new path.
std::string OriginalDir;
@@ -532,7 +532,7 @@ private:
/// \brief Whether to disable the normal validation performed on precompiled
/// headers when they are loaded.
bool DisableValidation;
-
+
/// \brief Whether to disable the use of stat caches in AST files.
bool DisableStatCache;
@@ -588,7 +588,7 @@ private:
/// Number of visible decl contexts read/total.
unsigned NumVisibleDeclContextsRead, TotalVisibleDeclContexts;
-
+
/// Total size of modules, in bits, currently loaded
uint64_t TotalModulesSizeInBits;
@@ -635,7 +635,7 @@ private:
Read_Decl, Read_Type, Read_Stmt
};
- /// \brief What kind of records we are reading.
+ /// \brief What kind of records we are reading.
ReadingKind ReadingKind;
/// \brief RAII object to change the reading kind.
@@ -705,7 +705,7 @@ private:
void loadDeclUpdateRecords(serialization::DeclID ID, Decl *D);
void loadObjCChainedCategories(serialization::GlobalDeclID ID,
ObjCInterfaceDecl *D);
-
+
RecordLocation getLocalBitOffset(uint64_t GlobalOffset);
uint64_t getGlobalBitOffset(Module &M, uint32_t LocalOffset);
@@ -713,7 +713,8 @@ private:
serialization::PreprocessedEntityID
findBeginPreprocessedEntity(SourceLocation BLoc) const;
- /// \brief Returns the first preprocessed entity ID that begins after \arg ELoc.
+ /// \brief Returns the first preprocessed entity ID that begins after \arg
+ /// ELoc.
serialization::PreprocessedEntityID
findEndPreprocessedEntity(SourceLocation ELoc) const;
@@ -773,7 +774,7 @@ public:
~ASTReader();
SourceManager &getSourceManager() const { return SourceMgr; }
-
+
/// \brief Load the AST file designated by the given file name.
ASTReadResult ReadAST(const std::string &FileName, ModuleKind Type);
@@ -802,7 +803,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Retrieve the preprocessor.
Preprocessor &getPreprocessor() const { return PP; }
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the name of the original source file name
const std::string &getOriginalSourceFile() { return OriginalFileName; }
@@ -827,7 +828,7 @@ public:
/// preprocessed entities that \arg Range encompasses.
virtual std::pair<unsigned, unsigned>
findPreprocessedEntitiesInRange(SourceRange Range);
-
+
/// \brief Optionally returns true or false if the preallocated preprocessed
/// entity with index \arg Index came from file \arg FID.
virtual llvm::Optional<bool> isPreprocessedEntityInFileID(unsigned Index,
@@ -871,15 +872,15 @@ public:
E = ModuleMgr.end(); I != E; ++I) {
Result += (*I)->NumPreprocessedEntities;
}
-
+
return Result;
}
-
+
/// \brief Returns the number of C++ base specifiers found in the chain.
unsigned getTotalNumCXXBaseSpecifiers() const {
return NumCXXBaseSpecifiersLoaded;
}
-
+
/// \brief Reads a TemplateArgumentLocInfo appropriate for the
/// given TemplateArgument kind.
TemplateArgumentLocInfo
@@ -901,20 +902,20 @@ public:
/// \brief Resolve a local type ID within a given AST file into a type.
QualType getLocalType(Module &F, unsigned LocalID);
-
+
/// \brief Map a local type ID within a given AST file into a global type ID.
serialization::TypeID getGlobalTypeID(Module &F, unsigned LocalID) const;
-
- /// \brief Read a type from the current position in the given record, which
+
+ /// \brief Read a type from the current position in the given record, which
/// was read from the given AST file.
QualType readType(Module &F, const RecordData &Record, unsigned &Idx) {
if (Idx >= Record.size())
return QualType();
-
+
return getLocalType(F, Record[Idx++]);
}
-
- /// \brief Map from a local declaration ID within a given module to a
+
+ /// \brief Map from a local declaration ID within a given module to a
/// global declaration ID.
serialization::DeclID getGlobalDeclID(Module &F, unsigned LocalID) const;
@@ -924,7 +925,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Returns the source location for the decl \arg ID.
SourceLocation getSourceLocationForDeclID(serialization::GlobalDeclID ID);
-
+
/// \brief Resolve a declaration ID into a declaration, potentially
/// building a new declaration.
Decl *GetDecl(serialization::DeclID ID);
@@ -943,19 +944,19 @@ public:
return cast_or_null<T>(GetLocalDecl(F, LocalID));
}
- /// \brief Reads a declaration ID from the given position in a record in the
+ /// \brief Reads a declaration ID from the given position in a record in the
/// given module.
///
/// \returns The declaration ID read from the record, adjusted to a global ID.
serialization::DeclID ReadDeclID(Module &F, const RecordData &Record,
unsigned &Idx);
-
+
/// \brief Reads a declaration from the given position in a record in the
/// given module.
Decl *ReadDecl(Module &F, const RecordData &R, unsigned &I) {
return GetDecl(ReadDeclID(F, R, I));
}
-
+
/// \brief Reads a declaration from the given position in a record in the
/// given module.
///
@@ -968,11 +969,11 @@ public:
/// \brief Read a CXXBaseSpecifiers ID form the given record and
/// return its global bit offset.
- uint64_t readCXXBaseSpecifiers(Module &M, const RecordData &Record,
+ uint64_t readCXXBaseSpecifiers(Module &M, const RecordData &Record,
unsigned &Idx);
-
+
virtual CXXBaseSpecifier *GetExternalCXXBaseSpecifiers(uint64_t Offset);
-
+
/// \brief Resolve the offset of a statement into a statement.
///
/// This operation will read a new statement from the external
@@ -1011,7 +1012,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Get the decls that are contained in a file in the Offset/Length
/// range. \arg Length can be 0 to indicate a point at \arg Offset instead of
- /// a range.
+ /// a range.
virtual void FindFileRegionDecls(FileID File, unsigned Offset,unsigned Length,
SmallVectorImpl<Decl *> &Decls);
@@ -1036,7 +1037,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Dump information about the AST reader to standard error.
void dump();
-
+
/// Return the amount of memory used by memory buffers, breaking down
/// by heap-backed versus mmap'ed memory.
virtual void getMemoryBufferSizes(MemoryBufferSizes &sizes) const;
@@ -1092,7 +1093,7 @@ public:
virtual void ReadLocallyScopedExternalDecls(
SmallVectorImpl<NamedDecl *> &Decls);
-
+
virtual void ReadReferencedSelectors(
SmallVectorImpl<std::pair<Selector, SourceLocation> > &Sels);
@@ -1102,7 +1103,7 @@ public:
virtual void ReadUsedVTables(SmallVectorImpl<ExternalVTableUse> &VTables);
virtual void ReadPendingInstantiations(
- SmallVectorImpl<std::pair<ValueDecl *,
+ SmallVectorImpl<std::pair<ValueDecl *,
SourceLocation> > &Pending);
/// \brief Load a selector from disk, registering its ID if it exists.
@@ -1121,7 +1122,7 @@ public:
IdentifierInfo *DecodeIdentifierInfo(serialization::IdentifierID ID);
- IdentifierInfo *GetIdentifierInfo(Module &M, const RecordData &Record,
+ IdentifierInfo *GetIdentifierInfo(Module &M, const RecordData &Record,
unsigned &Idx) {
return DecodeIdentifierInfo(getGlobalIdentifierID(M, Record[Idx++]));
}
@@ -1131,10 +1132,10 @@ public:
}
IdentifierInfo *getLocalIdentifier(Module &M, unsigned LocalID);
-
- serialization::IdentifierID getGlobalIdentifierID(Module &M,
+
+ serialization::IdentifierID getGlobalIdentifierID(Module &M,
unsigned LocalID);
-
+
/// \brief Read the source location entry with index ID.
virtual bool ReadSLocEntry(int ID);
@@ -1150,14 +1151,14 @@ public:
Selector ReadSelector(Module &M, const RecordData &Record, unsigned &Idx) {
return getLocalSelector(M, Record[Idx++]);
}
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the global selector ID that corresponds to this
/// the local selector ID in a given module.
- serialization::SelectorID getGlobalSelectorID(Module &F,
+ serialization::SelectorID getGlobalSelectorID(Module &F,
unsigned LocalID) const;
/// \brief Read a declaration name.
- DeclarationName ReadDeclarationName(Module &F,
+ DeclarationName ReadDeclarationName(Module &F,
const RecordData &Record, unsigned &Idx);
void ReadDeclarationNameLoc(Module &F,
DeclarationNameLoc &DNLoc, DeclarationName Name,
@@ -1172,23 +1173,23 @@ public:
const RecordData &Record,
unsigned &Idx);
- NestedNameSpecifierLoc ReadNestedNameSpecifierLoc(Module &F,
+ NestedNameSpecifierLoc ReadNestedNameSpecifierLoc(Module &F,
const RecordData &Record,
unsigned &Idx);
/// \brief Read a template name.
- TemplateName ReadTemplateName(Module &F, const RecordData &Record,
+ TemplateName ReadTemplateName(Module &F, const RecordData &Record,
unsigned &Idx);
/// \brief Read a template argument.
TemplateArgument ReadTemplateArgument(Module &F,
const RecordData &Record,unsigned &Idx);
-
+
/// \brief Read a template parameter list.
TemplateParameterList *ReadTemplateParameterList(Module &F,
const RecordData &Record,
unsigned &Idx);
-
+
/// \brief Read a template argument array.
void
ReadTemplateArgumentList(SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 8> &TemplArgs,
@@ -1242,9 +1243,9 @@ public:
/// \brief Read a version tuple.
VersionTuple ReadVersionTuple(const RecordData &Record, unsigned &Idx);
- CXXTemporary *ReadCXXTemporary(Module &F, const RecordData &Record,
+ CXXTemporary *ReadCXXTemporary(Module &F, const RecordData &Record,
unsigned &Idx);
-
+
/// \brief Reads attributes from the current stream position.
void ReadAttributes(Module &F, AttrVec &Attrs,
const RecordData &Record, unsigned &Idx);
@@ -1270,17 +1271,17 @@ public:
/// \brief Reads the macro record located at the given offset.
void ReadMacroRecord(Module &F, uint64_t Offset);
-
+
/// \brief Determine the global preprocessed entity ID that corresponds to
/// the given local ID within the given module.
- serialization::PreprocessedEntityID
+ serialization::PreprocessedEntityID
getGlobalPreprocessedEntityID(Module &M, unsigned LocalID) const;
-
+
/// \brief Note that the identifier is a macro whose record will be loaded
/// from the given AST file at the given (file-local) offset.
void SetIdentifierIsMacro(IdentifierInfo *II, Module &F,
uint64_t Offset);
-
+
/// \brief Read the set of macros defined by this external macro source.
virtual void ReadDefinedMacros();
@@ -1294,7 +1295,7 @@ public:
/// into the unread macro record offsets table.
void LoadMacroDefinition(
llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo *, uint64_t>::iterator Pos);
-
+
/// \brief Retrieve the AST context that this AST reader supplements.
ASTContext &getContext() { return Context; }
diff --git a/include/clang/Serialization/ASTWriter.h b/include/clang/Serialization/ASTWriter.h
index 8c0ea4fc33..f6a8812b20 100644
--- a/include/clang/Serialization/ASTWriter.h
+++ b/include/clang/Serialization/ASTWriter.h
@@ -84,7 +84,7 @@ private:
/// allow for the const/volatile qualifiers.
///
/// Keys in the map never have const/volatile qualifiers.
- typedef llvm::DenseMap<QualType, serialization::TypeIdx,
+ typedef llvm::DenseMap<QualType, serialization::TypeIdx,
serialization::UnsafeQualTypeDenseMapInfo>
TypeIdxMap;
@@ -93,33 +93,33 @@ private:
/// \brief The ASTContext we're writing.
ASTContext *Context;
-
+
/// \brief The reader of existing AST files, if we're chaining.
ASTReader *Chain;
-
- /// \brief Indicates when the AST writing is actively performing
+
+ /// \brief Indicates when the AST writing is actively performing
/// serialization, rather than just queueing updates.
bool WritingAST;
-
+
/// \brief Stores a declaration or a type to be written to the AST file.
class DeclOrType {
public:
DeclOrType(Decl *D) : Stored(D), IsType(false) { }
DeclOrType(QualType T) : Stored(T.getAsOpaquePtr()), IsType(true) { }
-
+
bool isType() const { return IsType; }
bool isDecl() const { return !IsType; }
-
+
QualType getType() const {
assert(isType() && "Not a type!");
return QualType::getFromOpaquePtr(Stored);
}
-
+
Decl *getDecl() const {
assert(isDecl() && "Not a decl!");
return static_cast<Decl *>(Stored);
}
-
+
private:
void *Stored;
bool IsType;
@@ -215,7 +215,7 @@ private:
/// \brief Offset of each selector within the method pool/selector
/// table, indexed by the Selector ID (-1).
std::vector<uint32_t> SelectorOffsets;
-
+
/// \brief Offsets of each of the macro identifiers into the
/// bitstream.
///
@@ -226,7 +226,7 @@ private:
/// \brief The set of identifiers that had macro definitions at some point.
std::vector<const IdentifierInfo *> DeserializedMacroNames;
-
+
/// \brief Mapping from macro definitions (as they occur in the preprocessing
/// record) to the macro IDs.
llvm::DenseMap<const MacroDefinition *, serialization::PreprocessedEntityID>
@@ -242,7 +242,7 @@ private:
/// \brief Map of first declarations from a chained PCH that point to the
/// most recent declarations in another PCH.
FirstLatestDeclMap FirstLatestDecls;
-
+
/// \brief Declarations encountered that might be external
/// definitions.
///
@@ -260,9 +260,10 @@ private:
/// \brief DeclContexts that have received extensions since their serialized
/// form.
///
- /// For namespaces, when we're chaining and encountering a namespace, we check if
- /// its primary namespace comes from the chain. If it does, we add the primary
- /// to this set, so that we can write out lexical content updates for it.
+ /// For namespaces, when we're chaining and encountering a namespace, we check
+ /// if its primary namespace comes from the chain. If it does, we add the
+ /// primary to this set, so that we can write out lexical content updates for
+ /// it.
llvm::SmallPtrSet<const DeclContext *, 16> UpdatedDeclContexts;
typedef llvm::SmallPtrSet<const Decl *, 16> DeclsToRewriteTy;
@@ -275,10 +276,10 @@ private:
/// \brief The local tail category ID that got chained to the imported
/// interface.
const ObjCCategoryDecl *TailCategory;
-
+
/// \brief ID corresponding to \c Interface.
serialization::DeclID InterfaceID;
-
+
/// \brief ID corresponding to TailCategoryID.
serialization::DeclID TailCategoryID;
};
@@ -310,7 +311,7 @@ private:
SmallVector<Stmt *, 16> StmtsToEmit;
/// \brief Statements collection to use for ASTWriter::AddStmt().
- /// It will point to StmtsToEmit unless it is overriden.
+ /// It will point to StmtsToEmit unless it is overriden.
SmallVector<Stmt *, 16> *CollectedStmts;
/// \brief Mapping from SwitchCase statements to IDs.
@@ -335,33 +336,33 @@ private:
/// \brief The offset of each CXXBaseSpecifier set within the AST.
SmallVector<uint32_t, 4> CXXBaseSpecifiersOffsets;
-
+
/// \brief The first ID number we can use for our own base specifiers.
serialization::CXXBaseSpecifiersID FirstCXXBaseSpecifiersID;
-
- /// \brief The base specifiers ID that will be assigned to the next new
+
+ /// \brief The base specifiers ID that will be assigned to the next new
/// set of C++ base specifiers.
serialization::CXXBaseSpecifiersID NextCXXBaseSpecifiersID;
- /// \brief A set of C++ base specifiers that is queued to be written into the
- /// AST file.
+ /// \brief A set of C++ base specifiers that is queued to be written into the
+ /// AST file.
struct QueuedCXXBaseSpecifiers {
QueuedCXXBaseSpecifiers() : ID(), Bases(), BasesEnd() { }
-
+
QueuedCXXBaseSpecifiers(serialization::CXXBaseSpecifiersID ID,
CXXBaseSpecifier const *Bases,
CXXBaseSpecifier const *BasesEnd)
: ID(ID), Bases(Bases), BasesEnd(BasesEnd) { }
-
+
serialization::CXXBaseSpecifiersID ID;
CXXBaseSpecifier const * Bases;
CXXBaseSpecifier const * BasesEnd;
};
-
+
/// \brief Queue of C++ base specifiers to be written to the AST file,
/// in the order they should be written.
SmallVector<QueuedCXXBaseSpecifiers, 2> CXXBaseSpecifiersToWrite;
-
+
/// \brief Write the given subexpression to the bitstream.
void WriteSubStmt(Stmt *S,
llvm::DenseMap<Stmt *, uint64_t> &SubStmtEntries,
@@ -419,13 +420,13 @@ private:
void WriteASTCore(Sema &SemaRef, MemorizeStatCalls *StatCalls,
StringRef isysroot, const std::string &OutputFile,
bool IsModule);
-
+
public:
/// \brief Create a new precompiled header writer that outputs to
/// the given bitstream.
ASTWriter(llvm::BitstreamWriter &Stream);
~ASTWriter();
-
+
/// \brief Write a precompiled header for the given semantic analysis.
///
/// \param SemaRef a reference to the semantic analysis object that processed
@@ -448,7 +449,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Emit a source range.
void AddSourceRange(SourceRange Range, RecordDataImpl &Record);
-
+
/// \brief Emit an integral value.
void AddAPInt(const llvm::APInt &Value, RecordDataImpl &Record);
@@ -471,10 +472,10 @@ public:
void AddCXXBaseSpecifiersRef(CXXBaseSpecifier const *Bases,
CXXBaseSpecifier const *BasesEnd,
RecordDataImpl &Record);
-
+
/// \brief Get the unique number used to refer to the given selector.
serialization::SelectorID getSelectorRef(Selector Sel);
-
+
/// \brief Get the unique number used to refer to the given identifier.
serialization::IdentID getIdentifierRef(const IdentifierInfo *II);
@@ -487,7 +488,7 @@ public:
"Identifier does not name a macro");
return MacroOffsets[II];
}
-
+
/// \brief Emit a reference to a type.
void AddTypeRef(QualType T, RecordDataImpl &Record);
@@ -521,7 +522,7 @@ public:
/// \brief Emit a reference to a declaration.
void AddDeclRef(const Decl *D, RecordDataImpl &Record);
-
+
/// \brief Force a declaration to be emitted and get its ID.
serialization::DeclID GetDeclRef(const Decl *D);
@@ -542,9 +543,9 @@ public:
void AddNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS, RecordDataImpl &Record);
/// \brief Emit a nested name specifier with source-location information.
- void AddNestedNameSpecifierLoc(NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNS,
+ void AddNestedNameSpecifierLoc(NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNS,
RecordDataImpl &Record);
-
+
/// \brief Emit a template name.
void AddTemplateName(TemplateName Name, RecordDataImpl &Record);
@@ -563,7 +564,8 @@ public:
void AddUnresolvedSet(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Set, RecordDataImpl &Record);
/// \brief Emit a C++ base specifier.
- void AddCXXBaseSpecifier(const CXXBaseSpecifier &Base, RecordDataImpl &Record);
+ void AddCXXBaseSpecifier(const CXXBaseSpecifier &Base,
+ RecordDataImpl &Record);
/// \brief Emit a CXXCtorInitializer array.
void AddCXXCtorInitializers(
@@ -614,10 +616,10 @@ public:
/// been added to the queue via AddStmt().
void FlushStmts();
- /// \brief Flush all of the C++ base specifier sets that have been added
+ /// \brief Flush all of the C++ base specifier sets that have been added
/// via \c AddCXXBaseSpecifiersRef().
void FlushCXXBaseSpecifiers();
-
+
/// \brief Record an ID for the given switch-case statement.
unsigned RecordSwitchCaseID(SwitchCase *S);
@@ -684,7 +686,7 @@ protected:
const ASTWriter &getWriter() const { return Writer; }
public:
- PCHGenerator(const Preprocessor &PP, StringRef OutputFile,
+ PCHGenerator(const Preprocessor &PP, StringRef OutputFile,
bool IsModule,
StringRef isysroot, raw_ostream *Out);
~PCHGenerator();
diff --git a/include/clang/Serialization/Module.h b/include/clang/Serialization/Module.h
index 43687f46dd..ca2046bf27 100644
--- a/include/clang/Serialization/Module.h
+++ b/include/clang/Serialization/Module.h
@@ -23,12 +23,12 @@
#include "llvm/Bitcode/BitstreamReader.h"
#include <string>
-namespace clang {
+namespace clang {
class DeclContext;
-
+
namespace serialization {
-
+
/// \brief Specifies the kind of module that has been loaded.
enum ModuleKind {
MK_Module, ///< File is a module proper.
@@ -39,9 +39,9 @@ enum ModuleKind {
/// \brief Information about the contents of a DeclContext.
struct DeclContextInfo {
- DeclContextInfo()
+ DeclContextInfo()
: NameLookupTableData(), LexicalDecls(), NumLexicalDecls() {}
-
+
void *NameLookupTableData; // an ASTDeclContextNameLookupTable.
const KindDeclIDPair *LexicalDecls;
unsigned NumLexicalDecls;
@@ -49,216 +49,216 @@ struct DeclContextInfo {
/// \brief Information about a module that has been loaded by the ASTReader.
///
-/// Each instance of the Module class corresponds to a single AST file, which
-/// may be a precompiled header, precompiled preamble, a module, or an AST file
-/// of some sort loaded as the main file, all of which are specific formulations of
-/// the general notion of a "module". A module may depend on any number of
+/// Each instance of the Module class corresponds to a single AST file, which
+/// may be a precompiled header, precompiled preamble, a module, or an AST file
+/// of some sort loaded as the main file, all of which are specific formulations
+/// of the general notion of a "module". A module may depend on any number of
/// other modules.
class Module {
-public:
+public:
Module(ModuleKind Kind);
~Module();
-
+
// === General information ===
-
+
/// \brief The type of this module.
ModuleKind Kind;
-
+
/// \brief The file name of the module file.
std::string FileName;
-
+
/// \brief Whether this module has been directly imported by the
/// user.
bool DirectlyImported;
-
+
/// \brief The memory buffer that stores the data associated with
/// this AST file.
llvm::OwningPtr<llvm::MemoryBuffer> Buffer;
-
+
/// \brief The size of this file, in bits.
uint64_t SizeInBits;
-
+
/// \brief The global bit offset (or base) of this module
uint64_t GlobalBitOffset;
-
+
/// \brief The bitstream reader from which we'll read the AST file.
llvm::BitstreamReader StreamFile;
-
+
/// \brief The main bitstream cursor for the main block.
llvm::BitstreamCursor Stream;
-
+
/// \brief The source location where this module was first imported.
SourceLocation ImportLoc;
-
+
/// \brief The first source location in this module.
SourceLocation FirstLoc;
-
+
// === Source Locations ===
-
+
/// \brief Cursor used to read source location entries.
llvm::BitstreamCursor SLocEntryCursor;
-
+
/// \brief The number of source location entries in this AST file.
unsigned LocalNumSLocEntries;
-
+
/// \brief The base ID in the source manager's view of this module.
int SLocEntryBaseID;
-
+
/// \brief The base offset in the source manager's view of this module.
unsigned SLocEntryBaseOffset;
-
+
/// \brief Offsets for all of the source location entries in the
/// AST file.
const uint32_t *SLocEntryOffsets;
-
+
/// \brief SLocEntries that we're going to preload.
SmallVector<uint64_t, 4> PreloadSLocEntries;
/// \brief The number of source location file entries in this AST file.
unsigned LocalNumSLocFileEntries;
-
+
/// \brief Offsets for all of the source location file entries in the
/// AST file.
const uint32_t *SLocFileOffsets;
-
+
/// \brief Remapping table for source locations in this module.
ContinuousRangeMap<uint32_t, int, 2> SLocRemap;
-
+
// === Identifiers ===
-
+
/// \brief The number of identifiers in this AST file.
unsigned LocalNumIdentifiers;
-
+
/// \brief Offsets into the identifier table data.
///
/// This array is indexed by the identifier ID (-1), and provides
/// the offset into IdentifierTableData where the string data is
/// stored.
const uint32_t *IdentifierOffsets;
-
+
/// \brief Base identifier ID for identifiers local to this module.
serialization::IdentID BaseIdentifierID;
-
+
/// \brief Remapping table for identifier IDs in this module.
ContinuousRangeMap<uint32_t, int, 2> IdentifierRemap;
-
+
/// \brief Actual data for the on-disk hash table of identifiers.
///
/// This pointer points into a memory buffer, where the on-disk hash
/// table for identifiers actually lives.
const char *IdentifierTableData;
-
+
/// \brief A pointer to an on-disk hash table of opaque type
/// IdentifierHashTable.
void *IdentifierLookupTable;
-
+
// === Macros ===
-
+
/// \brief The cursor to the start of the preprocessor block, which stores
/// all of the macro definitions.
llvm::BitstreamCursor MacroCursor;
-
+
/// \brief The offset of the start of the set of defined macros.
uint64_t MacroStartOffset;
-
+
// === Detailed PreprocessingRecord ===
-
- /// \brief The cursor to the start of the (optional) detailed preprocessing
+
+ /// \brief The cursor to the start of the (optional) detailed preprocessing
/// record block.
llvm::BitstreamCursor PreprocessorDetailCursor;
-
+
/// \brief The offset of the start of the preprocessor detail cursor.
uint64_t PreprocessorDetailStartOffset;
-
- /// \brief Base preprocessed entity ID for preprocessed entities local to
+
+ /// \brief Base preprocessed entity ID for preprocessed entities local to
/// this module.
serialization::PreprocessedEntityID BasePreprocessedEntityID;
-
+
/// \brief Remapping table for preprocessed entity IDs in this module.
ContinuousRangeMap<uint32_t, int, 2> PreprocessedEntityRemap;
-
+
const PPEntityOffset *PreprocessedEntityOffsets;
unsigned NumPreprocessedEntities;
-
+
// === Header search information ===
-
+
/// \brief The number of local HeaderFileInfo structures.
unsigned LocalNumHeaderFileInfos;
-
- /// \brief Actual data for the on-disk hash table of header file
+
+ /// \brief Actual data for the on-disk hash table of header file
/// information.
///
/// This pointer points into a memory buffer, where the on-disk hash
/// table for header file information actually lives.
const char *HeaderFileInfoTableData;
-
+
/// \brief The on-disk hash table that contains information about each of
/// the header files.
void *HeaderFileInfoTable;
-
+
/// \brief Actual data for the list of framework names used in the header
/// search information.
const char *HeaderFileFrameworkStrings;
-
+
// === Selectors ===
-
+
/// \brief The number of selectors new to this file.
///
/// This is the number of entries in SelectorOffsets.
unsigned LocalNumSelectors;
-
+
/// \brief Offsets into the selector lookup table's data array
/// where each selector resides.
const uint32_t *SelectorOffsets;
-
+
/// \brief Base selector ID for selectors local to this module.
serialization::SelectorID BaseSelectorID;
-
+
/// \brief Remapping table for selector IDs in this module.
ContinuousRangeMap<uint32_t, int, 2> SelectorRemap;
-
+
/// \brief A pointer to the character data that comprises the selector table
///
/// The SelectorOffsets table refers into this memory.
const unsigned char *SelectorLookupTableData;
-
+
/// \brief A pointer to an on-disk hash table of opaque type
/// ASTSelectorLookupTable.
///
/// This hash table provides the IDs of all selectors, and the associated
/// instance and factory methods.
void *SelectorLookupTable;
-
+
// === Declarations ===
-
+
/// DeclsCursor - This is a cursor to the start of the DECLS_BLOCK block. It
/// has read all the abbreviations at the start of the block and is ready to
/// jump around with these in context.
llvm::BitstreamCursor DeclsCursor;
-
+
/// \brief The number of declarations in this AST file.
unsigned LocalNumDecls;
-
+
/// \brief Offset of each declaration within the bitstream, indexed
/// by the declaration ID (-1).
const DeclOffset *DeclOffsets;
-
+
/// \brief Base declaration ID for declarations local to this module.
serialization::DeclID BaseDeclID;
-
+
/// \brief Remapping table for declaration IDs in this module.
ContinuousRangeMap<uint32_t, int, 2> DeclRemap;
-
+
/// \brief The number of C++ base specifier sets in this AST file.
unsigned LocalNumCXXBaseSpecifiers;
-
+
/// \brief Offset of each C++ base specifier set within the bitstream,
/// indexed by the C++ base specifier set ID (-1).
const uint32_t *CXXBaseSpecifiersOffsets;
-
+
typedef llvm::DenseMap<const DeclContext *, DeclContextInfo>
DeclContextInfosMap;
-
+
/// \brief Information about the lexical and visible declarations
/// for each DeclContext.
DeclContextInfosMap DeclContextInfos;
@@ -274,43 +274,43 @@ public:
/// \brief Array of file-level DeclIDs sorted by file.
const serialization::DeclID *FileSortedDecls;
-
+
// === Types ===
-
+
/// \brief The number of types in this AST file.
unsigned LocalNumTypes;
-
+
/// \brief Offset of each type within the bitstream, indexed by the
/// type ID, or the representation of a Type*.
const uint32_t *TypeOffsets;
-
- /// \brief Base type ID for types local to this module as represented in
+
+ /// \brief Base type ID for types local to this module as represented in
/// the global type ID space.
serialization::TypeID BaseTypeIndex;
-
+
/// \brief Remapping table for type IDs in this module.
ContinuousRangeMap<uint32_t, int, 2> TypeRemap;
-
+
// === Miscellaneous ===
-
+
/// \brief Diagnostic IDs and their mappings that the user changed.
SmallVector<uint64_t, 8> PragmaDiagMappings;
-
+
/// \brief The AST stat cache installed for this file, if any.
///
/// The dynamic type of this stat cache is always ASTStatCache
void *StatCache;
-
+
/// \brief List of modules which depend on this module
llvm::SetVector<Module *> ImportedBy;
-
+
/// \brief List of modules which this module depends on
llvm::SetVector<Module *> Imports;
-
+
/// \brief Determine whether this module was directly imported at
/// any point during translation.
bool isDirectlyImported() const { return DirectlyImported; }
-
+
/// \brief Dump debugging output for this module.
void dump();
};